summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/Doc/library
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'Doc/library')
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/_thread.rst3
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/abc.rst82
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/archiving.rst6
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/argparse.rst31
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/array.rst68
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/ast.rst3
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/asyncore.rst8
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/atexit.rst8
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/binascii.rst9
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/bz2.rst229
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/chunk.rst5
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/cmd.rst4
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/codecs.rst34
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/collections.abc.rst182
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/collections.rst365
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/concurrent.futures.rst19
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/crypt.rst115
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/csv.rst18
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/ctypes.rst21
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/curses.rst31
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/datatypes.rst1
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/datetime.rst39
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/debug.rst3
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/depgraph-output.pngbin0 -> 24719 bytes
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/difflib.rst4
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/dis.rst12
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/distutils.rst20
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/email.generator.rst55
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/email.parser.rst78
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/email.policy.rst184
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/email.rst1
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/email.util.rst37
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/exceptions.rst223
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/faulthandler.rst136
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/fcntl.rst9
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/fileinput.rst9
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/ftplib.rst65
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/functions.rst53
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/functools.rst13
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/gettext.rst7
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/gzip.rst5
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/http.client.rst6
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/http.cookiejar.rst11
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/http.server.rst45
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/imaplib.rst11
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/importlib.rst19
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/inspect.rst12
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/io.rst65
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/itertools.rst48
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/logging.handlers.rst101
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/logging.rst41
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/lzma.rst349
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/math.rst13
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/mmap.rst12
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/msvcrt.rst15
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/multiprocessing.rst58
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/nntplib.rst16
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/os.rst1017
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/ossaudiodev.rst14
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging-misc.rst27
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.command.rst111
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.compiler.rst681
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.database.rst324
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.depgraph.rst199
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.dist.rst108
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.fancy_getopt.rst75
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.install.rst112
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.metadata.rst122
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.pypi.dist.rst114
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.pypi.rst74
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.pypi.simple.rst218
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.pypi.xmlrpc.rst143
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.rst75
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.tests.pypi_server.rst105
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.util.rst155
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/packaging.version.rst104
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/platform.rst4
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/python.rst1
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/random.rst6
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/re.rst9
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/readline.rst4
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/resource.rst8
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/sched.rst65
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/select.rst114
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/shlex.rst36
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/shutil.rst114
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/signal.rst165
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/site.rst26
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/smtplib.rst62
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/socket.rst389
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/socketserver.rst16
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/sqlite3.rst16
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/ssl.rst218
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/stdtypes.rst78
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/struct.rst21
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/subprocess.rst151
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/sys.rst136
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/tarfile.rst31
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/telnetlib.rst6
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/tempfile.rst2
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/test.rst124
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/threading.rst56
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/time.rst120
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/tokenize.rst108
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/unicodedata.rst9
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/unittest.rst50
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/urllib.error.rst12
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/urllib.request.rst63
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/warnings.rst3
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/webbrowser.rst97
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/winreg.rst48
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/xmlrpc.client.rst53
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/xmlrpc.server.rst28
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/zipimport.rst5
-rw-r--r--Doc/library/zlib.rst39
115 files changed, 8124 insertions, 1164 deletions
diff --git a/Doc/library/_thread.rst b/Doc/library/_thread.rst
index 369e9cd..e7e7504 100644
--- a/Doc/library/_thread.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/_thread.rst
@@ -35,6 +35,9 @@ It defines the following constants and functions:
Raised on thread-specific errors.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This is now a synonym of the built-in :exc:`RuntimeError`.
+
.. data:: LockType
diff --git a/Doc/library/abc.rst b/Doc/library/abc.rst
index 1048b24..6f42222 100644
--- a/Doc/library/abc.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/abc.rst
@@ -18,7 +18,7 @@ regarding a type hierarchy for numbers based on ABCs.)
The :mod:`collections` module has some concrete classes that derive from
ABCs; these can, of course, be further derived. In addition the
-:mod:`collections` module has some ABCs that can be used to test whether
+:mod:`collections.abc` submodule has some ABCs that can be used to test whether
a class or instance provides a particular interface, for example, is it
hashable or a mapping.
@@ -55,6 +55,9 @@ This module provides the following class:
assert issubclass(tuple, MyABC)
assert isinstance((), MyABC)
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Returns the registered subclass, to allow usage as a class decorator.
+
You can also override this method in an abstract base class:
.. method:: __subclasshook__(subclass)
@@ -124,19 +127,18 @@ This module provides the following class:
available as a method of ``Foo``, so it is provided separately.
-It also provides the following decorators:
+The :mod:`abc` module also provides the following decorators:
.. decorator:: abstractmethod(function)
A decorator indicating abstract methods.
- Using this decorator requires that the class's metaclass is :class:`ABCMeta` or
- is derived from it.
- A class that has a metaclass derived from :class:`ABCMeta`
- cannot be instantiated unless all of its abstract methods and
- properties are overridden.
- The abstract methods can be called using any of the normal 'super' call
- mechanisms.
+ Using this decorator requires that the class's metaclass is :class:`ABCMeta`
+ or is derived from it. A class that has a metaclass derived from
+ :class:`ABCMeta` cannot be instantiated unless all of its abstract methods
+ and properties are overridden. The abstract methods can be called using any
+ of the normal 'super' call mechanisms. :func:`abstractmethod` may be used
+ to declare abstract methods for properties and descriptors.
Dynamically adding abstract methods to a class, or attempting to modify the
abstraction status of a method or class once it is created, are not
@@ -144,12 +146,52 @@ It also provides the following decorators:
regular inheritance; "virtual subclasses" registered with the ABC's
:meth:`register` method are not affected.
- Usage::
+ When :func:`abstractmethod` is applied in combination with other method
+ descriptors, it should be applied as the innermost decorator, as shown in
+ the following usage examples::
class C(metaclass=ABCMeta):
@abstractmethod
def my_abstract_method(self, ...):
...
+ @classmethod
+ @abstractmethod
+ def my_abstract_classmethod(cls, ...):
+ ...
+ @staticmethod
+ @abstractmethod
+ def my_abstract_staticmethod(...):
+ ...
+
+ @property
+ @abstractmethod
+ def my_abstract_property(self):
+ ...
+ @my_abstract_property.setter
+ @abstractmethod
+ def my_abstract_property(self, val):
+ ...
+
+ @abstractmethod
+ def _get_x(self):
+ ...
+ @abstractmethod
+ def _set_x(self, val):
+ ...
+ x = property(_get_x, _set_x)
+
+ In order to correctly interoperate with the abstract base class machinery,
+ the descriptor must identify itself as abstract using
+ :attr:`__isabstractmethod__`. In general, this attribute should be ``True``
+ if any of the methods used to compose the descriptor are abstract. For
+ example, Python's built-in property does the equivalent of::
+
+ class Descriptor:
+ ...
+ @property
+ def __isabstractmethod__(self):
+ return any(getattr(f, '__isabstractmethod__', False) for
+ f in (self._fget, self._fset, self._fdel))
.. note::
@@ -174,6 +216,8 @@ It also provides the following decorators:
...
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ Use :class:`classmethod` with :func:`abstractmethod` instead
.. decorator:: abstractstaticmethod(function)
@@ -189,18 +233,19 @@ It also provides the following decorators:
...
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ Use :class:`staticmethod` with :func:`abstractmethod` instead
-.. function:: abstractproperty(fget=None, fset=None, fdel=None, doc=None)
+.. decorator:: abstractproperty(fget=None, fset=None, fdel=None, doc=None)
A subclass of the built-in :func:`property`, indicating an abstract property.
- Using this function requires that the class's metaclass is :class:`ABCMeta` or
- is derived from it.
- A class that has a metaclass derived from :class:`ABCMeta` cannot be
- instantiated unless all of its abstract methods and properties are overridden.
- The abstract properties can be called using any of the normal
- 'super' call mechanisms.
+ Using this function requires that the class's metaclass is :class:`ABCMeta`
+ or is derived from it. A class that has a metaclass derived from
+ :class:`ABCMeta` cannot be instantiated unless all of its abstract methods
+ and properties are overridden. The abstract properties can be called using
+ any of the normal 'super' call mechanisms.
Usage::
@@ -217,6 +262,9 @@ It also provides the following decorators:
def setx(self, value): ...
x = abstractproperty(getx, setx)
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ Use :class:`property` with :func:`abstractmethod` instead
+
.. rubric:: Footnotes
diff --git a/Doc/library/archiving.rst b/Doc/library/archiving.rst
index 75d137c..c928494 100644
--- a/Doc/library/archiving.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/archiving.rst
@@ -5,8 +5,9 @@ Data Compression and Archiving
******************************
The modules described in this chapter support data compression with the zlib,
-gzip, and bzip2 algorithms, and the creation of ZIP- and tar-format archives.
-See also :ref:`archiving-operations` provided by the :mod:`shutil` module.
+gzip, bzip2 and lzma algorithms, and the creation of ZIP- and tar-format
+archives. See also :ref:`archiving-operations` provided by the :mod:`shutil`
+module.
.. toctree::
@@ -14,5 +15,6 @@ See also :ref:`archiving-operations` provided by the :mod:`shutil` module.
zlib.rst
gzip.rst
bz2.rst
+ lzma.rst
zipfile.rst
tarfile.rst
diff --git a/Doc/library/argparse.rst b/Doc/library/argparse.rst
index 4272f16..2617ae5 100644
--- a/Doc/library/argparse.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/argparse.rst
@@ -362,16 +362,16 @@ formatter_class
^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
:class:`ArgumentParser` objects allow the help formatting to be customized by
-specifying an alternate formatting class. Currently, there are three such
+specifying an alternate formatting class. Currently, there are four such
classes:
.. class:: RawDescriptionHelpFormatter
RawTextHelpFormatter
ArgumentDefaultsHelpFormatter
+ MetavarTypeHelpFormatter
-The first two allow more control over how textual descriptions are displayed,
-while the last automatically adds information about argument default values.
-
+:class:`RawDescriptionHelpFormatter` and :class:`RawTextHelpFormatter` give
+more control over how textual descriptions are displayed.
By default, :class:`ArgumentParser` objects line-wrap the description_ and
epilog_ texts in command-line help messages::
@@ -424,8 +424,8 @@ should not be line-wrapped::
:class:`RawTextHelpFormatter` maintains whitespace for all sorts of help text,
including argument descriptions.
-The other formatter class available, :class:`ArgumentDefaultsHelpFormatter`,
-will add information about the default value of each of the arguments::
+:class:`ArgumentDefaultsHelpFormatter` automatically adds information about
+default values to each of the argument help messages::
>>> parser = argparse.ArgumentParser(
... prog='PROG',
@@ -442,6 +442,25 @@ will add information about the default value of each of the arguments::
-h, --help show this help message and exit
--foo FOO FOO! (default: 42)
+:class:`MetavarTypeHelpFormatter` uses the name of the type_ argument for each
+argument as the display name for its values (rather than using the dest_
+as the regular formatter does)::
+
+ >>> parser = argparse.ArgumentParser(
+ ... prog='PROG',
+ ... formatter_class=argparse.MetavarTypeHelpFormatter)
+ >>> parser.add_argument('--foo', type=int)
+ >>> parser.add_argument('bar', type=float)
+ >>> parser.print_help()
+ usage: PROG [-h] [--foo int] float
+
+ positional arguments:
+ float
+
+ optional arguments:
+ -h, --help show this help message and exit
+ --foo int
+
conflict_handler
^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
diff --git a/Doc/library/array.rst b/Doc/library/array.rst
index d563cce..3e275a2 100644
--- a/Doc/library/array.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/array.rst
@@ -14,36 +14,44 @@ them is constrained. The type is specified at object creation time by using a
:dfn:`type code`, which is a single character. The following type codes are
defined:
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| Type code | C Type | Python Type | Minimum size in bytes |
-+===========+================+===================+=======================+
-| ``'b'`` | signed char | int | 1 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'B'`` | unsigned char | int | 1 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'u'`` | Py_UNICODE | Unicode character | 2 (see note) |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'h'`` | signed short | int | 2 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'H'`` | unsigned short | int | 2 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'i'`` | signed int | int | 2 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'I'`` | unsigned int | int | 2 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'l'`` | signed long | int | 4 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'L'`` | unsigned long | int | 4 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'f'`` | float | float | 4 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-| ``'d'`` | double | float | 8 |
-+-----------+----------------+-------------------+-----------------------+
-
-.. note::
-
- The ``'u'`` typecode corresponds to Python's unicode character. On narrow
- Unicode builds this is 2-bytes, on wide builds this is 4-bytes.
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| Type code | C Type | Python Type | Minimum size in bytes | Notes |
++===========+====================+===================+=======================+=======+
+| ``'b'`` | signed char | int | 1 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'B'`` | unsigned char | int | 1 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'u'`` | Py_UCS4 | Unicode character | 4 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'h'`` | signed short | int | 2 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'H'`` | unsigned short | int | 2 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'i'`` | signed int | int | 2 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'I'`` | unsigned int | int | 2 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'l'`` | signed long | int | 4 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'L'`` | unsigned long | int | 4 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'q'`` | signed long long | int | 8 | \(1) |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'Q'`` | unsigned long long | int | 8 | \(1) |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'f'`` | float | float | 4 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+| ``'d'`` | double | float | 8 | |
++-----------+--------------------+-------------------+-----------------------+-------+
+
+Notes:
+
+(1)
+ The ``'q'`` and ``'Q'`` type codes are available only if
+ the platform C compiler used to build Python supports C :c:type:`long long`,
+ or, on Windows, :c:type:`__int64`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
The actual representation of values is determined by the machine architecture
(strictly speaking, by the C implementation). The actual size can be accessed
diff --git a/Doc/library/ast.rst b/Doc/library/ast.rst
index e2c0b6d..16de3ca 100644
--- a/Doc/library/ast.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/ast.rst
@@ -96,9 +96,6 @@ Node classes
Abstract Grammar
----------------
-The module defines a string constant ``__version__`` which is the decimal
-Subversion revision number of the file shown below.
-
The abstract grammar is currently defined as follows:
.. literalinclude:: ../../Parser/Python.asdl
diff --git a/Doc/library/asyncore.rst b/Doc/library/asyncore.rst
index 619b7bb..5411c30 100644
--- a/Doc/library/asyncore.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/asyncore.rst
@@ -184,12 +184,14 @@ any that have been added to the map during asynchronous service) is closed.
Most of these are nearly identical to their socket partners.
- .. method:: create_socket(family, type)
+ .. method:: create_socket(family=socket.AF_INET, type=socket.SOCK_STREAM)
This is identical to the creation of a normal socket, and will use the
same options for creation. Refer to the :mod:`socket` documentation for
information on creating sockets.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3 family and type arguments can be omitted.
+
.. method:: connect(address)
@@ -280,7 +282,7 @@ implement its socket handling::
def __init__(self, host, path):
asyncore.dispatcher.__init__(self)
- self.create_socket(socket.AF_INET, socket.SOCK_STREAM)
+ self.create_socket()
self.connect( (host, 80) )
self.buffer = bytes('GET %s HTTP/1.0\r\nHost: %s\r\n\r\n' %
(path, host), 'ascii')
@@ -327,7 +329,7 @@ connections and dispatches the incoming connections to a handler::
def __init__(self, host, port):
asyncore.dispatcher.__init__(self)
- self.create_socket(socket.AF_INET, socket.SOCK_STREAM)
+ self.create_socket()
self.set_reuse_addr()
self.bind((host, port))
self.listen(5)
diff --git a/Doc/library/atexit.rst b/Doc/library/atexit.rst
index 5b87b94..c3bb04d 100644
--- a/Doc/library/atexit.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/atexit.rst
@@ -64,8 +64,9 @@ automatically when the program terminates without relying on the application
making an explicit call into this module at termination. ::
try:
- _count = int(open("/tmp/counter").read())
- except IOError:
+ with open("/tmp/counter") as infile:
+ _count = int(infile.read())
+ except FileNotFoundError:
_count = 0
def incrcounter(n):
@@ -73,7 +74,8 @@ making an explicit call into this module at termination. ::
_count = _count + n
def savecounter():
- open("/tmp/counter", "w").write("%d" % _count)
+ with open("/tmp/counter", "w") as outfile:
+ outfile.write("%d" % _count)
import atexit
atexit.register(savecounter)
diff --git a/Doc/library/binascii.rst b/Doc/library/binascii.rst
index 2aa3702..baf430d 100644
--- a/Doc/library/binascii.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/binascii.rst
@@ -20,8 +20,13 @@ higher-level modules.
.. note::
- Encoding and decoding functions do not accept Unicode strings. Only bytestring
- and bytearray objects can be processed.
+ ``a2b_*`` functions accept Unicode strings containing only ASCII characters.
+ Other functions only accept bytes and bytes-compatible objects (such as
+ bytearray objects and other objects implementing the buffer API).
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ ASCII-only unicode strings are now accepted by the ``a2b_*`` functions.
+
The :mod:`binascii` module defines the following functions:
diff --git a/Doc/library/bz2.rst b/Doc/library/bz2.rst
index d13f6e0..9577f31 100644
--- a/Doc/library/bz2.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/bz2.rst
@@ -1,198 +1,169 @@
-:mod:`bz2` --- Compression compatible with :program:`bzip2`
-===========================================================
+:mod:`bz2` --- Support for :program:`bzip2` compression
+=======================================================
.. module:: bz2
- :synopsis: Interface to compression and decompression routines
- compatible with bzip2.
+ :synopsis: Interfaces for bzip2 compression and decompression.
.. moduleauthor:: Gustavo Niemeyer <niemeyer@conectiva.com>
+.. moduleauthor:: Nadeem Vawda <nadeem.vawda@gmail.com>
.. sectionauthor:: Gustavo Niemeyer <niemeyer@conectiva.com>
+.. sectionauthor:: Nadeem Vawda <nadeem.vawda@gmail.com>
-This module provides a comprehensive interface for the bz2 compression library.
-It implements a complete file interface, one-shot (de)compression functions, and
-types for sequential (de)compression.
+This module provides a comprehensive interface for compressing and
+decompressing data using the bzip2 compression algorithm.
-Here is a summary of the features offered by the bz2 module:
+The :mod:`bz2` module contains:
-* :class:`BZ2File` class implements a complete file interface, including
- :meth:`~BZ2File.readline`, :meth:`~BZ2File.readlines`,
- :meth:`~BZ2File.writelines`, :meth:`~BZ2File.seek`, etc;
+* The :class:`BZ2File` class for reading and writing compressed files.
+* The :class:`BZ2Compressor` and :class:`BZ2Decompressor` classes for
+ incremental (de)compression.
+* The :func:`compress` and :func:`decompress` functions for one-shot
+ (de)compression.
-* :class:`BZ2File` class implements emulated :meth:`~BZ2File.seek` support;
-
-* :class:`BZ2File` class implements universal newline support;
-
-* :class:`BZ2File` class offers an optimized line iteration using a readahead
- algorithm;
-
-* Sequential (de)compression supported by :class:`BZ2Compressor` and
- :class:`BZ2Decompressor` classes;
-
-* One-shot (de)compression supported by :func:`compress` and :func:`decompress`
- functions;
-
-* Thread safety uses individual locking mechanism.
+All of the classes in this module may safely be accessed from multiple threads.
(De)compression of files
------------------------
-Handling of compressed files is offered by the :class:`BZ2File` class.
-
-
-.. class:: BZ2File(filename, mode='r', buffering=0, compresslevel=9)
-
- Open a bz2 file. Mode can be either ``'r'`` or ``'w'``, for reading (default)
- or writing. When opened for writing, the file will be created if it doesn't
- exist, and truncated otherwise. If *buffering* is given, ``0`` means
- unbuffered, and larger numbers specify the buffer size; the default is
- ``0``. If *compresslevel* is given, it must be a number between ``1`` and
- ``9``; the default is ``9``. Add a ``'U'`` to mode to open the file for input
- with universal newline support. Any line ending in the input file will be
- seen as a ``'\n'`` in Python. Also, a file so opened gains the attribute
- :attr:`newlines`; the value for this attribute is one of ``None`` (no newline
- read yet), ``'\r'``, ``'\n'``, ``'\r\n'`` or a tuple containing all the
- newline types seen. Universal newlines are available only when
- reading. Instances support iteration in the same way as normal :class:`file`
- instances.
-
- :class:`BZ2File` supports the :keyword:`with` statement.
-
- .. versionchanged:: 3.1
- Support for the :keyword:`with` statement was added.
-
-
- .. note::
+.. class:: BZ2File(filename=None, mode='r', buffering=None, compresslevel=9, \*, fileobj=None)
- This class does not support input files containing multiple streams (such
- as those produced by the :program:`pbzip2` tool). When reading such an
- input file, only the first stream will be accessible. If you require
- support for multi-stream files, consider using the third-party
- :mod:`bz2file` module (available from
- `PyPI <http://pypi.python.org/pypi/bz2file>`_). This module provides a
- backport of Python 3.3's :class:`BZ2File` class, which does support
- multi-stream files.
+ Open a bzip2-compressed file.
+ The :class:`BZ2File` can wrap an existing :term:`file object` (given by
+ *fileobj*), or operate directly on a named file (named by *filename*).
+ Exactly one of these two parameters should be provided.
- .. method:: close()
+ The *mode* argument can be either ``'r'`` for reading (default), ``'w'`` for
+ overwriting, or ``'a'`` for appending. If *fileobj* is provided, a mode of
+ ``'w'`` does not truncate the file, and is instead equivalent to ``'a'``.
- Close the file. Sets data attribute :attr:`closed` to true. A closed file
- cannot be used for further I/O operations. :meth:`close` may be called
- more than once without error.
+ The *buffering* argument is ignored. Its use is deprecated.
+ If *mode* is ``'w'`` or ``'a'``, *compresslevel* can be a number between
+ ``1`` and ``9`` specifying the level of compression: ``1`` produces the
+ least compression, and ``9`` (default) produces the most compression.
- .. method:: read([size])
+ If *mode* is ``'r'``, the input file may be the concatenation of multiple
+ compressed streams.
- Read at most *size* uncompressed bytes, returned as a byte string. If the
- *size* argument is negative or omitted, read until EOF is reached.
+ :class:`BZ2File` provides all of the members specified by the
+ :class:`io.BufferedIOBase`, except for :meth:`detach` and :meth:`truncate`.
+ Iteration and the :keyword:`with` statement are supported.
+ :class:`BZ2File` also provides the following method:
- .. method:: readline([size])
+ .. method:: peek([n])
- Return the next line from the file, as a byte string, retaining newline.
- A non-negative *size* argument limits the maximum number of bytes to
- return (an incomplete line may be returned then). Return an empty byte
- string at EOF.
+ Return buffered data without advancing the file position. At least one
+ byte of data will be returned (unless at EOF). The exact number of bytes
+ returned is unspecified.
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
- .. method:: readlines([size])
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.1
+ Support for the :keyword:`with` statement was added.
- Return a list of lines read. The optional *size* argument, if given, is an
- approximate bound on the total number of bytes in the lines returned.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The :meth:`fileno`, :meth:`readable`, :meth:`seekable`, :meth:`writable`,
+ :meth:`read1` and :meth:`readinto` methods were added.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *fileobj* argument to the constructor was added.
- .. method:: seek(offset[, whence])
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The ``'a'`` (append) mode was added, along with support for reading
+ multi-stream files.
- Move to new file position. Argument *offset* is a byte count. Optional
- argument *whence* defaults to ``os.SEEK_SET`` or ``0`` (offset from start
- of file; offset should be ``>= 0``); other values are ``os.SEEK_CUR`` or
- ``1`` (move relative to current position; offset can be positive or
- negative), and ``os.SEEK_END`` or ``2`` (move relative to end of file;
- offset is usually negative, although many platforms allow seeking beyond
- the end of a file).
- Note that seeking of bz2 files is emulated, and depending on the
- parameters the operation may be extremely slow.
+Incremental (de)compression
+---------------------------
+.. class:: BZ2Compressor(compresslevel=9)
- .. method:: tell()
+ Create a new compressor object. This object may be used to compress data
+ incrementally. For one-shot compression, use the :func:`compress` function
+ instead.
- Return the current file position, an integer.
+ *compresslevel*, if given, must be a number between ``1`` and ``9``. The
+ default is ``9``.
+ .. method:: compress(data)
- .. method:: write(data)
+ Provide data to the compressor object. Returns a chunk of compressed data
+ if possible, or an empty byte string otherwise.
- Write the byte string *data* to file. Note that due to buffering,
- :meth:`close` may be needed before the file on disk reflects the data
- written.
+ When you have finished providing data to the compressor, call the
+ :meth:`flush` method to finish the compression process.
- .. method:: writelines(sequence_of_byte_strings)
+ .. method:: flush()
- Write the sequence of byte strings to the file. Note that newlines are not
- added. The sequence can be any iterable object producing byte strings.
- This is equivalent to calling write() for each byte string.
+ Finish the compression process. Returns the compressed data left in
+ internal buffers.
+ The compressor object may not be used after this method has been called.
-Sequential (de)compression
---------------------------
-Sequential compression and decompression is done using the classes
-:class:`BZ2Compressor` and :class:`BZ2Decompressor`.
+.. class:: BZ2Decompressor()
+ Create a new decompressor object. This object may be used to decompress data
+ incrementally. For one-shot compression, use the :func:`decompress` function
+ instead.
-.. class:: BZ2Compressor(compresslevel=9)
+ .. note::
+ This class does not transparently handle inputs containing multiple
+ compressed streams, unlike :func:`decompress` and :class:`BZ2File`. If
+ you need to decompress a multi-stream input with :class:`BZ2Decompressor`,
+ you must use a new decompressor for each stream.
- Create a new compressor object. This object may be used to compress data
- sequentially. If you want to compress data in one shot, use the
- :func:`compress` function instead. The *compresslevel* parameter, if given,
- must be a number between ``1`` and ``9``; the default is ``9``.
+ .. method:: decompress(data)
- .. method:: compress(data)
+ Provide data to the decompressor object. Returns a chunk of decompressed
+ data if possible, or an empty byte string otherwise.
- Provide more data to the compressor object. It will return chunks of
- compressed data whenever possible. When you've finished providing data to
- compress, call the :meth:`flush` method to finish the compression process,
- and return what is left in internal buffers.
+ Attempting to decompress data after the end of the current stream is
+ reached raises an :exc:`EOFError`. If any data is found after the end of
+ the stream, it is ignored and saved in the :attr:`unused_data` attribute.
- .. method:: flush()
+ .. attribute:: eof
- Finish the compression process and return what is left in internal
- buffers. You must not use the compressor object after calling this method.
+ True if the end-of-stream marker has been reached.
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
-.. class:: BZ2Decompressor()
- Create a new decompressor object. This object may be used to decompress data
- sequentially. If you want to decompress data in one shot, use the
- :func:`decompress` function instead.
+ .. attribute:: unused_data
- .. method:: decompress(data)
+ Data found after the end of the compressed stream.
- Provide more data to the decompressor object. It will return chunks of
- decompressed data whenever possible. If you try to decompress data after
- the end of stream is found, :exc:`EOFError` will be raised. If any data
- was found after the end of stream, it'll be ignored and saved in
- :attr:`unused_data` attribute.
+ If this attribute is accessed before the end of the stream has been
+ reached, its value will be ``b''``.
One-shot (de)compression
------------------------
-One-shot compression and decompression is provided through the :func:`compress`
-and :func:`decompress` functions.
+.. function:: compress(data, compresslevel=9)
+ Compress *data*.
-.. function:: compress(data, compresslevel=9)
+ *compresslevel*, if given, must be a number between ``1`` and ``9``. The
+ default is ``9``.
- Compress *data* in one shot. If you want to compress data sequentially, use
- an instance of :class:`BZ2Compressor` instead. The *compresslevel* parameter,
- if given, must be a number between ``1`` and ``9``; the default is ``9``.
+ For incremental compression, use a :class:`BZ2Compressor` instead.
.. function:: decompress(data)
- Decompress *data* in one shot. If you want to decompress data sequentially,
- use an instance of :class:`BZ2Decompressor` instead.
+ Decompress *data*.
+
+ If *data* is the concatenation of multiple compressed streams, decompress
+ all of the streams.
+
+ For incremental decompression, use a :class:`BZ2Decompressor` instead.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Support for multi-stream inputs was added.
diff --git a/Doc/library/chunk.rst b/Doc/library/chunk.rst
index d3558a4..c1ba497 100644
--- a/Doc/library/chunk.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/chunk.rst
@@ -84,8 +84,9 @@ instance will fail with a :exc:`EOFError` exception.
Close and skip to the end of the chunk. This does not close the
underlying file.
- The remaining methods will raise :exc:`IOError` if called after the
- :meth:`close` method has been called.
+ The remaining methods will raise :exc:`OSError` if called after the
+ :meth:`close` method has been called. Before Python 3.3, they used to
+ raise :exc:`IOError`, now an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: isatty()
diff --git a/Doc/library/cmd.rst b/Doc/library/cmd.rst
index fd7f453..0c43bb8 100644
--- a/Doc/library/cmd.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/cmd.rst
@@ -285,8 +285,8 @@ immediate playback::
def do_playback(self, arg):
'Playback commands from a file: PLAYBACK rose.cmd'
self.close()
- cmds = open(arg).read().splitlines()
- self.cmdqueue.extend(cmds)
+ with open(arg) as f:
+ self.cmdqueue.extend(f.read().splitlines())
def precmd(self, line):
line = line.lower()
if self.file and 'playback' not in line:
diff --git a/Doc/library/codecs.rst b/Doc/library/codecs.rst
index 7747794..a9fae95 100644
--- a/Doc/library/codecs.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/codecs.rst
@@ -458,7 +458,8 @@ define in order to be compatible with the Python codec registry.
.. method:: reset()
- Reset the encoder to the initial state.
+ Reset the encoder to the initial state. The output is discarded: call
+ ``.encode('', final=True)`` to reset the encoder and to get the output.
.. method:: IncrementalEncoder.getstate()
@@ -786,11 +787,9 @@ methods and attributes from the underlying stream.
Encodings and Unicode
---------------------
-Strings are stored internally as sequences of codepoints (to be precise
-as :c:type:`Py_UNICODE` arrays). Depending on the way Python is compiled (either
-via ``--without-wide-unicode`` or ``--with-wide-unicode``, with the
-former being the default) :c:type:`Py_UNICODE` is either a 16-bit or 32-bit data
-type. Once a string object is used outside of CPU and memory, CPU endianness
+Strings are stored internally as sequences of codepoints in range ``0 - 10FFFF``
+(see :pep:`393` for more details about the implementation).
+Once a string object is used outside of CPU and memory, CPU endianness
and how these arrays are stored as bytes become an issue. Transforming a
string object into a sequence of bytes is called encoding and recreating the
string object from the sequence of bytes is known as decoding. There are many
@@ -901,6 +900,15 @@ is meant to be exhaustive. Notice that spelling alternatives that only differ in
case or use a hyphen instead of an underscore are also valid aliases; therefore,
e.g. ``'utf-8'`` is a valid alias for the ``'utf_8'`` codec.
+.. impl-detail::
+
+ Some common encodings can bypass the codecs lookup machinery to
+ improve performance. These optimization opportunities are only
+ recognized by CPython for a limited set of aliases: utf-8, utf8,
+ latin-1, latin1, iso-8859-1, mbcs (Windows only), ascii, utf-16,
+ and utf-32. Using alternative spellings for these encodings may
+ result in slower execution.
+
Many of the character sets support the same languages. They vary in individual
characters (e.g. whether the EURO SIGN is supported or not), and in the
assignment of characters to code positions. For the European languages in
@@ -1003,6 +1011,11 @@ particular, the following variants typically exist:
+-----------------+--------------------------------+--------------------------------+
| cp1258 | windows-1258 | Vietnamese |
+-----------------+--------------------------------+--------------------------------+
+| cp65001 | | Windows only: Windows UTF-8 |
+| | | (``CP_UTF8``) |
+| | | |
+| | | .. versionadded:: 3.3 |
++-----------------+--------------------------------+--------------------------------+
| euc_jp | eucjp, ujis, u-jis | Japanese |
+-----------------+--------------------------------+--------------------------------+
| euc_jis_2004 | jisx0213, eucjis2004 | Japanese |
@@ -1160,6 +1173,8 @@ particular, the following variants typically exist:
| unicode_internal | | Return the internal |
| | | representation of the |
| | | operand |
+| | | |
+| | | .. deprecated:: 3.3 |
+--------------------+---------+---------------------------+
The following codecs provide bytes-to-bytes mappings.
@@ -1272,12 +1287,13 @@ functions can be used directly if desired.
.. module:: encodings.mbcs
:synopsis: Windows ANSI codepage
-Encode operand according to the ANSI codepage (CP_ACP). This codec only
-supports ``'strict'`` and ``'replace'`` error handlers to encode, and
-``'strict'`` and ``'ignore'`` error handlers to decode.
+Encode operand according to the ANSI codepage (CP_ACP).
Availability: Windows only.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Support any error handler.
+
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Before 3.2, the *errors* argument was ignored; ``'replace'`` was always used
to encode, and ``'ignore'`` to decode.
diff --git a/Doc/library/collections.abc.rst b/Doc/library/collections.abc.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9873489
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/collections.abc.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,182 @@
+:mod:`collections.abc` --- Abstract Base Classes for Containers
+===============================================================
+
+.. module:: collections.abc
+ :synopsis: Abstract base classes for containers
+.. moduleauthor:: Raymond Hettinger <python at rcn.com>
+.. sectionauthor:: Raymond Hettinger <python at rcn.com>
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+ Formerly, this module was part of the :mod:`collections` module.
+
+.. testsetup:: *
+
+ from collections import *
+ import itertools
+ __name__ = '<doctest>'
+
+**Source code:** :source:`Lib/collections/abc.py`
+
+--------------
+
+This module provides :term:`abstract base classes <abstract base class>` that
+can be used to test whether a class provides a particular interface; for
+example, whether it is hashable or whether it is a mapping.
+
+
+.. _collections-abstract-base-classes:
+
+Collections Abstract Base Classes
+---------------------------------
+
+The collections module offers the following :term:`ABCs <abstract base class>`:
+
+========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
+ABC Inherits from Abstract Methods Mixin Methods
+========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
+:class:`Container` ``__contains__``
+:class:`Hashable` ``__hash__``
+:class:`Iterable` ``__iter__``
+:class:`Iterator` :class:`Iterable` ``__next__`` ``__iter__``
+:class:`Sized` ``__len__``
+:class:`Callable` ``__call__``
+
+:class:`Sequence` :class:`Sized`, ``__getitem__`` ``__contains__``, ``__iter__``, ``__reversed__``,
+ :class:`Iterable`, ``index``, and ``count``
+ :class:`Container`
+
+:class:`MutableSequence` :class:`Sequence` ``__setitem__``, Inherited :class:`Sequence` methods and
+ ``__delitem__``, ``append``, ``reverse``, ``extend``, ``pop``,
+ ``insert`` ``remove``, ``clear``, and ``__iadd__``
+
+:class:`Set` :class:`Sized`, ``__le__``, ``__lt__``, ``__eq__``, ``__ne__``,
+ :class:`Iterable`, ``__gt__``, ``__ge__``, ``__and__``, ``__or__``,
+ :class:`Container` ``__sub__``, ``__xor__``, and ``isdisjoint``
+
+:class:`MutableSet` :class:`Set` ``add``, Inherited :class:`Set` methods and
+ ``discard`` ``clear``, ``pop``, ``remove``, ``__ior__``,
+ ``__iand__``, ``__ixor__``, and ``__isub__``
+
+:class:`Mapping` :class:`Sized`, ``__getitem__`` ``__contains__``, ``keys``, ``items``, ``values``,
+ :class:`Iterable`, ``get``, ``__eq__``, and ``__ne__``
+ :class:`Container`
+
+:class:`MutableMapping` :class:`Mapping` ``__setitem__``, Inherited :class:`Mapping` methods and
+ ``__delitem__`` ``pop``, ``popitem``, ``clear``, ``update``,
+ and ``setdefault``
+
+
+:class:`MappingView` :class:`Sized` ``__len__``
+:class:`ItemsView` :class:`MappingView`, ``__contains__``,
+ :class:`Set` ``__iter__``
+:class:`KeysView` :class:`MappingView`, ``__contains__``,
+ :class:`Set` ``__iter__``
+:class:`ValuesView` :class:`MappingView` ``__contains__``, ``__iter__``
+========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
+
+
+.. class:: Container
+ Hashable
+ Sized
+ Callable
+
+ ABCs for classes that provide respectively the methods :meth:`__contains__`,
+ :meth:`__hash__`, :meth:`__len__`, and :meth:`__call__`.
+
+.. class:: Iterable
+
+ ABC for classes that provide the :meth:`__iter__` method.
+ See also the definition of :term:`iterable`.
+
+.. class:: Iterator
+
+ ABC for classes that provide the :meth:`__iter__` and :meth:`next` methods.
+ See also the definition of :term:`iterator`.
+
+.. class:: Sequence
+ MutableSequence
+
+ ABCs for read-only and mutable :term:`sequences <sequence>`.
+
+.. class:: Set
+ MutableSet
+
+ ABCs for read-only and mutable sets.
+
+.. class:: Mapping
+ MutableMapping
+
+ ABCs for read-only and mutable :term:`mappings <mapping>`.
+
+.. class:: MappingView
+ ItemsView
+ KeysView
+ ValuesView
+
+ ABCs for mapping, items, keys, and values :term:`views <view>`.
+
+
+These ABCs allow us to ask classes or instances if they provide
+particular functionality, for example::
+
+ size = None
+ if isinstance(myvar, collections.Sized):
+ size = len(myvar)
+
+Several of the ABCs are also useful as mixins that make it easier to develop
+classes supporting container APIs. For example, to write a class supporting
+the full :class:`Set` API, it only necessary to supply the three underlying
+abstract methods: :meth:`__contains__`, :meth:`__iter__`, and :meth:`__len__`.
+The ABC supplies the remaining methods such as :meth:`__and__` and
+:meth:`isdisjoint` ::
+
+ class ListBasedSet(collections.Set):
+ ''' Alternate set implementation favoring space over speed
+ and not requiring the set elements to be hashable. '''
+ def __init__(self, iterable):
+ self.elements = lst = []
+ for value in iterable:
+ if value not in lst:
+ lst.append(value)
+ def __iter__(self):
+ return iter(self.elements)
+ def __contains__(self, value):
+ return value in self.elements
+ def __len__(self):
+ return len(self.elements)
+
+ s1 = ListBasedSet('abcdef')
+ s2 = ListBasedSet('defghi')
+ overlap = s1 & s2 # The __and__() method is supported automatically
+
+Notes on using :class:`Set` and :class:`MutableSet` as a mixin:
+
+(1)
+ Since some set operations create new sets, the default mixin methods need
+ a way to create new instances from an iterable. The class constructor is
+ assumed to have a signature in the form ``ClassName(iterable)``.
+ That assumption is factored-out to an internal classmethod called
+ :meth:`_from_iterable` which calls ``cls(iterable)`` to produce a new set.
+ If the :class:`Set` mixin is being used in a class with a different
+ constructor signature, you will need to override :meth:`_from_iterable`
+ with a classmethod that can construct new instances from
+ an iterable argument.
+
+(2)
+ To override the comparisons (presumably for speed, as the
+ semantics are fixed), redefine :meth:`__le__` and
+ then the other operations will automatically follow suit.
+
+(3)
+ The :class:`Set` mixin provides a :meth:`_hash` method to compute a hash value
+ for the set; however, :meth:`__hash__` is not defined because not all sets
+ are hashable or immutable. To add set hashabilty using mixins,
+ inherit from both :meth:`Set` and :meth:`Hashable`, then define
+ ``__hash__ = Set._hash``.
+
+.. seealso::
+
+ * `OrderedSet recipe <http://code.activestate.com/recipes/576694/>`_ for an
+ example built on :class:`MutableSet`.
+
+ * For more about ABCs, see the :mod:`abc` module and :pep:`3119`.
diff --git a/Doc/library/collections.rst b/Doc/library/collections.rst
index e90b25e..188fd0a 100644
--- a/Doc/library/collections.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/collections.rst
@@ -12,7 +12,7 @@
import itertools
__name__ = '<doctest>'
-**Source code:** :source:`Lib/collections.py` and :source:`Lib/_abcoll.py`
+**Source code:** :source:`Lib/collections/__init__.py`
--------------
@@ -23,6 +23,7 @@ Python's general purpose built-in containers, :class:`dict`, :class:`list`,
===================== ====================================================================
:func:`namedtuple` factory function for creating tuple subclasses with named fields
:class:`deque` list-like container with fast appends and pops on either end
+:class:`ChainMap` dict-like class for creating a single view of multiple mappings
:class:`Counter` dict subclass for counting hashable objects
:class:`OrderedDict` dict subclass that remembers the order entries were added
:class:`defaultdict` dict subclass that calls a factory function to supply missing values
@@ -31,12 +32,125 @@ Python's general purpose built-in containers, :class:`dict`, :class:`list`,
:class:`UserString` wrapper around string objects for easier string subclassing
===================== ====================================================================
-In addition to the concrete container classes, the collections module provides
-:ref:`abstract base classes <collections-abstract-base-classes>` that can be
-used to test whether a class provides a particular interface, for example,
-whether it is hashable or a mapping.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Moved :ref:`collections-abstract-base-classes` to the :mod:`collections.abc` module.
+ For backwards compatibility, they continue to be visible in this module
+ as well.
+:class:`ChainMap` objects
+-------------------------
+
+A :class:`ChainMap` class is provided for quickly linking a number of mappings
+so they can be treated as a single unit. It is often much faster than creating
+a new dictionary and running multiple :meth:`~dict.update` calls.
+
+The class can be used to simulate nested scopes and is useful in templating.
+
+.. class:: ChainMap(*maps)
+
+ A :class:`ChainMap` groups multiple dicts or other mappings together to
+ create a single, updateable view. If no *maps* are specified, a single empty
+ dictionary is provided so that a new chain always has at least one mapping.
+
+ The underlying mappings are stored in a list. That list is public and can
+ accessed or updated using the *maps* attribute. There is no other state.
+
+ Lookups search the underlying mappings successively until a key is found. In
+ contrast, writes, updates, and deletions only operate on the first mapping.
+
+ A :class:`ChainMap` incorporates the underlying mappings by reference. So, if
+ one of the underlying mappings gets updated, those changes will be reflected
+ in :class:`ChainMap`.
+
+ All of the usual dictionary methods are supported. In addition, there is a
+ *maps* attribute, a method for creating new subcontexts, and a property for
+ accessing all but the first mapping:
+
+ .. attribute:: maps
+
+ A user updateable list of mappings. The list is ordered from
+ first-searched to last-searched. It is the only stored state and can
+ be modified to change which mappings are searched. The list should
+ always contain at least one mapping.
+
+ .. method:: new_child()
+
+ Returns a new :class:`ChainMap` containing a new :class:`dict` followed by
+ all of the maps in the current instance. A call to ``d.new_child()`` is
+ equivalent to: ``ChainMap({}, *d.maps)``. This method is used for
+ creating subcontexts that can be updated without altering values in any
+ of the parent mappings.
+
+ .. method:: parents()
+
+ Returns a new :class:`ChainMap` containing all of the maps in the current
+ instance except the first one. This is useful for skipping the first map
+ in the search. The use-cases are similar to those for the
+ :keyword:`nonlocal` keyword used in :term:`nested scopes <nested scope>`.
+ The use-cases also parallel those for the builtin :func:`super` function.
+ A reference to ``d.parents`` is equivalent to: ``ChainMap(*d.maps[1:])``.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ Example of simulating Python's internal lookup chain::
+
+ import builtins
+ pylookup = ChainMap(locals(), globals(), vars(builtins))
+
+ Example of letting user specified values take precedence over environment
+ variables which in turn take precedence over default values::
+
+ import os, argparse
+ defaults = {'color': 'red', 'user': guest}
+ parser = argparse.ArgumentParser()
+ parser.add_argument('-u', '--user')
+ parser.add_argument('-c', '--color')
+ user_specified = vars(parser.parse_args())
+ combined = ChainMap(user_specified, os.environ, defaults)
+
+ Example patterns for using the :class:`ChainMap` class to simulate nested
+ contexts::
+
+ c = ChainMap() Create root context
+ d = c.new_child() Create nested child context
+ e = c.new_child() Child of c, independent from d
+ e.maps[0] Current context dictionary -- like Python's locals()
+ e.maps[-1] Root context -- like Python's globals()
+ e.parents Enclosing context chain -- like Python's nonlocals
+
+ d['x'] Get first key in the chain of contexts
+ d['x'] = 1 Set value in current context
+ del['x'] Delete from current context
+ list(d) All nested values
+ k in d Check all nested values
+ len(d) Number of nested values
+ d.items() All nested items
+ dict(d) Flatten into a regular dictionary
+
+ .. seealso::
+
+ * The `MultiContext class
+ <http://svn.enthought.com/svn/enthought/CodeTools/trunk/enthought/contexts/multi_context.py>`_
+ in the Enthought `CodeTools package
+ <https://github.com/enthought/codetools>`_ has options to support
+ writing to any mapping in the chain.
+
+ * Django's `Context class
+ <http://code.djangoproject.com/browser/django/trunk/django/template/context.py>`_
+ for templating is a read-only chain of mappings. It also features
+ pushing and popping of contexts similar to the
+ :meth:`~collections.ChainMap.new_child` method and the
+ :meth:`~collections.ChainMap.parents` property.
+
+ * The `Nested Contexts recipe
+ <http://code.activestate.com/recipes/577434/>`_ has options to control
+ whether writes and other mutations apply only to the first mapping or to
+ any mapping in the chain.
+
+ * A `greatly simplified read-only version of Chainmap
+ <http://code.activestate.com/recipes/305268/>`_.
+
:class:`Counter` objects
------------------------
@@ -149,7 +263,7 @@ Common patterns for working with :class:`Counter` objects::
c.items() # convert to a list of (elem, cnt) pairs
Counter(dict(list_of_pairs)) # convert from a list of (elem, cnt) pairs
c.most_common()[:-n:-1] # n least common elements
- c += Counter() # remove zero and negative counts
+ +c # remove zero and negative counts
Several mathematical operations are provided for combining :class:`Counter`
objects to produce multisets (counters that have counts greater than zero).
@@ -169,6 +283,18 @@ counts, but the output will exclude results with counts of zero or less.
>>> c | d # union: max(c[x], d[x])
Counter({'a': 3, 'b': 2})
+Unary addition and substraction are shortcuts for adding an empty counter
+or subtracting from an empty counter.
+
+ >>> c = Counter(a=2, b=-4)
+ >>> +c
+ Counter({'a': 2})
+ >>> -c
+ Counter({'b': 4})
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+ Added support for unary plus, unary minus, and in-place multiset operations.
+
.. note::
Counters were primarily designed to work with positive integers to represent
@@ -398,7 +524,8 @@ in Unix::
def tail(filename, n=10):
'Return the last n lines of a file'
- return deque(open(filename), n)
+ with open(filename) as f:
+ return deque(f, n)
Another approach to using deques is to maintain a sequence of recently
added elements by appending to the right and popping to the left::
@@ -550,7 +677,7 @@ Setting the :attr:`default_factory` to :class:`set` makes the
... d[k].add(v)
...
>>> list(d.items())
- [('blue', set([2, 4])), ('red', set([1, 3]))]
+ [('blue', {2, 4}), ('red', {1, 3})]
:func:`namedtuple` Factory Function for Tuples with Named Fields
@@ -583,7 +710,9 @@ they add the ability to access fields by name instead of position index.
converted to ``['abc', '_1', 'ghi', '_3']``, eliminating the keyword
``def`` and the duplicate fieldname ``abc``.
- If *verbose* is true, the class definition is printed just before being built.
+ If *verbose* is true, the class definition is printed after it is
+ built. This option is outdated; instead, it is simpler to print the
+ :attr:`_source` attribute.
Named tuple instances do not have per-instance dictionaries, so they are
lightweight and require no more memory than regular tuples.
@@ -597,53 +726,6 @@ they add the ability to access fields by name instead of position index.
>>> # Basic example
>>> Point = namedtuple('Point', ['x', 'y'])
- >>> p = Point(x=10, y=11)
-
- >>> # Example using the verbose option to print the class definition
- >>> Point = namedtuple('Point', 'x y', verbose=True)
- class Point(tuple):
- 'Point(x, y)'
- <BLANKLINE>
- __slots__ = ()
- <BLANKLINE>
- _fields = ('x', 'y')
- <BLANKLINE>
- def __new__(_cls, x, y):
- 'Create a new instance of Point(x, y)'
- return _tuple.__new__(_cls, (x, y))
- <BLANKLINE>
- @classmethod
- def _make(cls, iterable, new=tuple.__new__, len=len):
- 'Make a new Point object from a sequence or iterable'
- result = new(cls, iterable)
- if len(result) != 2:
- raise TypeError('Expected 2 arguments, got %d' % len(result))
- return result
- <BLANKLINE>
- def __repr__(self):
- 'Return a nicely formatted representation string'
- return self.__class__.__name__ + '(x=%r, y=%r)' % self
- <BLANKLINE>
- def _asdict(self):
- 'Return a new OrderedDict which maps field names to their values'
- return OrderedDict(zip(self._fields, self))
- <BLANKLINE>
- __dict__ = property(_asdict)
- <BLANKLINE>
- def _replace(_self, **kwds):
- 'Return a new Point object replacing specified fields with new values'
- result = _self._make(map(kwds.pop, ('x', 'y'), _self))
- if kwds:
- raise ValueError('Got unexpected field names: %r' % list(kwds.keys()))
- return result
- <BLANKLINE>
- def __getnewargs__(self):
- 'Return self as a plain tuple. Used by copy and pickle.'
- return tuple(self)
- <BLANKLINE>
- x = _property(_itemgetter(0), doc='Alias for field number 0')
- y = _property(_itemgetter(1), doc='Alias for field number 1')
-
>>> p = Point(11, y=22) # instantiate with positional or keyword arguments
>>> p[0] + p[1] # indexable like the plain tuple (11, 22)
33
@@ -672,7 +754,7 @@ by the :mod:`csv` or :mod:`sqlite3` modules::
print(emp.name, emp.title)
In addition to the methods inherited from tuples, named tuples support
-three additional methods and one attribute. To prevent conflicts with
+three additional methods and two attributes. To prevent conflicts with
field names, the method and attribute names start with an underscore.
.. classmethod:: somenamedtuple._make(iterable)
@@ -710,6 +792,15 @@ field names, the method and attribute names start with an underscore.
>>> for partnum, record in inventory.items():
... inventory[partnum] = record._replace(price=newprices[partnum], timestamp=time.now())
+.. attribute:: somenamedtuple._source
+
+ A string with the pure Python source code used to create the named
+ tuple class. The source makes the named tuple self-documenting.
+ It can be printed, executed using :func:`exec`, or saved to a file
+ and imported.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. attribute:: somenamedtuple._fields
Tuple of strings listing the field names. Useful for introspection
@@ -758,7 +849,6 @@ a fixed-width print format:
The subclass shown above sets ``__slots__`` to an empty tuple. This helps
keep memory requirements low by preventing the creation of instance dictionaries.
-
Subclassing is not useful for adding new, stored fields. Instead, simply
create a new named tuple type from the :attr:`_fields` attribute:
@@ -770,6 +860,7 @@ customize a prototype instance:
>>> Account = namedtuple('Account', 'owner balance transaction_count')
>>> default_account = Account('<owner name>', 0.0, 0)
>>> johns_account = default_account._replace(owner='John')
+ >>> janes_account = default_account._replace(owner='Jane')
Enumerated constants can be implemented with named tuples, but it is simpler
and more efficient to use a simple class declaration:
@@ -988,161 +1079,3 @@ attribute.
be an instance of :class:`bytes`, :class:`str`, :class:`UserString` (or a
subclass) or an arbitrary sequence which can be converted into a string using
the built-in :func:`str` function.
-
-
-.. _collections-abstract-base-classes:
-
-ABCs - abstract base classes
-----------------------------
-
-The collections module offers the following :term:`ABCs <abstract base class>`:
-
-========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
-ABC Inherits from Abstract Methods Mixin Methods
-========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
-:class:`Container` ``__contains__``
-:class:`Hashable` ``__hash__``
-:class:`Iterable` ``__iter__``
-:class:`Iterator` :class:`Iterable` ``__next__`` ``__iter__``
-:class:`Sized` ``__len__``
-:class:`Callable` ``__call__``
-
-:class:`Sequence` :class:`Sized`, ``__getitem__`` ``__contains__``, ``__iter__``, ``__reversed__``,
- :class:`Iterable`, ``index``, and ``count``
- :class:`Container`
-
-:class:`MutableSequence` :class:`Sequence` ``__setitem__``, Inherited :class:`Sequence` methods and
- ``__delitem__``, ``append``, ``reverse``, ``extend``, ``pop``,
- ``insert`` ``remove``, and ``__iadd__``
-
-:class:`Set` :class:`Sized`, ``__le__``, ``__lt__``, ``__eq__``, ``__ne__``,
- :class:`Iterable`, ``__gt__``, ``__ge__``, ``__and__``, ``__or__``,
- :class:`Container` ``__sub__``, ``__xor__``, and ``isdisjoint``
-
-:class:`MutableSet` :class:`Set` ``add``, Inherited :class:`Set` methods and
- ``discard`` ``clear``, ``pop``, ``remove``, ``__ior__``,
- ``__iand__``, ``__ixor__``, and ``__isub__``
-
-:class:`Mapping` :class:`Sized`, ``__getitem__`` ``__contains__``, ``keys``, ``items``, ``values``,
- :class:`Iterable`, ``get``, ``__eq__``, and ``__ne__``
- :class:`Container`
-
-:class:`MutableMapping` :class:`Mapping` ``__setitem__``, Inherited :class:`Mapping` methods and
- ``__delitem__`` ``pop``, ``popitem``, ``clear``, ``update``,
- and ``setdefault``
-
-
-:class:`MappingView` :class:`Sized` ``__len__``
-:class:`ItemsView` :class:`MappingView`, ``__contains__``,
- :class:`Set` ``__iter__``
-:class:`KeysView` :class:`MappingView`, ``__contains__``,
- :class:`Set` ``__iter__``
-:class:`ValuesView` :class:`MappingView` ``__contains__``, ``__iter__``
-========================= ===================== ====================== ====================================================
-
-
-.. class:: Container
- Hashable
- Sized
- Callable
-
- ABCs for classes that provide respectively the methods :meth:`__contains__`,
- :meth:`__hash__`, :meth:`__len__`, and :meth:`__call__`.
-
-.. class:: Iterable
-
- ABC for classes that provide the :meth:`__iter__` method.
- See also the definition of :term:`iterable`.
-
-.. class:: Iterator
-
- ABC for classes that provide the :meth:`__iter__` and :meth:`next` methods.
- See also the definition of :term:`iterator`.
-
-.. class:: Sequence
- MutableSequence
-
- ABCs for read-only and mutable :term:`sequences <sequence>`.
-
-.. class:: Set
- MutableSet
-
- ABCs for read-only and mutable sets.
-
-.. class:: Mapping
- MutableMapping
-
- ABCs for read-only and mutable :term:`mappings <mapping>`.
-
-.. class:: MappingView
- ItemsView
- KeysView
- ValuesView
-
- ABCs for mapping, items, keys, and values :term:`views <view>`.
-
-
-These ABCs allow us to ask classes or instances if they provide
-particular functionality, for example::
-
- size = None
- if isinstance(myvar, collections.Sized):
- size = len(myvar)
-
-Several of the ABCs are also useful as mixins that make it easier to develop
-classes supporting container APIs. For example, to write a class supporting
-the full :class:`Set` API, it only necessary to supply the three underlying
-abstract methods: :meth:`__contains__`, :meth:`__iter__`, and :meth:`__len__`.
-The ABC supplies the remaining methods such as :meth:`__and__` and
-:meth:`isdisjoint` ::
-
- class ListBasedSet(collections.Set):
- ''' Alternate set implementation favoring space over speed
- and not requiring the set elements to be hashable. '''
- def __init__(self, iterable):
- self.elements = lst = []
- for value in iterable:
- if value not in lst:
- lst.append(value)
- def __iter__(self):
- return iter(self.elements)
- def __contains__(self, value):
- return value in self.elements
- def __len__(self):
- return len(self.elements)
-
- s1 = ListBasedSet('abcdef')
- s2 = ListBasedSet('defghi')
- overlap = s1 & s2 # The __and__() method is supported automatically
-
-Notes on using :class:`Set` and :class:`MutableSet` as a mixin:
-
-(1)
- Since some set operations create new sets, the default mixin methods need
- a way to create new instances from an iterable. The class constructor is
- assumed to have a signature in the form ``ClassName(iterable)``.
- That assumption is factored-out to an internal classmethod called
- :meth:`_from_iterable` which calls ``cls(iterable)`` to produce a new set.
- If the :class:`Set` mixin is being used in a class with a different
- constructor signature, you will need to override :meth:`_from_iterable`
- with a classmethod that can construct new instances from
- an iterable argument.
-
-(2)
- To override the comparisons (presumably for speed, as the
- semantics are fixed), redefine :meth:`__le__` and
- then the other operations will automatically follow suit.
-
-(3)
- The :class:`Set` mixin provides a :meth:`_hash` method to compute a hash value
- for the set; however, :meth:`__hash__` is not defined because not all sets
- are hashable or immutable. To add set hashabilty using mixins,
- inherit from both :meth:`Set` and :meth:`Hashable`, then define
- ``__hash__ = Set._hash``.
-
-.. seealso::
-
- * `OrderedSet recipe <http://code.activestate.com/recipes/576694/>`_ for an
- example built on :class:`MutableSet`.
-
- * For more about ABCs, see the :mod:`abc` module and :pep:`3119`.
diff --git a/Doc/library/concurrent.futures.rst b/Doc/library/concurrent.futures.rst
index 29ffc0d..a88f10c 100644
--- a/Doc/library/concurrent.futures.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/concurrent.futures.rst
@@ -169,6 +169,12 @@ to a :class:`ProcessPoolExecutor` will result in deadlock.
of at most *max_workers* processes. If *max_workers* is ``None`` or not
given, it will default to the number of processors on the machine.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ When one of the worker processes terminates abruptly, a
+ :exc:`BrokenProcessPool` error is now raised. Previously, behaviour
+ was undefined but operations on the executor or its futures would often
+ freeze or deadlock.
+
.. _processpoolexecutor-example:
@@ -369,3 +375,16 @@ Module Functions
:pep:`3148` -- futures - execute computations asynchronously
The proposal which described this feature for inclusion in the Python
standard library.
+
+
+Exception classes
+-----------------
+
+.. exception:: BrokenProcessPool
+
+ Derived from :exc:`RuntimeError`, this exception class is raised when
+ one of the workers of a :class:`ProcessPoolExecutor` has terminated
+ in a non-clean fashion (for example, if it was killed from the outside).
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
diff --git a/Doc/library/crypt.rst b/Doc/library/crypt.rst
index 0be571e..1ba2ed3 100644
--- a/Doc/library/crypt.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/crypt.rst
@@ -15,9 +15,9 @@
This module implements an interface to the :manpage:`crypt(3)` routine, which is
a one-way hash function based upon a modified DES algorithm; see the Unix man
-page for further details. Possible uses include allowing Python scripts to
-accept typed passwords from the user, or attempting to crack Unix passwords with
-a dictionary.
+page for further details. Possible uses include storing hashed passwords
+so you can check passwords without storing the actual password, or attempting
+to crack Unix passwords with a dictionary.
.. index:: single: crypt(3)
@@ -26,15 +26,74 @@ the :manpage:`crypt(3)` routine in the running system. Therefore, any
extensions available on the current implementation will also be available on
this module.
+Hashing Methods
+---------------
-.. function:: crypt(word, salt)
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+The :mod:`crypt` module defines the list of hashing methods (not all methods
+are available on all platforms):
+
+.. data:: METHOD_SHA512
+
+ A Modular Crypt Format method with 16 character salt and 86 character
+ hash. This is the strongest method.
+
+.. data:: METHOD_SHA256
+
+ Another Modular Crypt Format method with 16 character salt and 43
+ character hash.
+
+.. data:: METHOD_MD5
+
+ Another Modular Crypt Format method with 8 character salt and 22
+ character hash.
+
+.. data:: METHOD_CRYPT
+
+ The traditional method with a 2 character salt and 13 characters of
+ hash. This is the weakest method.
+
+
+Module Attributes
+-----------------
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. attribute:: methods
+
+ A list of available password hashing algorithms, as
+ ``crypt.METHOD_*`` objects. This list is sorted from strongest to
+ weakest, and is guaranteed to have at least ``crypt.METHOD_CRYPT``.
+
+
+Module Functions
+----------------
+
+The :mod:`crypt` module defines the following functions:
+
+.. function:: crypt(word, salt=None)
*word* will usually be a user's password as typed at a prompt or in a graphical
- interface. *salt* is usually a random two-character string which will be used
- to perturb the DES algorithm in one of 4096 ways. The characters in *salt* must
- be in the set ``[./a-zA-Z0-9]``. Returns the hashed password as a string, which
- will be composed of characters from the same alphabet as the salt (the first two
- characters represent the salt itself).
+ interface. The optional *salt* is either a string as returned from
+ :func:`mksalt`, one of the ``crypt.METHOD_*`` values (though not all
+ may be available on all platforms), or a full encrypted password
+ including salt, as returned by this function. If *salt* is not
+ provided, the strongest method will be used (as returned by
+ :func:`methods`.
+
+ Checking a password is usually done by passing the plain-text password
+ as *word* and the full results of a previous :func:`crypt` call,
+ which should be the same as the results of this call.
+
+ *salt* (either a random 2 or 16 character string, possibly prefixed with
+ ``$digit$`` to indicate the method) which will be used to perturb the
+ encryption algorithm. The characters in *salt* must be in the set
+ ``[./a-zA-Z0-9]``, with the exception of Modular Crypt Format which
+ prefixes a ``$digit$``.
+
+ Returns the hashed password as a string, which will be composed of
+ characters from the same alphabet as the salt.
.. index:: single: crypt(3)
@@ -42,18 +101,48 @@ this module.
different sizes in the *salt*, it is recommended to use the full crypted
password as salt when checking for a password.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Accept ``crypt.METHOD_*`` values in addition to strings for *salt*.
+
+
+.. function:: mksalt(method=None)
+
+ Return a randomly generated salt of the specified method. If no
+ *method* is given, the strongest method available as returned by
+ :func:`methods` is used.
+
+ The return value is a string either of 2 characters in length for
+ ``crypt.METHOD_CRYPT``, or 19 characters starting with ``$digit$`` and
+ 16 random characters from the set ``[./a-zA-Z0-9]``, suitable for
+ passing as the *salt* argument to :func:`crypt`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+Examples
+--------
+
A simple example illustrating typical use::
- import crypt, getpass, pwd
+ import pwd
+ import crypt
+ import getpass
def login():
- username = input('Python login:')
+ username = input('Python login: ')
cryptedpasswd = pwd.getpwnam(username)[1]
if cryptedpasswd:
if cryptedpasswd == 'x' or cryptedpasswd == '*':
- raise "Sorry, currently no support for shadow passwords"
+ raise ValueError('no support for shadow passwords')
cleartext = getpass.getpass()
return crypt.crypt(cleartext, cryptedpasswd) == cryptedpasswd
else:
- return 1
+ return True
+
+To generate a hash of a password using the strongest available method and
+check it against the original::
+
+ import crypt
+ hashed = crypt.crypt(plaintext)
+ if hashed != crypt.crypt(plaintext, hashed):
+ raise ValueError("hashed version doesn't validate against original")
diff --git a/Doc/library/csv.rst b/Doc/library/csv.rst
index edbe726..ec0dfcc 100644
--- a/Doc/library/csv.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/csv.rst
@@ -11,15 +11,15 @@
pair: data; tabular
The so-called CSV (Comma Separated Values) format is the most common import and
-export format for spreadsheets and databases. There is no "CSV standard", so
-the format is operationally defined by the many applications which read and
-write it. The lack of a standard means that subtle differences often exist in
-the data produced and consumed by different applications. These differences can
-make it annoying to process CSV files from multiple sources. Still, while the
-delimiters and quoting characters vary, the overall format is similar enough
-that it is possible to write a single module which can efficiently manipulate
-such data, hiding the details of reading and writing the data from the
-programmer.
+export format for spreadsheets and databases. CSV format was used for many
+years prior to attempts to describe the format in a standardized way in
+:rfc:`4180`. The lack of a well-defined standard means that subtle differences
+often exist in the data produced and consumed by different applications. These
+differences can make it annoying to process CSV files from multiple sources.
+Still, while the delimiters and quoting characters vary, the overall format is
+similar enough that it is possible to write a single module which can
+efficiently manipulate such data, hiding the details of reading and writing the
+data from the programmer.
The :mod:`csv` module implements classes to read and write tabular data in CSV
format. It allows programmers to say, "write this data in the format preferred
diff --git a/Doc/library/ctypes.rst b/Doc/library/ctypes.rst
index df39c28..44f8c20 100644
--- a/Doc/library/ctypes.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/ctypes.rst
@@ -39,9 +39,14 @@ loads libraries which export functions using the standard ``cdecl`` calling
convention, while *windll* libraries call functions using the ``stdcall``
calling convention. *oledll* also uses the ``stdcall`` calling convention, and
assumes the functions return a Windows :c:type:`HRESULT` error code. The error
-code is used to automatically raise a :class:`WindowsError` exception when the
+code is used to automatically raise a :class:`OSError` exception when the
function call fails.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Windows errors used to raise :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an alias
+ of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+
Here are some examples for Windows. Note that ``msvcrt`` is the MS standard C
library containing most standard C functions, and uses the cdecl calling
convention::
@@ -189,7 +194,7 @@ argument values::
>>> windll.kernel32.GetModuleHandleA(32) # doctest: +WINDOWS
Traceback (most recent call last):
File "<stdin>", line 1, in ?
- WindowsError: exception: access violation reading 0x00000020
+ OSError: exception: access violation reading 0x00000020
>>>
There are, however, enough ways to crash Python with :mod:`ctypes`, so you
@@ -491,7 +496,7 @@ useful to check for error return values and automatically raise an exception::
Traceback (most recent call last):
File "<stdin>", line 1, in ?
File "<stdin>", line 3, in ValidHandle
- WindowsError: [Errno 126] The specified module could not be found.
+ OSError: [Errno 126] The specified module could not be found.
>>>
``WinError`` is a function which will call Windows ``FormatMessage()`` api to
@@ -1345,7 +1350,10 @@ way is to instantiate one of the following classes:
assumed to return the windows specific :class:`HRESULT` code. :class:`HRESULT`
values contain information specifying whether the function call failed or
succeeded, together with additional error code. If the return value signals a
- failure, an :class:`WindowsError` is automatically raised.
+ failure, an :class:`OSError` is automatically raised.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`WindowsError` used to be raised.
.. class:: WinDLL(name, mode=DEFAULT_MODE, handle=None, use_errno=False, use_last_error=False)
@@ -1962,11 +1970,14 @@ Utility functions
.. function:: WinError(code=None, descr=None)
Windows only: this function is probably the worst-named thing in ctypes. It
- creates an instance of WindowsError. If *code* is not specified,
+ creates an instance of OSError. If *code* is not specified,
``GetLastError`` is called to determine the error code. If *descr* is not
specified, :func:`FormatError` is called to get a textual description of the
error.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ An instance of :exc:`WindowsError` used to be created.
+
.. function:: wstring_at(address, size=-1)
diff --git a/Doc/library/curses.rst b/Doc/library/curses.rst
index f31b9c5..ff3a793 100644
--- a/Doc/library/curses.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/curses.rst
@@ -598,6 +598,17 @@ The module :mod:`curses` defines the following functions:
Only one *ch* can be pushed before :meth:`getch` is called.
+.. function:: unget_wch(ch)
+
+ Push *ch* so the next :meth:`get_wch` will return it.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Only one *ch* can be pushed before :meth:`get_wch` is called.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: ungetmouse(id, x, y, z, bstate)
Push a :const:`KEY_MOUSE` event onto the input queue, associating the given
@@ -642,7 +653,7 @@ Window Objects
--------------
Window objects, as returned by :func:`initscr` and :func:`newwin` above, have
-the following methods:
+the following methods and attributes:
.. method:: window.addch([y, x,] ch[, attr])
@@ -823,6 +834,16 @@ the following methods:
event.
+.. attribute:: window.encoding
+
+ Encoding used to encode method arguments (Unicode strings and characters).
+ The encoding attribute is inherited from by parent window when a subwindow
+ is created, for example with :meth:`window.subwin`. By default, the locale
+ encoding is used (see :func:`locale.getpreferredencoding`).
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: window.erase()
Clear the window.
@@ -846,6 +867,14 @@ the following methods:
until a key is pressed.
+.. method:: window.get_wch([y, x])
+
+ Get a wide character. Like :meth:`getch`, but the integer returned is the
+ Unicode code point for the key pressed, so it can be passed to :func:`chr`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: window.getkey([y, x])
Get a character, returning a string instead of an integer, as :meth:`getch`
diff --git a/Doc/library/datatypes.rst b/Doc/library/datatypes.rst
index 6b4a71a..8e33c1f 100644
--- a/Doc/library/datatypes.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/datatypes.rst
@@ -21,6 +21,7 @@ The following modules are documented in this chapter:
datetime.rst
calendar.rst
collections.rst
+ collections.abc.rst
heapq.rst
bisect.rst
array.rst
diff --git a/Doc/library/datetime.rst b/Doc/library/datetime.rst
index 1f4cfba..a6c1997 100644
--- a/Doc/library/datetime.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/datetime.rst
@@ -721,6 +721,22 @@ Other constructors, all class methods:
It's common for this to be restricted to years in 1970 through 2038. See also
:meth:`fromtimestamp`.
+ On the POSIX compliant platforms, ``utcfromtimestamp(timestamp)``
+ is equivalent to the following expression::
+
+ datetime(1970, 1, 1) + timedelta(seconds=timestamp)
+
+ There is no method to obtain the timestamp from a :class:`datetime`
+ instance, but POSIX timestamp corresponding to a :class:`datetime`
+ instance ``dt`` can be easily calculated as follows. For a naive
+ ``dt``::
+
+ timestamp = (dt - datetime(1970, 1, 1)) / timedelta(seconds=1)
+
+ And for an aware ``dt``::
+
+ timestamp = (dt - datetime(1970, 1, 1, tzinfo=timezone.utc)) / timedelta(seconds=1)
+
.. classmethod:: datetime.fromordinal(ordinal)
@@ -1564,11 +1580,12 @@ only EST (fixed offset -5 hours), or only EDT (fixed offset -4 hours)).
:class:`timezone` Objects
--------------------------
-A :class:`timezone` object represents a timezone that is defined by a
-fixed offset from UTC. Note that objects of this class cannot be used
-to represent timezone information in the locations where different
-offsets are used in different days of the year or where historical
-changes have been made to civil time.
+The :class:`timezone` class is a subclass of :class:`tzinfo`, each
+instance of which represents a timezone defined by a fixed offset from
+UTC. Note that objects of this class cannot be used to represent
+timezone information in the locations where different offsets are used
+in different days of the year or where historical changes have been
+made to civil time.
.. class:: timezone(offset[, name])
@@ -1737,8 +1754,7 @@ format codes.
| | decimal number [00,99]. | |
+-----------+--------------------------------+-------+
| ``%Y`` | Year with century as a decimal | \(5) |
-| | number [0001,9999] (strptime), | |
-| | [1000,9999] (strftime). | |
+| | number [0001,9999]. | |
+-----------+--------------------------------+-------+
| ``%z`` | UTC offset in the form +HHMM | \(6) |
| | or -HHMM (empty string if the | |
@@ -1772,10 +1788,7 @@ Notes:
calculations when the day of the week and the year are specified.
(5)
- For technical reasons, :meth:`strftime` method does not support
- dates before year 1000: ``t.strftime(format)`` will raise a
- :exc:`ValueError` when ``t.year < 1000`` even if ``format`` does
- not contain ``%Y`` directive. The :meth:`strptime` method can
+ The :meth:`strptime` method can
parse years in the full [1, 9999] range, but years < 1000 must be
zero-filled to 4-digit width.
@@ -1783,6 +1796,10 @@ Notes:
In previous versions, :meth:`strftime` method was restricted to
years >= 1900.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ In version 3.2, :meth:`strftime` method was restricted to
+ years >= 1000.
+
(6)
For example, if :meth:`utcoffset` returns ``timedelta(hours=-3, minutes=-30)``,
``%z`` is replaced with the string ``'-0330'``.
diff --git a/Doc/library/debug.rst b/Doc/library/debug.rst
index b2ee4fa..c69fb1c 100644
--- a/Doc/library/debug.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/debug.rst
@@ -10,7 +10,8 @@ allowing you to identify bottlenecks in your programs.
.. toctree::
bdb.rst
+ faulthandler.rst
pdb.rst
profile.rst
timeit.rst
- trace.rst \ No newline at end of file
+ trace.rst
diff --git a/Doc/library/depgraph-output.png b/Doc/library/depgraph-output.png
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..960bb1b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/depgraph-output.png
Binary files differ
diff --git a/Doc/library/difflib.rst b/Doc/library/difflib.rst
index bdc37b3..836e240 100644
--- a/Doc/library/difflib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/difflib.rst
@@ -752,8 +752,8 @@ It is also contained in the Python source distribution, as
# we're passing these as arguments to the diff function
fromdate = time.ctime(os.stat(fromfile).st_mtime)
todate = time.ctime(os.stat(tofile).st_mtime)
- fromlines = open(fromfile, 'U').readlines()
- tolines = open(tofile, 'U').readlines()
+ with open(fromlines) as fromf, open(tofile) as tof:
+ fromlines, tolines = list(fromf), list(tof)
if options.u:
diff = difflib.unified_diff(fromlines, tolines, fromfile, tofile,
diff --git a/Doc/library/dis.rst b/Doc/library/dis.rst
index 79cc583..5ba66cb 100644
--- a/Doc/library/dis.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/dis.rst
@@ -171,11 +171,6 @@ The Python compiler currently generates the following bytecode instructions.
**General instructions**
-.. opcode:: STOP_CODE
-
- Indicates end-of-code to the compiler, not used by the interpreter.
-
-
.. opcode:: NOP
Do nothing code. Used as a placeholder by the bytecode optimizer.
@@ -436,6 +431,13 @@ the stack so that it is available for further iterations of the loop.
Pops ``TOS`` and yields it from a :term:`generator`.
+.. opcode:: YIELD_FROM
+
+ Pops ``TOS`` and delegates to it as a subiterator from a :term:`generator`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. opcode:: IMPORT_STAR
Loads all symbols not starting with ``'_'`` directly from the module TOS to the
diff --git a/Doc/library/distutils.rst b/Doc/library/distutils.rst
index 238b79d..53a69ae 100644
--- a/Doc/library/distutils.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/distutils.rst
@@ -12,18 +12,26 @@ additional modules into a Python installation. The new modules may be either
100%-pure Python, or may be extension modules written in C, or may be
collections of Python packages which include modules coded in both Python and C.
-This package is discussed in two separate chapters:
+.. deprecated:: 3.3
+ :mod:`packaging` replaces Distutils. See :ref:`packaging-index` and
+ :ref:`packaging-install-index`.
+User documentation and API reference are provided in another document:
+
.. seealso::
:ref:`distutils-index`
The manual for developers and packagers of Python modules. This describes
how to prepare :mod:`distutils`\ -based packages so that they may be
- easily installed into an existing Python installation.
+ easily installed into an existing Python installation. If also contains
+ instructions for end-users wanting to install a distutils-based package,
+ :ref:`install-index`.
+
+
+.. trick to silence a Sphinx warning
- :ref:`install-index`
- An "administrators" manual which includes information on installing
- modules into an existing Python installation. You do not need to be a
- Python programmer to read this manual.
+.. toctree::
+ :hidden:
+ ../distutils/index
diff --git a/Doc/library/email.generator.rst b/Doc/library/email.generator.rst
index 85b32fe..847d7e4 100644
--- a/Doc/library/email.generator.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/email.generator.rst
@@ -32,7 +32,8 @@ Here are the public methods of the :class:`Generator` class, imported from the
:mod:`email.generator` module:
-.. class:: Generator(outfp, mangle_from_=True, maxheaderlen=78)
+.. class:: Generator(outfp, mangle_from_=True, maxheaderlen=78, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
The constructor for the :class:`Generator` class takes a :term:`file-like object`
called *outfp* for an argument. *outfp* must support the :meth:`write` method
@@ -53,10 +54,16 @@ Here are the public methods of the :class:`Generator` class, imported from the
:class:`~email.header.Header` class. Set to zero to disable header wrapping.
The default is 78, as recommended (but not required) by :rfc:`2822`.
+ The *policy* keyword specifies a :mod:`~email.policy` object that controls a
+ number of aspects of the generator's operation. The default policy
+ maintains backward compatibility.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3 Added the *policy* keyword.
+
The other public :class:`Generator` methods are:
- .. method:: flatten(msg, unixfrom=False, linesep='\\n')
+ .. method:: flatten(msg, unixfrom=False, linesep=None)
Print the textual representation of the message object structure rooted at
*msg* to the output file specified when the :class:`Generator` instance
@@ -72,12 +79,13 @@ Here are the public methods of the :class:`Generator` class, imported from the
Note that for subparts, no envelope header is ever printed.
Optional *linesep* specifies the line separator character used to
- terminate lines in the output. It defaults to ``\n`` because that is
- the most useful value for Python application code (other library packages
- expect ``\n`` separated lines). ``linesep=\r\n`` can be used to
- generate output with RFC-compliant line separators.
+ terminate lines in the output. If specified it overrides the value
+ specified by the ``Generator``\'s ``policy``.
- Messages parsed with a Bytes parser that have a
+ Because strings cannot represent non-ASCII bytes, ``Generator`` ignores
+ the value of the :attr:`~email.policy.Policy.must_be_7bit`
+ :mod:`~email.policy` setting and operates as if it were set ``True``.
+ This means that messages parsed with a Bytes parser that have a
:mailheader:`Content-Transfer-Encoding` of 8bit will be converted to a
use a 7bit Content-Transfer-Encoding. Non-ASCII bytes in the headers
will be :rfc:`2047` encoded with a charset of `unknown-8bit`.
@@ -103,7 +111,8 @@ As a convenience, see the :class:`~email.message.Message` methods
formatted string representation of a message object. For more detail, see
:mod:`email.message`.
-.. class:: BytesGenerator(outfp, mangle_from_=True, maxheaderlen=78)
+.. class:: BytesGenerator(outfp, mangle_from_=True, maxheaderlen=78, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
The constructor for the :class:`BytesGenerator` class takes a binary
:term:`file-like object` called *outfp* for an argument. *outfp* must
@@ -125,19 +134,31 @@ formatted string representation of a message object. For more detail, see
wrapping. The default is 78, as recommended (but not required) by
:rfc:`2822`.
+ The *policy* keyword specifies a :mod:`~email.policy` object that controls a
+ number of aspects of the generator's operation. The default policy
+ maintains backward compatibility.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3 Added the *policy* keyword.
+
The other public :class:`BytesGenerator` methods are:
- .. method:: flatten(msg, unixfrom=False, linesep='\n')
+ .. method:: flatten(msg, unixfrom=False, linesep=None)
Print the textual representation of the message object structure rooted
at *msg* to the output file specified when the :class:`BytesGenerator`
instance was created. Subparts are visited depth-first and the resulting
- text will be properly MIME encoded. If the input that created the *msg*
- contained bytes with the high bit set and those bytes have not been
- modified, they will be copied faithfully to the output, even if doing so
- is not strictly RFC compliant. (To produce strictly RFC compliant
- output, use the :class:`Generator` class.)
+ text will be properly MIME encoded. If the :mod:`~email.policy` option
+ :attr:`~email.policy.Policy.must_be_7bit` is ``False`` (the default),
+ then any bytes with the high bit set in the original parsed message that
+ have not been modified will be copied faithfully to the output. If
+ ``must_be_7bit`` is true, the bytes will be converted as needed using an
+ ASCII content-transfer-encoding. In particular, RFC-invalid non-ASCII
+ bytes in headers will be encoded using the MIME ``unknown-8bit``
+ character set, thus rendering them RFC-compliant.
+
+ .. XXX: There should be a complementary option that just does the RFC
+ compliance transformation but leaves CTE 8bit parts alone.
Messages parsed with a Bytes parser that have a
:mailheader:`Content-Transfer-Encoding` of 8bit will be reconstructed
@@ -152,10 +173,8 @@ formatted string representation of a message object. For more detail, see
Note that for subparts, no envelope header is ever printed.
Optional *linesep* specifies the line separator character used to
- terminate lines in the output. It defaults to ``\n`` because that is
- the most useful value for Python application code (other library packages
- expect ``\n`` separated lines). ``linesep=\r\n`` can be used to
- generate output with RFC-compliant line separators.
+ terminate lines in the output. If specified it overrides the value
+ specified by the ``Generator``\ 's ``policy``.
.. method:: clone(fp)
diff --git a/Doc/library/email.parser.rst b/Doc/library/email.parser.rst
index 384c5c9..a0303a4 100644
--- a/Doc/library/email.parser.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/email.parser.rst
@@ -58,12 +58,18 @@ list of defects that it can find.
Here is the API for the :class:`FeedParser`:
-.. class:: FeedParser(_factory=email.message.Message)
+.. class:: FeedParser(_factory=email.message.Message, *, policy=policy.default)
Create a :class:`FeedParser` instance. Optional *_factory* is a no-argument
callable that will be called whenever a new message object is needed. It
defaults to the :class:`email.message.Message` class.
+ The *policy* keyword specifies a :mod:`~email.policy` object that controls a
+ number of aspects of the parser's operation. The default policy maintains
+ backward compatibility.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3 Added the *policy* keyword.
+
.. method:: feed(data)
Feed the :class:`FeedParser` some more data. *data* should be a string
@@ -94,15 +100,17 @@ Parser class API
The :class:`Parser` class, imported from the :mod:`email.parser` module,
provides an API that can be used to parse a message when the complete contents
of the message are available in a string or file. The :mod:`email.parser`
-module also provides a second class, called :class:`HeaderParser` which can be
-used if you're only interested in the headers of the message.
-:class:`HeaderParser` can be much faster in these situations, since it does not
-attempt to parse the message body, instead setting the payload to the raw body
-as a string. :class:`HeaderParser` has the same API as the :class:`Parser`
-class.
+module also provides header-only parsers, called :class:`HeaderParser` and
+:class:`BytesHeaderParser`, which can be used if you're only interested in the
+headers of the message. :class:`HeaderParser` and :class:`BytesHeaderParser`
+can be much faster in these situations, since they do not attempt to parse the
+message body, instead setting the payload to the raw body as a string. They
+have the same API as the :class:`Parser` and :class:`BytesParser` classes.
+.. versionadded:: 3.3 BytesHeaderParser
-.. class:: Parser(_class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+
+.. class:: Parser(_class=email.message.Message, *, policy=policy.default)
The constructor for the :class:`Parser` class takes an optional argument
*_class*. This must be a callable factory (such as a function or a class), and
@@ -110,13 +118,13 @@ class.
:class:`~email.message.Message` (see :mod:`email.message`). The factory will
be called without arguments.
- The optional *strict* flag is ignored.
+ The *policy* keyword specifies a :mod:`~email.policy` object that controls a
+ number of aspects of the parser's operation. The default policy maintains
+ backward compatibility.
- .. deprecated:: 2.4
- Because the :class:`Parser` class is a backward compatible API wrapper
- around the new-in-Python 2.4 :class:`FeedParser`, *all* parsing is
- effectively non-strict. You should simply stop passing a *strict* flag to
- the :class:`Parser` constructor.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed the *strict* argument that was deprecated in 2.4. Added the
+ *policy* keyword.
The other public :class:`Parser` methods are:
@@ -147,12 +155,18 @@ class.
Optional *headersonly* is as with the :meth:`parse` method.
-.. class:: BytesParser(_class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+.. class:: BytesParser(_class=email.message.Message, *, policy=policy.default)
This class is exactly parallel to :class:`Parser`, but handles bytes input.
The *_class* and *strict* arguments are interpreted in the same way as for
- the :class:`Parser` constructor. *strict* is supported only to make porting
- code easier; it is deprecated.
+ the :class:`Parser` constructor.
+
+ The *policy* keyword specifies a :mod:`~email.policy` object that
+ controls a number of aspects of the parser's operation. The default
+ policy maintains backward compatibility.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed the *strict* argument. Added the *policy* keyword.
.. method:: parse(fp, headeronly=False)
@@ -190,34 +204,48 @@ in the top-level :mod:`email` package namespace.
.. currentmodule:: email
-.. function:: message_from_string(s, _class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+.. function:: message_from_string(s, _class=email.message.Message, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
Return a message object structure from a string. This is exactly equivalent to
- ``Parser().parsestr(s)``. Optional *_class* and *strict* are interpreted as
+ ``Parser().parsestr(s)``. *_class* and *policy* are interpreted as
with the :class:`Parser` class constructor.
-.. function:: message_from_bytes(s, _class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed the *strict* argument. Added the *policy* keyword.
+
+.. function:: message_from_bytes(s, _class=email.message.Message, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
Return a message object structure from a byte string. This is exactly
equivalent to ``BytesParser().parsebytes(s)``. Optional *_class* and
*strict* are interpreted as with the :class:`Parser` class constructor.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed the *strict* argument. Added the *policy* keyword.
-.. function:: message_from_file(fp, _class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+.. function:: message_from_file(fp, _class=email.message.Message, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
Return a message object structure tree from an open :term:`file object`.
- This is exactly equivalent to ``Parser().parse(fp)``. Optional *_class*
- and *strict* are interpreted as with the :class:`Parser` class constructor.
+ This is exactly equivalent to ``Parser().parse(fp)``. *_class*
+ and *policy* are interpreted as with the :class:`Parser` class constructor.
+
+ .. versionchanged::
+ Removed the *strict* argument. Added the *policy* keyword.
-.. function:: message_from_binary_file(fp, _class=email.message.Message, strict=None)
+.. function:: message_from_binary_file(fp, _class=email.message.Message, *, \
+ policy=policy.default)
Return a message object structure tree from an open binary :term:`file
object`. This is exactly equivalent to ``BytesParser().parse(fp)``.
- Optional *_class* and *strict* are interpreted as with the :class:`Parser`
+ *_class* and *policy* are interpreted as with the :class:`Parser`
class constructor.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed the *strict* argument. Added the *policy* keyword.
Here's an example of how you might use this at an interactive Python prompt::
diff --git a/Doc/library/email.policy.rst b/Doc/library/email.policy.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d9a292c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/email.policy.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,184 @@
+:mod:`email`: Policy Objects
+----------------------------
+
+.. module:: email.policy
+ :synopsis: Controlling the parsing and generating of messages
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+The :mod:`email` package's prime focus is the handling of email messages as
+described by the various email and MIME RFCs. However, the general format of
+email messages (a block of header fields each consisting of a name followed by
+a colon followed by a value, the whole block followed by a blank line and an
+arbitrary 'body'), is a format that has found utility outside of the realm of
+email. Some of these uses conform fairly closely to the main RFCs, some do
+not. And even when working with email, there are times when it is desirable to
+break strict compliance with the RFCs.
+
+Policy objects give the email package the flexibility to handle all these
+disparate use cases.
+
+A :class:`Policy` object encapsulates a set of attributes and methods that
+control the behavior of various components of the email package during use.
+:class:`Policy` instances can be passed to various classes and methods in the
+email package to alter the default behavior. The settable values and their
+defaults are described below. The :mod:`policy` module also provides some
+pre-created :class:`Policy` instances. In addition to a :const:`default`
+instance, there are instances tailored for certain applications. For example
+there is an :const:`SMTP` :class:`Policy` with defaults appropriate for
+generating output to be sent to an SMTP server. These are listed `below
+<Policy Instances>`.
+
+In general an application will only need to deal with setting the policy at the
+input and output boundaries. Once parsed, a message is represented by a
+:class:`~email.message.Message` object, which is designed to be independent of
+the format that the message has "on the wire" when it is received, transmitted,
+or displayed. Thus, a :class:`Policy` can be specified when parsing a message
+to create a :class:`~email.message.Message`, and again when turning the
+:class:`~email.message.Message` into some other representation. While often a
+program will use the same :class:`Policy` for both input and output, the two
+can be different.
+
+As an example, the following code could be used to read an email message from a
+file on disk and pass it to the system ``sendmail`` program on a Unix system::
+
+ >>> from email import msg_from_binary_file
+ >>> from email.generator import BytesGenerator
+ >>> import email.policy
+ >>> from subprocess import Popen, PIPE
+ >>> with open('mymsg.txt', 'b') as f:
+ ... msg = msg_from_binary_file(f, policy=email.policy.mbox)
+ >>> p = Popen(['sendmail', msg['To'][0].address], stdin=PIPE)
+ >>> g = BytesGenerator(p.stdin, policy=email.policy.SMTP)
+ >>> g.flatten(msg)
+ >>> p.stdin.close()
+ >>> rc = p.wait()
+
+.. XXX email.policy.mbox/MBOX does not exist yet
+
+Some email package methods accept a *policy* keyword argument, allowing the
+policy to be overridden for that method. For example, the following code uses
+the :meth:`~email.message.Message.as_string` method of the *msg* object from the
+previous example and re-write it to a file using the native line separators for
+the platform on which it is running::
+
+ >>> import os
+ >>> mypolicy = email.policy.Policy(linesep=os.linesep)
+ >>> with open('converted.txt', 'wb') as f:
+ ... f.write(msg.as_string(policy=mypolicy))
+
+Policy instances are immutable, but they can be cloned, accepting the same
+keyword arguments as the class constructor and returning a new :class:`Policy`
+instance that is a copy of the original but with the specified attributes
+values changed. For example, the following creates an SMTP policy that will
+raise any defects detected as errors::
+
+ >>> strict_SMTP = email.policy.SMTP.clone(raise_on_defect=True)
+
+Policy objects can also be combined using the addition operator, producing a
+policy object whose settings are a combination of the non-default values of the
+summed objects::
+
+ >>> strict_SMTP = email.policy.SMTP + email.policy.strict
+
+This operation is not commutative; that is, the order in which the objects are
+added matters. To illustrate::
+
+ >>> Policy = email.policy.Policy
+ >>> apolicy = Policy(max_line_length=100) + Policy(max_line_length=80)
+ >>> apolicy.max_line_length
+ 80
+ >>> apolicy = Policy(max_line_length=80) + Policy(max_line_length=100)
+ >>> apolicy.max_line_length
+ 100
+
+
+.. class:: Policy(**kw)
+
+ The valid constructor keyword arguments are any of the attributes listed
+ below.
+
+ .. attribute:: max_line_length
+
+ The maximum length of any line in the serialized output, not counting the
+ end of line character(s). Default is 78, per :rfc:`5322`. A value of
+ ``0`` or :const:`None` indicates that no line wrapping should be
+ done at all.
+
+ .. attribute:: linesep
+
+ The string to be used to terminate lines in serialized output. The
+ default is ``\n`` because that's the internal end-of-line discipline used
+ by Python, though ``\r\n`` is required by the RFCs. See `Policy
+ Instances`_ for policies that use an RFC conformant linesep. Setting it
+ to :attr:`os.linesep` may also be useful.
+
+ .. attribute:: must_be_7bit
+
+ If ``True``, data output by a bytes generator is limited to ASCII
+ characters. If :const:`False` (the default), then bytes with the high
+ bit set are preserved and/or allowed in certain contexts (for example,
+ where possible a content transfer encoding of ``8bit`` will be used).
+ String generators act as if ``must_be_7bit`` is ``True`` regardless of
+ the policy in effect, since a string cannot represent non-ASCII bytes.
+
+ .. attribute:: raise_on_defect
+
+ If :const:`True`, any defects encountered will be raised as errors. If
+ :const:`False` (the default), defects will be passed to the
+ :meth:`register_defect` method.
+
+ :mod:`Policy` object also have the following methods:
+
+ .. method:: handle_defect(obj, defect)
+
+ *obj* is the object on which to register the defect. *defect* should be
+ an instance of a subclass of :class:`~email.errors.Defect`.
+ If :attr:`raise_on_defect`
+ is ``True`` the defect is raised as an exception. Otherwise *obj* and
+ *defect* are passed to :meth:`register_defect`. This method is intended
+ to be called by parsers when they encounter defects, and will not be
+ called by code that uses the email library unless that code is
+ implementing an alternate parser.
+
+ .. method:: register_defect(obj, defect)
+
+ *obj* is the object on which to register the defect. *defect* should be
+ a subclass of :class:`~email.errors.Defect`. This method is part of the
+ public API so that custom ``Policy`` subclasses can implement alternate
+ handling of defects. The default implementation calls the ``append``
+ method of the ``defects`` attribute of *obj*.
+
+ .. method:: clone(obj, *kw)
+
+ Return a new :class:`Policy` instance whose attributes have the same
+ values as the current instance, except where those attributes are
+ given new values by the keyword arguments.
+
+
+Policy Instances
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+The following instances of :class:`Policy` provide defaults suitable for
+specific common application domains.
+
+.. data:: default
+
+ An instance of :class:`Policy` with all defaults unchanged.
+
+.. data:: SMTP
+
+ Output serialized from a message will conform to the email and SMTP
+ RFCs. The only changed attribute is :attr:`linesep`, which is set to
+ ``\r\n``.
+
+.. data:: HTTP
+
+ Suitable for use when serializing headers for use in HTTP traffic.
+ :attr:`linesep` is set to ``\r\n``, and :attr:`max_line_length` is set to
+ :const:`None` (unlimited).
+
+.. data:: strict
+
+ :attr:`raise_on_defect` is set to :const:`True`.
diff --git a/Doc/library/email.rst b/Doc/library/email.rst
index 4530b95..fc206f4 100644
--- a/Doc/library/email.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/email.rst
@@ -51,6 +51,7 @@ Contents of the :mod:`email` package documentation:
email.message.rst
email.parser.rst
email.generator.rst
+ email.policy.rst
email.mime.rst
email.header.rst
email.charset.rst
diff --git a/Doc/library/email.util.rst b/Doc/library/email.util.rst
index f7b777a..2f9ef89 100644
--- a/Doc/library/email.util.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/email.util.rst
@@ -29,13 +29,20 @@ There are several useful utilities provided in the :mod:`email.utils` module:
fails, in which case a 2-tuple of ``('', '')`` is returned.
-.. function:: formataddr(pair)
+.. function:: formataddr(pair, charset='utf-8')
The inverse of :meth:`parseaddr`, this takes a 2-tuple of the form ``(realname,
email_address)`` and returns the string value suitable for a :mailheader:`To` or
:mailheader:`Cc` header. If the first element of *pair* is false, then the
second element is returned unmodified.
+ Optional *charset* is the character set that will be used in the :rfc:`2047`
+ encoding of the ``realname`` if the ``realname`` contains non-ASCII
+ characters. Can be an instance of :class:`str` or a
+ :class:`~email.charset.Charset`. Defaults to ``utf-8``.
+
+ .. versionchanged: 3.3 added the *charset* option
+
.. function:: getaddresses(fieldvalues)
@@ -74,6 +81,20 @@ There are several useful utilities provided in the :mod:`email.utils` module:
indexes 6, 7, and 8 of the result tuple are not usable.
+.. function:: parsedate_to_datetime(date)
+
+ The inverse of :func:`format_datetime`. Performs the same function as
+ :func:`parsedate`, but on success returns a :mod:`~datetime.datetime`. If
+ the input date has a timezone of ``-0000``, the ``datetime`` will be a naive
+ ``datetime``, and if the date is conforming to the RFCs it will represent a
+ time in UTC but with no indication of the actual source timezone of the
+ message the date comes from. If the input date has any other valid timezone
+ offset, the ``datetime`` will be an aware ``datetime`` with the
+ corresponding a :class:`~datetime.timezone` :class:`~datetime.tzinfo`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: mktime_tz(tuple)
Turn a 10-tuple as returned by :func:`parsedate_tz` into a UTC timestamp. It
@@ -105,6 +126,20 @@ There are several useful utilities provided in the :mod:`email.utils` module:
``False``. The default is ``False``.
+.. function:: format_datetime(dt, usegmt=False)
+
+ Like ``formatdate``, but the input is a :mod:`datetime` instance. If it is
+ a naive datetime, it is assumed to be "UTC with no information about the
+ source timezone", and the conventional ``-0000`` is used for the timezone.
+ If it is an aware ``datetime``, then the numeric timezone offset is used.
+ If it is an aware timezone with offset zero, then *usegmt* may be set to
+ ``True``, in which case the string ``GMT`` is used instead of the numeric
+ timezone offset. This provides a way to generate standards conformant HTTP
+ date headers.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: make_msgid(idstring=None, domain=None)
Returns a string suitable for an :rfc:`2822`\ -compliant
diff --git a/Doc/library/exceptions.rst b/Doc/library/exceptions.rst
index ca3ad3e..3f1a30d 100644
--- a/Doc/library/exceptions.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/exceptions.rst
@@ -34,6 +34,10 @@ programmers are encouraged to at least derive new exceptions from the
defining exceptions is available in the Python Tutorial under
:ref:`tut-userexceptions`.
+
+Base classes
+------------
+
The following exceptions are used mostly as base classes for other exceptions.
.. exception:: BaseException
@@ -90,27 +94,8 @@ The following exceptions are used mostly as base classes for other exceptions.
can be raised directly by :func:`codecs.lookup`.
-.. exception:: EnvironmentError
-
- The base class for exceptions that can occur outside the Python system:
- :exc:`IOError`, :exc:`OSError`. When exceptions of this type are created with a
- 2-tuple, the first item is available on the instance's :attr:`errno` attribute
- (it is assumed to be an error number), and the second item is available on the
- :attr:`strerror` attribute (it is usually the associated error message). The
- tuple itself is also available on the :attr:`args` attribute.
-
- When an :exc:`EnvironmentError` exception is instantiated with a 3-tuple, the
- first two items are available as above, while the third item is available on the
- :attr:`filename` attribute. However, for backwards compatibility, the
- :attr:`args` attribute contains only a 2-tuple of the first two constructor
- arguments.
-
- The :attr:`filename` attribute is ``None`` when this exception is created with
- other than 3 arguments. The :attr:`errno` and :attr:`strerror` attributes are
- also ``None`` when the instance was created with other than 2 or 3 arguments.
- In this last case, :attr:`args` contains the verbatim constructor arguments as a
- tuple.
-
+Concrete exceptions
+-------------------
The following exceptions are the exceptions that are usually raised.
@@ -151,16 +136,6 @@ The following exceptions are the exceptions that are usually raised.
it is technically not an error.
-.. exception:: IOError
-
- Raised when an I/O operation (such as the built-in :func:`print` or
- :func:`open` functions or a method of a :term:`file object`) fails for an
- I/O-related reason, e.g., "file not found" or "disk full".
-
- This class is derived from :exc:`EnvironmentError`. See the discussion above
- for more information on exception instance attributes.
-
-
.. exception:: ImportError
Raised when an :keyword:`import` statement fails to find the module definition
@@ -221,17 +196,30 @@ The following exceptions are the exceptions that are usually raised.
.. index:: module: errno
- This exception is derived from :exc:`EnvironmentError`. It is raised when a
- function returns a system-related error (not for illegal argument types or
- other incidental errors). The :attr:`errno` attribute is a numeric error
- code from :c:data:`errno`, and the :attr:`strerror` attribute is the
- corresponding string, as would be printed by the C function :c:func:`perror`.
- See the module :mod:`errno`, which contains names for the error codes defined
- by the underlying operating system.
+ This exception is raised when a system function returns a system-related
+ error, including I/O failures such as "file not found" or "disk full"
+ (not for illegal argument types or other incidental errors). Often a
+ subclass of :exc:`OSError` will actually be raised as described in
+ `OS exceptions`_ below. The :attr:`errno` attribute is a numeric error
+ code from the C variable :c:data:`errno`.
+
+ Under Windows, the :attr:`winerror` attribute gives you the native
+ Windows error code. The :attr:`errno` attribute is then an approximate
+ translation, in POSIX terms, of that native error code.
+
+ Under all platforms, the :attr:`strerror` attribute is the corresponding
+ error message as provided by the operating system (as formatted by the C
+ functions :c:func:`perror` under POSIX, and :c:func:`FormatMessage`
+ Windows).
- For exceptions that involve a file system path (such as :func:`chdir` or
- :func:`unlink`), the exception instance will contain a third attribute,
- :attr:`filename`, which is the file name passed to the function.
+ For exceptions that involve a file system path (such as :func:`open` or
+ :func:`os.unlink`), the exception instance will contain an additional
+ attribute, :attr:`filename`, which is the file name passed to the function.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`EnvironmentError`, :exc:`IOError`, :exc:`WindowsError`,
+ :exc:`VMSError`, :exc:`socket.error`, :exc:`select.error` and
+ :exc:`mmap.error` have been merged into :exc:`OSError`.
.. exception:: OverflowError
@@ -262,8 +250,20 @@ The following exceptions are the exceptions that are usually raised.
.. exception:: StopIteration
Raised by built-in function :func:`next` and an :term:`iterator`\'s
- :meth:`__next__` method to signal that there are no further values.
+ :meth:`__next__` method to signal that there are no further items to be
+ produced by the iterator.
+
+ The exception object has a single attribute :attr:`value`, which is
+ given as an argument when constructing the exception, and defaults
+ to :const:`None`.
+ When a generator function returns, a new :exc:`StopIteration` instance is
+ raised, and the value returned by the function is used as the
+ :attr:`value` parameter to the constructor of the exception.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added ``value`` attribute and the ability for generator functions to
+ use it to return a value.
.. exception:: SyntaxError
@@ -372,27 +372,142 @@ The following exceptions are the exceptions that are usually raised.
more precise exception such as :exc:`IndexError`.
-.. exception:: VMSError
+.. exception:: ZeroDivisionError
+
+ Raised when the second argument of a division or modulo operation is zero. The
+ associated value is a string indicating the type of the operands and the
+ operation.
+
+
+The following exceptions are kept for compatibility with previous versions;
+starting from Python 3.3, they are aliases of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+.. exception:: EnvironmentError
- Only available on VMS. Raised when a VMS-specific error occurs.
+.. exception:: IOError
+
+.. exception:: VMSError
+ Only available on VMS.
.. exception:: WindowsError
- Raised when a Windows-specific error occurs or when the error number does not
- correspond to an :c:data:`errno` value. The :attr:`winerror` and
- :attr:`strerror` values are created from the return values of the
- :c:func:`GetLastError` and :c:func:`FormatMessage` functions from the Windows
- Platform API. The :attr:`errno` value maps the :attr:`winerror` value to
- corresponding ``errno.h`` values. This is a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
+ Only available on Windows.
-.. exception:: ZeroDivisionError
+OS exceptions
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+The following exceptions are subclasses of :exc:`OSError`, they get raised
+depending on the system error code.
+
+.. exception:: BlockingIOError
+
+ Raised when an operation would block on an object (e.g. socket) set
+ for non-blocking operation.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EAGAIN``, ``EALREADY``,
+ ``EWOULDBLOCK`` and ``EINPROGRESS``.
+
+ In addition to those of :exc:`OSError`, :exc:`BlockingIOError` can have
+ one more attribute:
+
+ .. attribute:: characters_written
+
+ An integer containing the number of characters written to the stream
+ before it blocked. This attribute is available when using the
+ buffered I/O classes from the :mod:`io` module.
+
+.. exception:: ChildProcessError
+
+ Raised when an operation on a child process failed.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ECHILD``.
+
+.. exception:: ConnectionError
+
+ A base class for connection-related issues. Subclasses are
+ :exc:`BrokenPipeError`, :exc:`ConnectionAbortedError`,
+ :exc:`ConnectionRefusedError` and :exc:`ConnectionResetError`.
+
+ .. exception:: BrokenPipeError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`ConnectionError`, raised when trying to write on a
+ pipe while the other end has been closed, or trying to write on a socket
+ which has been shutdown for writing.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EPIPE`` and ``ESHUTDOWN``.
+
+ .. exception:: ConnectionAbortedError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`ConnectionError`, raised when a connection attempt
+ is aborted by the peer.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ECONNABORTED``.
+
+ .. exception:: ConnectionRefusedError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`ConnectionError`, raised when a connection attempt
+ is refused by the peer.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ECONNREFUSED``.
+
+ .. exception:: ConnectionResetError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`ConnectionError`, raised when a connection is
+ reset by the peer.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ECONNRESET``.
+
+.. exception:: FileExistsError
+
+ Raised when trying to create a file or directory which already exists.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EEXIST``.
+
+.. exception:: FileNotFoundError
+
+ Raised when a file or directory is requested but doesn't exist.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ENOENT``.
+
+.. exception:: InterruptedError
+
+ Raised when a system call is interrupted by an incoming signal.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EEINTR``.
+
+.. exception:: IsADirectoryError
+
+ Raised when a file operation (such as :func:`os.remove`) is requested
+ on a directory.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EISDIR``.
+
+.. exception:: NotADirectoryError
+
+ Raised when a directory operation (such as :func:`os.listdir`) is requested
+ on something which is not a directory.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ENOTDIR``.
+
+.. exception:: PermissionError
+
+ Raised when trying to run an operation without the adequate access
+ rights - for example filesystem permissions.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``EACCES`` and ``EPERM``.
+
+.. exception:: ProcessLookupError
+
+ Raised when a given process doesn't exist.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ESRCH``.
+
+.. exception:: TimeoutError
+
+ Raised when a system function timed out at the system level.
+ Corresponds to :c:data:`errno` ``ETIMEDOUT``.
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+ All the above :exc:`OSError` subclasses were added.
+
+
+.. seealso::
+
+ :pep:`3151` - Reworking the OS and IO exception hierarchy
+ PEP written and implemented by Antoine Pitrou.
- Raised when the second argument of a division or modulo operation is zero. The
- associated value is a string indicating the type of the operands and the
- operation.
+Warnings
+--------
The following exceptions are used as warning categories; see the :mod:`warnings`
module for more information.
diff --git a/Doc/library/faulthandler.rst b/Doc/library/faulthandler.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c9b9546
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/faulthandler.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+:mod:`faulthandler` --- Dump the Python traceback
+=================================================
+
+.. module:: faulthandler
+ :synopsis: Dump the Python traceback.
+
+This module contains functions to dump Python tracebacks explicitly, on a fault,
+after a timeout, or on a user signal. Call :func:`faulthandler.enable` to
+install fault handlers for the :const:`SIGSEGV`, :const:`SIGFPE`,
+:const:`SIGABRT`, :const:`SIGBUS`, and :const:`SIGILL` signals. You can also
+enable them at startup by setting the :envvar:`PYTHONFAULTHANDLER` environment
+variable or by using :option:`-X` ``faulthandler`` command line option.
+
+The fault handler is compatible with system fault handlers like Apport or the
+Windows fault handler. The module uses an alternative stack for signal handlers
+if the :c:func:`sigaltstack` function is available. This allows it to dump the
+traceback even on a stack overflow.
+
+The fault handler is called on catastrophic cases and therefore can only use
+signal-safe functions (e.g. it cannot allocate memory on the heap). Because of
+this limitation traceback dumping is minimal compared to normal Python
+tracebacks:
+
+* Only ASCII is supported. The ``backslashreplace`` error handler is used on
+ encoding.
+* Each string is limited to 100 characters.
+* Only the filename, the function name and the line number are
+ displayed. (no source code)
+* It is limited to 100 frames and 100 threads.
+
+By default, the Python traceback is written to :data:`sys.stderr`. To see
+tracebacks, applications must be run in the terminal. A log file can
+alternatively be passed to :func:`faulthandler.enable`.
+
+The module is implemented in C, so tracebacks can be dumped on a crash or when
+Python is deadlocked.
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+Dump the traceback
+------------------
+
+.. function:: dump_traceback(file=sys.stderr, all_threads=True)
+
+ Dump the tracebacks of all threads into *file*. If *all_threads* is
+ ``False``, dump only the current thread.
+
+
+Fault handler state
+-------------------
+
+.. function:: enable(file=sys.stderr, all_threads=True)
+
+ Enable the fault handler: install handlers for the :const:`SIGSEGV`,
+ :const:`SIGFPE`, :const:`SIGABRT`, :const:`SIGBUS` and :const:`SIGILL`
+ signals to dump the Python traceback. If *all_threads* is ``True``,
+ produce tracebacks for every running thread. Otherwise, dump only the current
+ thread.
+
+.. function:: disable()
+
+ Disable the fault handler: uninstall the signal handlers installed by
+ :func:`enable`.
+
+.. function:: is_enabled()
+
+ Check if the fault handler is enabled.
+
+
+Dump the tracebacks after a timeout
+-----------------------------------
+
+.. function:: dump_tracebacks_later(timeout, repeat=False, file=sys.stderr, exit=False)
+
+ Dump the tracebacks of all threads, after a timeout of *timeout* seconds, or
+ every *timeout* seconds if *repeat* is ``True``. If *exit* is ``True``, call
+ :c:func:`_exit` with status=1 after dumping the tracebacks. (Note
+ :c:func:`_exit` exits the process immediately, which means it doesn't do any
+ cleanup like flushing file buffers.) If the function is called twice, the new
+ call replaces previous parameters and resets the timeout. The timer has a
+ sub-second resolution.
+
+ This function is implemented using a watchdog thread and therefore is not
+ available if Python is compiled with threads disabled.
+
+.. function:: cancel_dump_tracebacks_later()
+
+ Cancel the last call to :func:`dump_tracebacks_later`.
+
+
+Dump the traceback on a user signal
+-----------------------------------
+
+.. function:: register(signum, file=sys.stderr, all_threads=True, chain=False)
+
+ Register a user signal: install a handler for the *signum* signal to dump
+ the traceback of all threads, or of the current thread if *all_threads* is
+ ``False``, into *file*. Call the previous handler if chain is ``True``.
+
+ Not available on Windows.
+
+.. function:: unregister(signum)
+
+ Unregister a user signal: uninstall the handler of the *signum* signal
+ installed by :func:`register`. Return ``True`` if the signal was registered,
+ ``False`` otherwise.
+
+ Not available on Windows.
+
+
+File descriptor issue
+---------------------
+
+:func:`enable`, :func:`dump_tracebacks_later` and :func:`register` keep the
+file descriptor of their *file* argument. If the file is closed and its file
+descriptor is reused by a new file, or if :func:`os.dup2` is used to replace
+the file descriptor, the traceback will be written into a different file. Call
+these functions again each time that the file is replaced.
+
+
+Example
+-------
+
+Example of a segmentation fault on Linux: ::
+
+ $ python -q -X faulthandler
+ >>> import ctypes
+ >>> ctypes.string_at(0)
+ Fatal Python error: Segmentation fault
+
+ Current thread 0x00007fb899f39700:
+ File "/home/python/cpython/Lib/ctypes/__init__.py", line 486 in string_at
+ File "<stdin>", line 1 in <module>
+ Segmentation fault
+
diff --git a/Doc/library/fcntl.rst b/Doc/library/fcntl.rst
index 6192400..9a9cdc1 100644
--- a/Doc/library/fcntl.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/fcntl.rst
@@ -19,6 +19,11 @@ argument. This can be an integer file descriptor, such as returned by
``sys.stdin.fileno()``, or a :class:`io.IOBase` object, such as ``sys.stdin``
itself, which provides a :meth:`fileno` that returns a genuine file descriptor.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Operations in this module used to raise a :exc:`IOError` where they now
+ raise a :exc:`OSError`.
+
+
The module defines the following functions:
@@ -40,7 +45,7 @@ The module defines the following functions:
larger than 1024 bytes, this is most likely to result in a segmentation
violation or a more subtle data corruption.
- If the :c:func:`fcntl` fails, an :exc:`IOError` is raised.
+ If the :c:func:`fcntl` fails, an :exc:`OSError` is raised.
.. function:: ioctl(fd, op[, arg[, mutate_flag]])
@@ -107,7 +112,7 @@ The module defines the following functions:
When *operation* is :const:`LOCK_SH` or :const:`LOCK_EX`, it can also be
bitwise ORed with :const:`LOCK_NB` to avoid blocking on lock acquisition.
If :const:`LOCK_NB` is used and the lock cannot be acquired, an
- :exc:`IOError` will be raised and the exception will have an *errno*
+ :exc:`OSError` will be raised and the exception will have an *errno*
attribute set to :const:`EACCES` or :const:`EAGAIN` (depending on the
operating system; for portability, check for both values). On at least some
systems, :const:`LOCK_EX` can only be used if the file descriptor refers to a
diff --git a/Doc/library/fileinput.rst b/Doc/library/fileinput.rst
index ac44311..f8ec436 100644
--- a/Doc/library/fileinput.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/fileinput.rst
@@ -28,7 +28,10 @@ as the first argument to :func:`.input`. A single file name is also allowed.
All files are opened in text mode by default, but you can override this by
specifying the *mode* parameter in the call to :func:`.input` or
:class:`FileInput`. If an I/O error occurs during opening or reading a file,
-:exc:`IOError` is raised.
+:exc:`OSError` is raised.
+
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised; it is now an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
If ``sys.stdin`` is used more than once, the second and further use will return
no lines, except perhaps for interactive use, or if it has been explicitly reset
@@ -168,10 +171,6 @@ and the backup file remains around; by default, the extension is ``'.bak'`` and
it is deleted when the output file is closed. In-place filtering is disabled
when standard input is read.
-.. note::
-
- The current implementation does not work for MS-DOS 8+3 filesystems.
-
The two following opening hooks are provided by this module:
diff --git a/Doc/library/ftplib.rst b/Doc/library/ftplib.rst
index 5bbef4f..3cc295a 100644
--- a/Doc/library/ftplib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/ftplib.rst
@@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ Here's a sample session using the :mod:`ftplib` module::
The module defines the following items:
-.. class:: FTP(host='', user='', passwd='', acct=''[, timeout])
+.. class:: FTP(host='', user='', passwd='', acct='', timeout=None, source_address=None)
Return a new instance of the :class:`FTP` class. When *host* is given, the
method call ``connect(host)`` is made. When *user* is given, additionally
@@ -48,7 +48,8 @@ The module defines the following items:
*acct* default to the empty string when not given). The optional *timeout*
parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for blocking operations like the
connection attempt (if is not specified, the global default timeout setting
- will be used).
+ will be used). *source_address* is a 2-tuple ``(host, port)`` for the socket
+ to bind to as its source address before connecting.
:class:`FTP` class supports the :keyword:`with` statement. Here is a sample
on how using it:
@@ -68,8 +69,11 @@ The module defines the following items:
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Support for the :keyword:`with` statement was added.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *source_address* parameter was added.
-.. class:: FTP_TLS(host='', user='', passwd='', acct='', [keyfile[, certfile[, context[, timeout]]]])
+
+.. class:: FTP_TLS(host='', user='', passwd='', acct='', keyfile=None, certfile=None, context=None, timeout=None, source_address=None)
A :class:`FTP` subclass which adds TLS support to FTP as described in
:rfc:`4217`.
@@ -80,10 +84,15 @@ The module defines the following items:
private key and certificate chain file name for the SSL connection.
*context* parameter is a :class:`ssl.SSLContext` object which allows
bundling SSL configuration options, certificates and private keys into a
- single (potentially long-lived) structure.
+ single (potentially long-lived) structure. *source_address* is a 2-tuple
+ ``(host, port)`` for the socket to bind to as its source address before
+ connecting.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *source_address* parameter was added.
+
Here's a sample session using the :class:`FTP_TLS` class:
>>> from ftplib import FTP_TLS
@@ -135,8 +144,7 @@ The module defines the following items:
The set of all exceptions (as a tuple) that methods of :class:`FTP`
instances may raise as a result of problems with the FTP connection (as
opposed to programming errors made by the caller). This set includes the
- four exceptions listed above as well as :exc:`socket.error` and
- :exc:`IOError`.
+ four exceptions listed above as well as :exc:`OSError`.
.. seealso::
@@ -174,7 +182,7 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
debugging output, logging each line sent and received on the control connection.
-.. method:: FTP.connect(host='', port=0[, timeout])
+.. method:: FTP.connect(host='', port=0, timeout=None, source_address=None)
Connect to the given host and port. The default port number is ``21``, as
specified by the FTP protocol specification. It is rarely needed to specify a
@@ -182,10 +190,14 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
instance; it should not be called at all if a host was given when the instance
was created. All other methods can only be used after a connection has been
made.
-
The optional *timeout* parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for the
connection attempt. If no *timeout* is passed, the global default timeout
setting will be used.
+ *source_address* is a 2-tuple ``(host, port)`` for the socket to bind to as
+ its source address before connecting.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *source_address* parameter was added.
.. method:: FTP.getwelcome()
@@ -241,13 +253,12 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
Retrieve a file or directory listing in ASCII transfer mode. *cmd* should be
an appropriate ``RETR`` command (see :meth:`retrbinary`) or a command such as
- ``LIST``, ``NLST`` or ``MLSD`` (usually just the string ``'LIST'``).
+ ``LIST`` or ``NLST`` (usually just the string ``'LIST'``).
``LIST`` retrieves a list of files and information about those files.
- ``NLST`` retrieves a list of file names. On some servers, ``MLSD`` retrieves
- a machine readable list of files and information about those files. The
- *callback* function is called for each line with a string argument containing
- the line with the trailing CRLF stripped. The default *callback* prints the
- line to ``sys.stdout``.
+ ``NLST`` retrieves a list of file names.
+ The *callback* function is called for each line with a string argument
+ containing the line with the trailing CRLF stripped. The default *callback*
+ prints the line to ``sys.stdout``.
.. method:: FTP.set_pasv(boolean)
@@ -307,6 +318,20 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
in :meth:`transfercmd`.
+.. method:: FTP.mlsd(path="", facts=[])
+
+ List a directory in a standardized format by using MLSD command
+ (:rfc:`3659`). If *path* is omitted the current directory is assumed.
+ *facts* is a list of strings representing the type of information desired
+ (e.g. ``["type", "size", "perm"]``). Return a generator object yielding a
+ tuple of two elements for every file found in path. First element is the
+ file name, the second one is a dictionary containing facts about the file
+ name. Content of this dictionary might be limited by the *facts* argument
+ but server is not guaranteed to return all requested facts.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: FTP.nlst(argument[, ...])
Return a list of file names as returned by the ``NLST`` command. The
@@ -314,6 +339,8 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
directory). Multiple arguments can be used to pass non-standard options to
the ``NLST`` command.
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3 use :meth:`mlsd` instead.
+
.. method:: FTP.dir(argument[, ...])
@@ -324,6 +351,8 @@ followed by ``lines`` for the text version or ``binary`` for the binary version.
as a *callback* function as for :meth:`retrlines`; the default prints to
``sys.stdout``. This method returns ``None``.
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3 use :meth:`mlsd` instead.
+
.. method:: FTP.rename(fromname, toname)
@@ -396,6 +425,14 @@ FTP_TLS Objects
Set up secure control connection by using TLS or SSL, depending on what specified in :meth:`ssl_version` attribute.
+.. method:: FTP_TLS.ccc()
+
+ Revert control channel back to plaintext. This can be useful to take
+ advantage of firewalls that know how to handle NAT with non-secure FTP
+ without opening fixed ports.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. method:: FTP_TLS.prot_p()
Set up secure data connection.
diff --git a/Doc/library/functions.rst b/Doc/library/functions.rst
index f835dcf..e4b14b8 100644
--- a/Doc/library/functions.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/functions.rst
@@ -152,10 +152,6 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
1,114,111 (0x10FFFF in base 16). :exc:`ValueError` will be raised if *i* is
outside that range.
- Note that on narrow Unicode builds, the result is a string of
- length two for *i* greater than 65,535 (0xFFFF in hexadecimal).
-
-
.. function:: classmethod(function)
@@ -780,10 +776,10 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
:meth:`__index__` method that returns an integer.
-.. function:: open(file, mode='r', buffering=-1, encoding=None, errors=None, newline=None, closefd=True)
+.. function:: open(file, mode='r', buffering=-1, encoding=None, errors=None, newline=None, closefd=True, opener=None)
Open *file* and return a corresponding stream. If the file cannot be opened,
- an :exc:`IOError` is raised.
+ an :exc:`OSError` is raised.
*file* is either a string or bytes object giving the pathname (absolute or
relative to the current working directory) of the file to be opened or
@@ -887,6 +883,15 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
closed. If a filename is given *closefd* has no effect and must be ``True``
(the default).
+ A custom opener can be used by passing a callable as *opener*. The underlying
+ file descriptor for the file object is then obtained by calling *opener* with
+ (*file*, *flags*). *opener* must return an open file descriptor (passing
+ :mod:`os.open` as *opener* results in functionality similar to passing
+ ``None``).
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *opener* parameter was added.
+
The type of file object returned by the :func:`open` function depends on the
mode. When :func:`open` is used to open a file in a text mode (``'w'``,
``'r'``, ``'wt'``, ``'rt'``, etc.), it returns a subclass of
@@ -912,6 +917,9 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
(where :func:`open` is declared), :mod:`os`, :mod:`os.path`, :mod:`tempfile`,
and :mod:`shutil`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised, it is now an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. XXX works for bytes too, but should it?
.. function:: ord(c)
@@ -921,9 +929,6 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
point of that character. For example, ``ord('a')`` returns the integer ``97``
and ``ord('\u2020')`` returns ``8224``. This is the inverse of :func:`chr`.
- On wide Unicode builds, if the argument length is not one, a
- :exc:`TypeError` will be raised. On narrow Unicode builds, strings
- of length two are accepted when they form a UTF-16 surrogate pair.
.. function:: pow(x, y[, z])
@@ -941,7 +946,7 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
must be of integer types, and *y* must be non-negative.
-.. function:: print([object, ...], *, sep=' ', end='\\n', file=sys.stdout)
+.. function:: print([object, ...], *, sep=' ', end='\\n', file=sys.stdout, flush=False)
Print *object*\(s) to the stream *file*, separated by *sep* and followed by
*end*. *sep*, *end* and *file*, if present, must be given as keyword
@@ -954,9 +959,12 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
*end*.
The *file* argument must be an object with a ``write(string)`` method; if it
- is not present or ``None``, :data:`sys.stdout` will be used. Output buffering
- is determined by *file*. Use ``file.flush()`` to ensure, for instance,
- immediate appearance on a screen.
+ is not present or ``None``, :data:`sys.stdout` will be used. Whether output
+ is buffered is usually determined by *file*, but if the *flush* keyword
+ argument is true, the stream is forcibly flushed.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *flush* keyword argument.
.. function:: property(fget=None, fset=None, fdel=None, doc=None)
@@ -1039,7 +1047,9 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
...]``. If *step* is positive, the last element is the largest ``start + i *
step`` less than *stop*; if *step* is negative, the last element is the
smallest ``start + i * step`` greater than *stop*. *step* must not be zero
- (or else :exc:`ValueError` is raised). Example:
+ (or else :exc:`ValueError` is raised). Range objects have read-only data
+ attributes :attr:`start`, :attr:`stop` and :attr:`step` which return the
+ argument values (or their default). Example:
>>> list(range(10))
[0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9]
@@ -1076,6 +1086,13 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
>>> r[-1]
18
+ Testing range objects for equality with ``==`` and ``!=`` compares
+ them as sequences. That is, two range objects are considered equal if
+ they represent the same sequence of values. (Note that two range
+ objects that compare equal might have different :attr:`start`,
+ :attr:`stop` and :attr:`step` attributes, for example ``range(0) ==
+ range(2, 1, 3)`` or ``range(0, 3, 2) == range(0, 4, 2)``.)
+
Ranges containing absolute values larger than :data:`sys.maxsize` are permitted
but some features (such as :func:`len`) will raise :exc:`OverflowError`.
@@ -1085,6 +1102,14 @@ are always available. They are listed here in alphabetical order.
Test integers for membership in constant time instead of iterating
through all items.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Define '==' and '!=' to compare range objects based on the
+ sequence of values they define (instead of comparing based on
+ object identity).
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ The :attr:`start`, :attr:`stop` and :attr:`step` attributes.
+
.. function:: repr(object)
diff --git a/Doc/library/functools.rst b/Doc/library/functools.rst
index 04743d3..05f97b1 100644
--- a/Doc/library/functools.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/functools.rst
@@ -40,7 +40,7 @@ The :mod:`functools` module defines the following functions:
.. versionadded:: 3.2
-.. decorator:: lru_cache(maxsize=100)
+.. decorator:: lru_cache(maxsize=100, typed=False)
Decorator to wrap a function with a memoizing callable that saves up to the
*maxsize* most recent calls. It can save time when an expensive or I/O bound
@@ -52,6 +52,10 @@ The :mod:`functools` module defines the following functions:
If *maxsize* is set to None, the LRU feature is disabled and the cache
can grow without bound.
+ If *typed* is set to True, function arguments of different types will be
+ cached separately. For example, ``f(3)`` and ``f(3.0)`` will be treated
+ as distinct calls with distinct results.
+
To help measure the effectiveness of the cache and tune the *maxsize*
parameter, the wrapped function is instrumented with a :func:`cache_info`
function that returns a :term:`named tuple` showing *hits*, *misses*,
@@ -67,8 +71,8 @@ The :mod:`functools` module defines the following functions:
An `LRU (least recently used) cache
<http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Cache_algorithms#Least_Recently_Used>`_ works
- best when more recent calls are the best predictors of upcoming calls (for
- example, the most popular articles on a news server tend to change daily).
+ best when the most recent calls are the best predictors of upcoming calls (for
+ example, the most popular articles on a news server tend to change each day).
The cache's size limit assures that the cache does not grow without bound on
long-running processes such as web servers.
@@ -111,6 +115,9 @@ The :mod:`functools` module defines the following functions:
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *typed* option.
+
.. decorator:: total_ordering
Given a class defining one or more rich comparison ordering methods, this
diff --git a/Doc/library/gettext.rst b/Doc/library/gettext.rst
index 0fa022c..825311b 100644
--- a/Doc/library/gettext.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/gettext.rst
@@ -185,10 +185,13 @@ class can also install themselves in the built-in namespace as the function
translation object from the cache; the actual instance data is still shared with
the cache.
- If no :file:`.mo` file is found, this function raises :exc:`IOError` if
+ If no :file:`.mo` file is found, this function raises :exc:`OSError` if
*fallback* is false (which is the default), and returns a
:class:`NullTranslations` instance if *fallback* is true.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised instead of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: install(domain, localedir=None, codeset=None, names=None)
@@ -342,7 +345,7 @@ The entire set of key/value pairs are placed into a dictionary and set as the
If the :file:`.mo` file's magic number is invalid, or if other problems occur
while reading the file, instantiating a :class:`GNUTranslations` class can raise
-:exc:`IOError`.
+:exc:`OSError`.
The following methods are overridden from the base class implementation:
diff --git a/Doc/library/gzip.rst b/Doc/library/gzip.rst
index 8aca2dd..82c9522 100644
--- a/Doc/library/gzip.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/gzip.rst
@@ -69,7 +69,7 @@ The module defines the following items:
:class:`GzipFile` supports the :class:`io.BufferedIOBase` interface,
including iteration and the :keyword:`with` statement. Only the
- :meth:`read1` and :meth:`truncate` methods aren't implemented.
+ :meth:`truncate` method isn't implemented.
:class:`GzipFile` also provides the following method:
@@ -91,6 +91,9 @@ The module defines the following items:
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Support for unseekable files was added.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The :meth:`io.BufferedIOBase.read1` method is now implemented.
+
.. function:: open(filename, mode='rb', compresslevel=9)
diff --git a/Doc/library/http.client.rst b/Doc/library/http.client.rst
index 52fbe57..f0da8ee 100644
--- a/Doc/library/http.client.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/http.client.rst
@@ -502,6 +502,12 @@ statement.
Reads and returns the response body, or up to the next *amt* bytes.
+.. method:: HTTPResponse.readinto(b)
+
+ Reads up to the next len(b) bytes of the response body into the buffer *b*.
+ Returns the number of bytes read.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. method:: HTTPResponse.getheader(name, default=None)
diff --git a/Doc/library/http.cookiejar.rst b/Doc/library/http.cookiejar.rst
index 9771496..1fe775f 100644
--- a/Doc/library/http.cookiejar.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/http.cookiejar.rst
@@ -40,7 +40,11 @@ The module defines the following exception:
.. exception:: LoadError
Instances of :class:`FileCookieJar` raise this exception on failure to load
- cookies from a file. :exc:`LoadError` is a subclass of :exc:`IOError`.
+ cookies from a file. :exc:`LoadError` is a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ LoadError was made a subclass of :exc:`OSError` instead of
+ :exc:`IOError`.
The following classes are provided:
@@ -257,9 +261,12 @@ contained :class:`Cookie` objects.
Arguments are as for :meth:`save`.
The named file must be in the format understood by the class, or
- :exc:`LoadError` will be raised. Also, :exc:`IOError` may be raised, for
+ :exc:`LoadError` will be raised. Also, :exc:`OSError` may be raised, for
example if the file does not exist.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised, it is now an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. method:: FileCookieJar.revert(filename=None, ignore_discard=False, ignore_expires=False)
diff --git a/Doc/library/http.server.rst b/Doc/library/http.server.rst
index e3a3a10..d9aaa72 100644
--- a/Doc/library/http.server.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/http.server.rst
@@ -179,19 +179,29 @@ of which this module provides three different variants:
.. method:: send_response(code, message=None)
- Sends a response header and logs the accepted request. The HTTP response
- line is sent, followed by *Server* and *Date* headers. The values for
- these two headers are picked up from the :meth:`version_string` and
- :meth:`date_time_string` methods, respectively.
+ Adds a response header to the headers buffer and logs the accepted
+ request. The HTTP response line is written to the internal buffer,
+ followed by *Server* and *Date* headers. The values for these two headers
+ are picked up from the :meth:`version_string` and
+ :meth:`date_time_string` methods, respectively. If the server does not
+ intend to send any other headers using the :meth:`send_header` method,
+ then :meth:`send_response` should be followed by a :meth:`end_headers`
+ call.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Headers are stored to an internal buffer and :meth:`end_headers`
+ needs to be called explicitly.
+
.. method:: send_header(keyword, value)
- Stores the HTTP header to an internal buffer which will be written to the
- output stream when :meth:`end_headers` method is invoked.
- *keyword* should specify the header keyword, with *value*
- specifying its value.
+ Adds the HTTP header to an internal buffer which will be written to the
+ output stream when either :meth:`end_headers` or :meth:`flush_headers` is
+ invoked. *keyword* should specify the header keyword, with *value*
+ specifying its value. Note that, after the send_header calls are done,
+ :meth:`end_headers` MUST BE called in order to complete the operation.
- .. versionchanged:: 3.2 Storing the headers in an internal buffer
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.2 Headers are stored in an internal buffer.
.. method:: send_response_only(code, message=None)
@@ -205,10 +215,19 @@ of which this module provides three different variants:
.. method:: end_headers()
- Write the buffered HTTP headers to the output stream and send a blank
- line, indicating the end of the HTTP headers in the response.
+ Adds a blank line
+ (indicating the end of the HTTP headers in the response)
+ to the headers buffer and calls :meth:`flush_headers()`.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.2
+ The buffered headers are written to the output stream.
+
+ .. method:: flush_headers()
+
+ Finally send the headers to the output stream and flush the internal
+ headers buffer.
- .. versionchanged:: 3.2 Writing the buffered headers to the output stream.
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. method:: log_request(code='-', size='-')
@@ -299,7 +318,7 @@ of which this module provides three different variants:
response if the :func:`listdir` fails.
If the request was mapped to a file, it is opened and the contents are
- returned. Any :exc:`IOError` exception in opening the requested file is
+ returned. Any :exc:`OSError` exception in opening the requested file is
mapped to a ``404``, ``'File not found'`` error. Otherwise, the content
type is guessed by calling the :meth:`guess_type` method, which in turn
uses the *extensions_map* variable.
diff --git a/Doc/library/imaplib.rst b/Doc/library/imaplib.rst
index 3f45c95..038355c 100644
--- a/Doc/library/imaplib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/imaplib.rst
@@ -64,14 +64,21 @@ Three exceptions are defined as attributes of the :class:`IMAP4` class:
There's also a subclass for secure connections:
-.. class:: IMAP4_SSL(host='', port=IMAP4_SSL_PORT, keyfile=None, certfile=None)
+.. class:: IMAP4_SSL(host='', port=IMAP4_SSL_PORT, keyfile=None, certfile=None, ssl_context=None)
This is a subclass derived from :class:`IMAP4` that connects over an SSL
encrypted socket (to use this class you need a socket module that was compiled
with SSL support). If *host* is not specified, ``''`` (the local host) is used.
If *port* is omitted, the standard IMAP4-over-SSL port (993) is used. *keyfile*
and *certfile* are also optional - they can contain a PEM formatted private key
- and certificate chain file for the SSL connection.
+ and certificate chain file for the SSL connection. *ssl_context* parameter is a
+ :class:`ssl.SSLContext` object which allows bundling SSL configuration
+ options, certificates and private keys into a single (potentially long-lived)
+ structure. Note that the *keyfile*/*certfile* parameters are mutually exclusive with *ssl_context*,
+ a :class:`ValueError` is thrown if *keyfile*/*certfile* is provided along with *ssl_context*.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *ssl_context* parameter added.
The second subclass allows for connections created by a child process:
diff --git a/Doc/library/importlib.rst b/Doc/library/importlib.rst
index c9f742a..6dd13cc 100644
--- a/Doc/library/importlib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/importlib.rst
@@ -239,11 +239,30 @@ are also provided to help in implementing the core ABCs.
optimization to speed up loading by removing the parsing step of Python's
compiler, and so no bytecode-specific API is exposed.
+ .. method:: path_stats(self, path)
+
+ Optional abstract method which returns a :class:`dict` containing
+ metadata about the specifed path. Supported dictionary keys are:
+
+ - ``'mtime'`` (mandatory): an integer or floating-point number
+ representing the modification time of the source code;
+ - ``'size'`` (optional): the size in bytes of the source code.
+
+ Any other keys in the dictionary are ignored, to allow for future
+ extensions.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. method:: path_mtime(self, path)
Optional abstract method which returns the modification time for the
specified path.
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ This method is deprecated in favour of :meth:`path_stats`. You don't
+ have to implement it, but it is still available for compatibility
+ purposes.
+
.. method:: set_data(self, path, data)
Optional abstract method which writes the specified bytes to a file
diff --git a/Doc/library/inspect.rst b/Doc/library/inspect.rst
index d127ce8..ac6ae99 100644
--- a/Doc/library/inspect.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/inspect.rst
@@ -355,17 +355,25 @@ Retrieving source code
argument may be a module, class, method, function, traceback, frame, or code
object. The source code is returned as a list of the lines corresponding to the
object and the line number indicates where in the original source file the first
- line of code was found. An :exc:`IOError` is raised if the source code cannot
+ line of code was found. An :exc:`OSError` is raised if the source code cannot
be retrieved.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`OSError` is raised instead of :exc:`IOError`, now an alias of the
+ former.
+
.. function:: getsource(object)
Return the text of the source code for an object. The argument may be a module,
class, method, function, traceback, frame, or code object. The source code is
- returned as a single string. An :exc:`IOError` is raised if the source code
+ returned as a single string. An :exc:`OSError` is raised if the source code
cannot be retrieved.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`OSError` is raised instead of :exc:`IOError`, now an alias of the
+ former.
+
.. function:: cleandoc(doc)
diff --git a/Doc/library/io.rst b/Doc/library/io.rst
index becc4a2..4d564bb 100644
--- a/Doc/library/io.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/io.rst
@@ -33,6 +33,10 @@ giving a :class:`str` object to the ``write()`` method of a binary stream
will raise a ``TypeError``. So will giving a :class:`bytes` object to the
``write()`` method of a text stream.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Operations defined in this module used to raise :exc:`IOError`, which is
+ now an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
Text I/O
^^^^^^^^
@@ -109,21 +113,13 @@ High-level Module Interface
.. exception:: BlockingIOError
- Error raised when blocking would occur on a non-blocking stream. It inherits
- :exc:`IOError`.
-
- In addition to those of :exc:`IOError`, :exc:`BlockingIOError` has one
- attribute:
-
- .. attribute:: characters_written
-
- An integer containing the number of characters written to the stream
- before it blocked.
+ This is a compatibility alias for the builtin :exc:`BlockingIOError`
+ exception.
.. exception:: UnsupportedOperation
- An exception inheriting :exc:`IOError` and :exc:`ValueError` that is raised
+ An exception inheriting :exc:`OSError` and :exc:`ValueError` that is raised
when an unsupported operation is called on a stream.
@@ -202,8 +198,8 @@ I/O Base Classes
Even though :class:`IOBase` does not declare :meth:`read`, :meth:`readinto`,
or :meth:`write` because their signatures will vary, implementations and
clients should consider those methods part of the interface. Also,
- implementations may raise a :exc:`IOError` when operations they do not
- support are called.
+ implementations may raise a :exc:`ValueError` (or :exc:`UnsupportedOperation`)
+ when operations they do not support are called.
The basic type used for binary data read from or written to a file is
:class:`bytes`. :class:`bytearray`\s are accepted too, and in some cases
@@ -211,7 +207,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
:class:`str` data.
Note that calling any method (even inquiries) on a closed stream is
- undefined. Implementations may raise :exc:`IOError` in this case.
+ undefined. Implementations may raise :exc:`ValueError` in this case.
IOBase (and its subclasses) support the iterator protocol, meaning that an
:class:`IOBase` object can be iterated over yielding the lines in a stream.
@@ -244,7 +240,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
.. method:: fileno()
Return the underlying file descriptor (an integer) of the stream if it
- exists. An :exc:`IOError` is raised if the IO object does not use a file
+ exists. An :exc:`OSError` is raised if the IO object does not use a file
descriptor.
.. method:: flush()
@@ -260,7 +256,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
.. method:: readable()
Return ``True`` if the stream can be read from. If False, :meth:`read`
- will raise :exc:`IOError`.
+ will raise :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: readline(limit=-1)
@@ -298,7 +294,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
.. method:: seekable()
Return ``True`` if the stream supports random access. If ``False``,
- :meth:`seek`, :meth:`tell` and :meth:`truncate` will raise :exc:`IOError`.
+ :meth:`seek`, :meth:`tell` and :meth:`truncate` will raise :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: tell()
@@ -316,7 +312,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
.. method:: writable()
Return ``True`` if the stream supports writing. If ``False``,
- :meth:`write` and :meth:`truncate` will raise :exc:`IOError`.
+ :meth:`write` and :meth:`truncate` will raise :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: writelines(lines)
@@ -450,7 +446,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
Write the given bytes or bytearray object, *b* and return the number
of bytes written (never less than ``len(b)``, since if the write fails
- an :exc:`IOError` will be raised). Depending on the actual
+ an :exc:`OSError` will be raised). Depending on the actual
implementation, these bytes may be readily written to the underlying
stream, or held in a buffer for performance and latency reasons.
@@ -462,7 +458,7 @@ I/O Base Classes
Raw File I/O
^^^^^^^^^^^^
-.. class:: FileIO(name, mode='r', closefd=True)
+.. class:: FileIO(name, mode='r', closefd=True, opener=None)
:class:`FileIO` represents an OS-level file containing bytes data.
It implements the :class:`RawIOBase` interface (and therefore the
@@ -475,14 +471,27 @@ Raw File I/O
* an integer representing the number of an existing OS-level file descriptor
to which the resulting :class:`FileIO` object will give access.
- The *mode* can be ``'r'``, ``'w'`` or ``'a'`` for reading (default), writing,
- or appending. The file will be created if it doesn't exist when opened for
- writing or appending; it will be truncated when opened for writing. Add a
+ The *mode* can be ``'r'``, ``'w'``, ``'x'`` or ``'a'`` for reading
+ (default), writing, exclusive creation or appending. The file will be
+ created if it doesn't exist when opened for writing or appending; it will be
+ truncated when opened for writing. :exc:`FileExistsError` will be raised if
+ it already exists when opened for creating. Opening a file for creating
+ implies writing, so this mode behaves in a similar way to ``'w'``. Add a
``'+'`` to the mode to allow simultaneous reading and writing.
The :meth:`read` (when called with a positive argument), :meth:`readinto`
and :meth:`write` methods on this class will only make one system call.
+ A custom opener can be used by passing a callable as *opener*. The underlying
+ file descriptor for the file object is then obtained by calling *opener* with
+ (*name*, *flags*). *opener* must return an open file descriptor (passing
+ :mod:`os.open` as *opener* results in functionality similar to passing
+ ``None``).
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *opener* parameter was added.
+ The ``'x'`` mode was added.
+
In addition to the attributes and methods from :class:`IOBase` and
:class:`RawIOBase`, :class:`FileIO` provides the following data
attributes and methods:
@@ -736,7 +745,8 @@ Text I/O
written.
-.. class:: TextIOWrapper(buffer, encoding=None, errors=None, newline=None, line_buffering=False)
+.. class:: TextIOWrapper(buffer, encoding=None, errors=None, newline=None, \
+ line_buffering=False, write_through=False)
A buffered text stream over a :class:`BufferedIOBase` binary stream.
It inherits :class:`TextIOBase`.
@@ -767,6 +777,13 @@ Text I/O
If *line_buffering* is ``True``, :meth:`flush` is implied when a call to
write contains a newline character.
+ If *write_through* is ``True``, calls to :meth:`write` are guaranteed
+ not to be buffered: any data written on the :class:`TextIOWrapper`
+ object is immediately handled to its underlying binary *buffer*.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *write_through* argument has been added.
+
:class:`TextIOWrapper` provides one attribute in addition to those of
:class:`TextIOBase` and its parents:
diff --git a/Doc/library/itertools.rst b/Doc/library/itertools.rst
index d1d1188..994a25a 100644
--- a/Doc/library/itertools.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/itertools.rst
@@ -46,7 +46,7 @@ Iterator Arguments Results
==================== ============================ ================================================= =============================================================
Iterator Arguments Results Example
==================== ============================ ================================================= =============================================================
-:func:`accumulate` p p0, p0+p1, p0+p1+p2, ... ``accumulate([1,2,3,4,5]) --> 1 3 6 10 15``
+:func:`accumulate` p [,func] p0, p0+p1, p0+p1+p2, ... ``accumulate([1,2,3,4,5]) --> 1 3 6 10 15``
:func:`chain` p, q, ... p0, p1, ... plast, q0, q1, ... ``chain('ABC', 'DEF') --> A B C D E F``
:func:`compress` data, selectors (d[0] if s[0]), (d[1] if s[1]), ... ``compress('ABCDEF', [1,0,1,0,1,1]) --> A C E F``
:func:`dropwhile` pred, seq seq[n], seq[n+1], starting when pred fails ``dropwhile(lambda x: x<5, [1,4,6,4,1]) --> 6 4 1``
@@ -84,23 +84,61 @@ The following module functions all construct and return iterators. Some provide
streams of infinite length, so they should only be accessed by functions or
loops that truncate the stream.
-.. function:: accumulate(iterable)
+.. function:: accumulate(iterable[, func])
Make an iterator that returns accumulated sums. Elements may be any addable
- type including :class:`Decimal` or :class:`Fraction`. Equivalent to::
+ type including :class:`Decimal` or :class:`Fraction`. If the optional
+ *func* argument is supplied, it should be a function of two arguments
+ and it will be used instead of addition.
- def accumulate(iterable):
+ Equivalent to::
+
+ def accumulate(iterable, func=operator.add):
'Return running totals'
# accumulate([1,2,3,4,5]) --> 1 3 6 10 15
+ # accumulate([1,2,3,4,5], operator.mul) --> 1 2 6 24 120
it = iter(iterable)
total = next(it)
yield total
for element in it:
- total = total + element
+ total = func(total, element)
yield total
+ There are a number of uses for the *func* argument. It can be set to
+ :func:`min` for a running minimum, :func:`max` for a running maximum, or
+ :func:`operator.mul` for a running product. Amortization tables can be
+ built by accumulating interest and applying payments. First-order
+ `recurrence relations <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Recurrence_relation>`_
+ can be modeled by supplying the initial value in the iterable and using only
+ the accumulated total in *func* argument::
+
+ >>> data = [3, 4, 6, 2, 1, 9, 0, 7, 5, 8]
+ >>> list(accumulate(data, operator.mul)) # running product
+ [3, 12, 72, 144, 144, 1296, 0, 0, 0, 0]
+ >>> list(accumulate(data, max)) # running maximum
+ [3, 4, 6, 6, 6, 9, 9, 9, 9, 9]
+
+ # Amortize a 5% loan of 1000 with 4 annual payments of 90
+ >>> cashflows = [1000, -90, -90, -90, -90]
+ >>> list(accumulate(cashflows, lambda bal, pmt: bal*1.05 + pmt))
+ [1000, 960.0, 918.0, 873.9000000000001, 827.5950000000001]
+
+ # Chaotic recurrence relation http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Logistic_map
+ >>> logistic_map = lambda x, _: r * x * (1 - x)
+ >>> r = 3.8
+ >>> x0 = 0.4
+ >>> inputs = repeat(x0, 36) # only the initial value is used
+ >>> [format(x, '.2f') for x in accumulate(inputs, logistic_map)]
+ ['0.40', '0.91', '0.30', '0.81', '0.60', '0.92', '0.29', '0.79', '0.63',
+ '0.88' ,'0.39', '0.90', '0.33', '0.84', '0.52', '0.95', '0.18', '0.57',
+ '0.93', '0.25', '0.71', '0.79', '0.63', '0.88', '0.39', '0.91', '0.32',
+ '0.83', '0.54', '0.95', '0.20', '0.60', '0.91', '0.30', '0.80', '0.60']
+
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the optional *func* parameter.
+
.. function:: chain(*iterables)
Make an iterator that returns elements from the first iterable until it is
diff --git a/Doc/library/logging.handlers.rst b/Doc/library/logging.handlers.rst
index c4dd438..51e476b 100644
--- a/Doc/library/logging.handlers.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/logging.handlers.rst
@@ -164,6 +164,87 @@ this value.
changed. If it has, the existing stream is flushed and closed and the
file opened again, before outputting the record to the file.
+.. _base-rotating-handler:
+
+BaseRotatingHandler
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+The :class:`BaseRotatingHandler` class, located in the :mod:`logging.handlers`
+module, is the base class for the rotating file handlers,
+:class:`RotatingFileHandler` and :class:`TimedRotatingFileHandler`. You should
+not need to instantiate this class, but it has attributes and methods you may
+need to override.
+
+.. class:: BaseRotatingHandler(filename, mode, encoding=None, delay=False)
+
+ The parameters are as for :class:`FileHandler`. The attributes are:
+
+ .. attribute:: namer
+
+ If this attribute is set to a callable, the :meth:`rotation_filename`
+ method delegates to this callable. The parameters passed to the callable
+ are those passed to :meth:`rotation_filename`.
+
+ .. note:: The namer function is called quite a few times during rollover,
+ so it should be as simple and as fast as possible. It should also
+ return the same output every time for a given input, otherwise the
+ rollover behaviour may not work as expected.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+ .. attribute:: BaseRotatingHandler.rotator
+
+ If this attribute is set to a callable, the :meth:`rotate` method
+ delegates to this callable. The parameters passed to the callable are
+ those passed to :meth:`rotate`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ .. method:: BaseRotatingHandler.rotation_filename(default_name)
+
+ Modify the filename of a log file when rotating.
+
+ This is provided so that a custom filename can be provided.
+
+ The default implementation calls the 'namer' attribute of the handler,
+ if it's callable, passing the default name to it. If the attribute isn't
+ callable (the default is ``None``), the name is returned unchanged.
+
+ :param default_name: The default name for the log file.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+ .. method:: BaseRotatingHandler.rotate(source, dest)
+
+ When rotating, rotate the current log.
+
+ The default implementation calls the 'rotator' attribute of the handler,
+ if it's callable, passing the source and dest arguments to it. If the
+ attribute isn't callable (the default is ``None``), the source is simply
+ renamed to the destination.
+
+ :param source: The source filename. This is normally the base
+ filename, e.g. 'test.log'
+ :param dest: The destination filename. This is normally
+ what the source is rotated to, e.g. 'test.log.1'.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+The reason the attributes exist is to save you having to subclass - you can use
+the same callables for instances of :class:`RotatingFileHandler` and
+:class:`TimedRotatingFileHandler`. If either the namer or rotator callable
+raises an exception, this will be handled in the same way as any other
+exception during an :meth:`emit` call, i.e. via the :meth:`handleError` method
+of the handler.
+
+If you need to make more significant changes to rotation processing, you can
+override the methods.
+
+For an example, see :ref:`cookbook-rotator-namer`.
+
+
.. _rotating-file-handler:
RotatingFileHandler
@@ -452,6 +533,15 @@ supports sending logging messages to a remote or local Unix syslog.
behaviour) but can be set to ``False`` on a ``SysLogHandler`` instance
in order for that instance to *not* append the NUL terminator.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ (See: :issue:`12419`.) In earlier versions, there was no facility for
+ an "ident" or "tag" prefix to identify the source of the message. This
+ can now be specified using a class-level attribute, defaulting to
+ ``""`` to preserve existing behaviour, but which can be overridden on
+ a ``SysLogHandler`` instance in order for that instance to prepend
+ the ident to every message handled. Note that the provided ident must
+ be text, not bytes, and is prepended to the message exactly as is.
+
.. method:: encodePriority(facility, priority)
Encodes the facility and priority into an integer. You can pass in strings
@@ -690,7 +780,7 @@ should, then :meth:`flush` is expected to do the needful.
.. method:: close()
- Calls :meth:`flush`, sets the target to :const:`None` and clears the
+ Calls :meth:`flush`, sets the target to ``None`` and clears the
buffer.
@@ -859,6 +949,15 @@ possible, while any potentially slow operations (such as sending an email via
Note that if you don't call this before your application exits, there
may be some records still left on the queue, which won't be processed.
+ .. method:: enqueue_sentinel()
+
+ Writes a sentinel to the queue to tell the listener to quit. This
+ implementation uses ``put_nowait()``. You may want to override this
+ method if you want to use timeouts or work with custom queue
+ implementations.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. seealso::
diff --git a/Doc/library/logging.rst b/Doc/library/logging.rst
index 5a41160..b0487dd 100644
--- a/Doc/library/logging.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/logging.rst
@@ -200,6 +200,9 @@ instantiated directly, but always through the module-level function
Logs a message with level :const:`WARNING` on this logger. The arguments are
interpreted as for :meth:`debug`.
+ .. note:: There is an obsolete method ``warn`` which is functionally
+ identical to ``warning``. As ``warn`` is deprecated, please do not use
+ it - use ``warning`` instead.
.. method:: Logger.error(msg, *args, **kwargs)
@@ -477,6 +480,19 @@ The useful mapping keys in a :class:`LogRecord` are given in the section on
want all logging times to be shown in GMT, set the ``converter``
attribute in the ``Formatter`` class.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Previously, the default ISO 8601 format was hard-coded as in this
+ example: ``2010-09-06 22:38:15,292`` where the part before the comma is
+ handled by a strptime format string (``'%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S'``), and the
+ part after the comma is a millisecond value. Because strptime does not
+ have a format placeholder for milliseconds, the millisecond value is
+ appended using another format string, ``'%s,%03d'`` – and both of these
+ format strings have been hardcoded into this method. With the change,
+ these strings are defined as class-level attributes which can be
+ overridden at the instance level when desired. The names of the
+ attributes are ``default_time_format`` (for the strptime format string)
+ and ``default_msec_format`` (for appending the millisecond value).
+
.. method:: formatException(exc_info)
Formats the specified exception information (a standard exception tuple as
@@ -883,8 +899,12 @@ functions.
.. function:: warning(msg, *args, **kwargs)
- Logs a message with level :const:`WARNING` on the root logger. The arguments are
- interpreted as for :func:`debug`.
+ Logs a message with level :const:`WARNING` on the root logger. The arguments
+ are interpreted as for :func:`debug`.
+
+ .. note:: There is an obsolete function ``warn`` which is functionally
+ identical to ``warning``. As ``warn`` is deprecated, please do not use
+ it - use ``warning`` instead.
.. function:: error(msg, *args, **kwargs)
@@ -1009,12 +1029,27 @@ functions.
| ``stream`` | Use the specified stream to initialize the |
| | StreamHandler. Note that this argument is |
| | incompatible with 'filename' - if both are |
- | | present, 'stream' is ignored. |
+ | | present, a ``ValueError`` is raised. |
+ +--------------+---------------------------------------------+
+ | ``handlers`` | If specified, this should be an iterable of |
+ | | already created handlers to add to the root |
+ | | logger. Any handlers which don't already |
+ | | have a formatter set will be assigned the |
+ | | default formatter created in this function. |
+ | | Note that this argument is incompatible |
+ | | with 'filename' or 'stream' - if both are |
+ | | present, a ``ValueError`` is raised. |
+--------------+---------------------------------------------+
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
The ``style`` argument was added.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The ``handlers`` argument was added. Additional checks were added to
+ catch situations where incompatible arguments are specified (e.g.
+ ``handlers`` together with ``stream`` or ``filename``, or ``stream``
+ together with ``filename``).
+
.. function:: shutdown()
diff --git a/Doc/library/lzma.rst b/Doc/library/lzma.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cae05b6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/lzma.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,349 @@
+:mod:`lzma` --- Compression using the LZMA algorithm
+====================================================
+
+.. module:: lzma
+ :synopsis: A Python wrapper for the liblzma compression library.
+.. moduleauthor:: Nadeem Vawda <nadeem.vawda@gmail.com>
+.. sectionauthor:: Nadeem Vawda <nadeem.vawda@gmail.com>
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+This module provides classes and convenience functions for compressing and
+decompressing data using the LZMA compression algorithm. Also included is a file
+interface supporting the ``.xz`` and legacy ``.lzma`` file formats used by the
+:program:`xz` utility, as well as raw compressed streams.
+
+The interface provided by this module is very similar to that of the :mod:`bz2`
+module. However, note that :class:`LZMAFile` is *not* thread-safe, unlike
+:class:`bz2.BZ2File`, so if you need to use a single :class:`LZMAFile` instance
+from multiple threads, it is necessary to protect it with a lock.
+
+
+.. exception:: LZMAError
+
+ This exception is raised when an error occurs during compression or
+ decompression, or while initializing the compressor/decompressor state.
+
+
+Reading and writing compressed files
+------------------------------------
+
+.. class:: LZMAFile(filename=None, mode="r", \*, fileobj=None, format=None, check=-1, preset=None, filters=None)
+
+ Open an LZMA-compressed file.
+
+ An :class:`LZMAFile` can wrap an existing :term:`file object` (given by
+ *fileobj*), or operate directly on a named file (named by *filename*).
+ Exactly one of these two parameters should be provided. If *fileobj* is
+ provided, it is not closed when the :class:`LZMAFile` is closed.
+
+ The *mode* argument can be either ``"r"`` for reading (default), ``"w"`` for
+ overwriting, or ``"a"`` for appending. If *fileobj* is provided, a mode of
+ ``"w"`` does not truncate the file, and is instead equivalent to ``"a"``.
+
+ When opening a file for reading, the input file may be the concatenation of
+ multiple separate compressed streams. These are transparently decoded as a
+ single logical stream.
+
+ When opening a file for reading, the *format* and *filters* arguments have
+ the same meanings as for :class:`LZMADecompressor`. In this case, the *check*
+ and *preset* arguments should not be used.
+
+ When opening a file for writing, the *format*, *check*, *preset* and
+ *filters* arguments have the same meanings as for :class:`LZMACompressor`.
+
+ :class:`LZMAFile` supports all the members specified by
+ :class:`io.BufferedIOBase`, except for :meth:`detach` and :meth:`truncate`.
+ Iteration and the :keyword:`with` statement are supported.
+
+ The following method is also provided:
+
+ .. method:: peek(size=-1)
+
+ Return buffered data without advancing the file position. At least one
+ byte of data will be returned, unless EOF has been reached. The exact
+ number of bytes returned is unspecified (the *size* argument is ignored).
+
+
+Compressing and decompressing data in memory
+--------------------------------------------
+
+.. class:: LZMACompressor(format=FORMAT_XZ, check=-1, preset=None, filters=None)
+
+ Create a compressor object, which can be used to compress data incrementally.
+
+ For a more convenient way of compressing a single chunk of data, see
+ :func:`compress`.
+
+ The *format* argument specifies what container format should be used.
+ Possible values are:
+
+ * :const:`FORMAT_XZ`: The ``.xz`` container format.
+ This is the default format.
+
+ * :const:`FORMAT_ALONE`: The legacy ``.lzma`` container format.
+ This format is more limited than ``.xz`` -- it does not support integrity
+ checks or multiple filters.
+
+ * :const:`FORMAT_RAW`: A raw data stream, not using any container format.
+ This format specifier does not support integrity checks, and requires that
+ you always specify a custom filter chain (for both compression and
+ decompression). Additionally, data compressed in this manner cannot be
+ decompressed using :const:`FORMAT_AUTO` (see :class:`LZMADecompressor`).
+
+ The *check* argument specifies the type of integrity check to include in the
+ compressed data. This check is used when decompressing, to ensure that the
+ data has not been corrupted. Possible values are:
+
+ * :const:`CHECK_NONE`: No integrity check.
+ This is the default (and the only acceptable value) for
+ :const:`FORMAT_ALONE` and :const:`FORMAT_RAW`.
+
+ * :const:`CHECK_CRC32`: 32-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check.
+
+ * :const:`CHECK_CRC64`: 64-bit Cyclic Redundancy Check.
+ This is the default for :const:`FORMAT_XZ`.
+
+ * :const:`CHECK_SHA256`: 256-bit Secure Hash Algorithm.
+
+ If the specified check is not supported, an :class:`LZMAError` is raised.
+
+ The compression settings can be specified either as a preset compression
+ level (with the *preset* argument), or in detail as a custom filter chain
+ (with the *filters* argument).
+
+ The *preset* argument (if provided) should be an integer between ``0`` and
+ ``9`` (inclusive), optionally OR-ed with the constant
+ :const:`PRESET_EXTREME`. If neither *preset* nor *filters* are given, the
+ default behavior is to use :const:`PRESET_DEFAULT` (preset level ``6``).
+ Higher presets produce smaller output, but make the compression process
+ slower.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ In addition to being more CPU-intensive, compression with higher presets
+ also requires much more memory (and produces output that needs more memory
+ to decompress). With preset ``9`` for example, the overhead for an
+ :class:`LZMACompressor` object can be as high as 800MiB. For this reason,
+ it is generally best to stick with the default preset.
+
+ The *filters* argument (if provided) should be a filter chain specifier.
+ See :ref:`filter-chain-specs` for details.
+
+ .. method:: compress(data)
+
+ Compress *data* (a :class:`bytes` object), returning a :class:`bytes`
+ object containing compressed data for at least part of the input. Some of
+ *data* may be buffered internally, for use in later calls to
+ :meth:`compress` and :meth:`flush`. The returned data should be
+ concatenated with the output of any previous calls to :meth:`compress`.
+
+ .. method:: flush()
+
+ Finish the compression process, returning a :class:`bytes` object
+ containing any data stored in the compressor's internal buffers.
+
+ The compressor cannot be used after this method has been called.
+
+
+.. class:: LZMADecompressor(format=FORMAT_AUTO, memlimit=None, filters=None)
+
+ Create a decompressor object, which can be used to decompress data
+ incrementally.
+
+ For a more convenient way of decompressing an entire compressed stream at
+ once, see :func:`decompress`.
+
+ The *format* argument specifies the container format that should be used. The
+ default is :const:`FORMAT_AUTO`, which can decompress both ``.xz`` and
+ ``.lzma`` files. Other possible values are :const:`FORMAT_XZ`,
+ :const:`FORMAT_ALONE`, and :const:`FORMAT_RAW`.
+
+ The *memlimit* argument specifies a limit (in bytes) on the amount of memory
+ that the decompressor can use. When this argument is used, decompression will
+ fail with an :class:`LZMAError` if it is not possible to decompress the input
+ within the given memory limit.
+
+ The *filters* argument specifies the filter chain that was used to create
+ the stream being decompressed. This argument is required if *format* is
+ :const:`FORMAT_RAW`, but should not be used for other formats.
+ See :ref:`filter-chain-specs` for more information about filter chains.
+
+ .. note::
+ This class does not transparently handle inputs containing multiple
+ compressed streams, unlike :func:`decompress` and :class:`LZMAFile`. To
+ decompress a multi-stream input with :class:`LZMADecompressor`, you must
+ create a new decompressor for each stream.
+
+ .. method:: decompress(data)
+
+ Decompress *data* (a :class:`bytes` object), returning a :class:`bytes`
+ object containing the decompressed data for at least part of the input.
+ Some of *data* may be buffered internally, for use in later calls to
+ :meth:`decompress`. The returned data should be concatenated with the
+ output of any previous calls to :meth:`decompress`.
+
+ .. attribute:: check
+
+ The ID of the integrity check used by the input stream. This may be
+ :const:`CHECK_UNKNOWN` until enough of the input has been decoded to
+ determine what integrity check it uses.
+
+ .. attribute:: eof
+
+ True if the end-of-stream marker has been reached.
+
+ .. attribute:: unused_data
+
+ Data found after the end of the compressed stream.
+
+ Before the end of the stream is reached, this will be ``b""``.
+
+
+.. function:: compress(data, format=FORMAT_XZ, check=-1, preset=None, filters=None)
+
+ Compress *data* (a :class:`bytes` object), returning the compressed data as a
+ :class:`bytes` object.
+
+ See :class:`LZMACompressor` above for a description of the *format*, *check*,
+ *preset* and *filters* arguments.
+
+
+.. function:: decompress(data, format=FORMAT_AUTO, memlimit=None, filters=None)
+
+ Decompress *data* (a :class:`bytes` object), returning the uncompressed data
+ as a :class:`bytes` object.
+
+ If *data* is the concatenation of multiple distinct compressed streams,
+ decompress all of these streams, and return the concatenation of the results.
+
+ See :class:`LZMADecompressor` above for a description of the *format*,
+ *memlimit* and *filters* arguments.
+
+
+Miscellaneous
+-------------
+
+.. function:: check_is_supported(check)
+
+ Returns true if the given integrity check is supported on this system.
+
+ :const:`CHECK_NONE` and :const:`CHECK_CRC32` are always supported.
+ :const:`CHECK_CRC64` and :const:`CHECK_SHA256` may be unavailable if you are
+ using a version of :program:`liblzma` that was compiled with a limited
+ feature set.
+
+
+.. _filter-chain-specs:
+
+Specifying custom filter chains
+-------------------------------
+
+A filter chain specifier is a sequence of dictionaries, where each dictionary
+contains the ID and options for a single filter. Each dictionary must contain
+the key ``"id"``, and may contain additional keys to specify filter-dependent
+options. Valid filter IDs are as follows:
+
+* Compression filters:
+ * :const:`FILTER_LZMA1` (for use with :const:`FORMAT_ALONE`)
+ * :const:`FILTER_LZMA2` (for use with :const:`FORMAT_XZ` and :const:`FORMAT_RAW`)
+
+* Delta filter:
+ * :const:`FILTER_DELTA`
+
+* Branch-Call-Jump (BCJ) filters:
+ * :const:`FILTER_X86`
+ * :const:`FILTER_IA64`
+ * :const:`FILTER_ARM`
+ * :const:`FILTER_ARMTHUMB`
+ * :const:`FILTER_POWERPC`
+ * :const:`FILTER_SPARC`
+
+A filter chain can consist of up to 4 filters, and cannot be empty. The last
+filter in the chain must be a compression filter, and any other filters must be
+delta or BCJ filters.
+
+Compression filters support the following options (specified as additional
+entries in the dictionary representing the filter):
+
+ * ``preset``: A compression preset to use as a source of default values for
+ options that are not specified explicitly.
+ * ``dict_size``: Dictionary size in bytes. This should be between 4KiB and
+ 1.5GiB (inclusive).
+ * ``lc``: Number of literal context bits.
+ * ``lp``: Number of literal position bits. The sum ``lc + lp`` must be at
+ most 4.
+ * ``pb``: Number of position bits; must be at most 4.
+ * ``mode``: :const:`MODE_FAST` or :const:`MODE_NORMAL`.
+ * ``nice_len``: What should be considered a "nice length" for a match.
+ This should be 273 or less.
+ * ``mf``: What match finder to use -- :const:`MF_HC3`, :const:`MF_HC4`,
+ :const:`MF_BT2`, :const:`MF_BT3`, or :const:`MF_BT4`.
+ * ``depth``: Maximum search depth used by match finder. 0 (default) means to
+ select automatically based on other filter options.
+
+The delta filter stores the differences between bytes, producing more repetitive
+input for the compressor in certain circumstances. It only supports a single
+The delta filter supports only one option, ``dist``. This indicates the distance
+between bytes to be subtracted. The default is 1, i.e. take the differences
+between adjacent bytes.
+
+The BCJ filters are intended to be applied to machine code. They convert
+relative branches, calls and jumps in the code to use absolute addressing, with
+the aim of increasing the redundancy that can be exploited by the compressor.
+These filters support one option, ``start_offset``. This specifies the address
+that should be mapped to the beginning of the input data. The default is 0.
+
+
+Examples
+--------
+
+Reading in a compressed file::
+
+ import lzma
+ with lzma.LZMAFile("file.xz") as f:
+ file_content = f.read()
+
+Creating a compressed file::
+
+ import lzma
+ data = b"Insert Data Here"
+ with lzma.LZMAFile("file.xz", "w") as f:
+ f.write(data)
+
+Compressing data in memory::
+
+ import lzma
+ data_in = b"Insert Data Here"
+ data_out = lzma.compress(data_in)
+
+Incremental compression::
+
+ import lzma
+ lzc = lzma.LZMACompressor()
+ out1 = lzc.compress(b"Some data\n")
+ out2 = lzc.compress(b"Another piece of data\n")
+ out3 = lzc.compress(b"Even more data\n")
+ out4 = lzc.flush()
+ # Concatenate all the partial results:
+ result = b"".join([out1, out2, out3, out4])
+
+Writing compressed data to an already-open file::
+
+ import lzma
+ with open("file.xz", "wb") as f:
+ f.write(b"This data will not be compressed\n")
+ with lzma.LZMAFile(fileobj=f, mode="w") as lzf:
+ lzf.write(b"This *will* be compressed\n")
+ f.write(b"Not compressed\n")
+
+Creating a compressed file using a custom filter chain::
+
+ import lzma
+ my_filters = [
+ {"id": lzma.FILTER_DELTA, "dist": 5},
+ {"id": lzma.FILTER_LZMA2, "preset": 7 | lzma.PRESET_EXTREME},
+ ]
+ with lzma.LZMAFile("file.xz", "w", filters=my_filters) as f:
+ f.write(b"blah blah blah")
diff --git a/Doc/library/math.rst b/Doc/library/math.rst
index 98c5b33..62c0f34 100644
--- a/Doc/library/math.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/math.rst
@@ -184,6 +184,19 @@ Power and logarithmic functions
result is calculated in a way which is accurate for *x* near zero.
+.. function:: log2(x)
+
+ Return the base-2 logarithm of *x*. This is usually more accurate than
+ ``log(x, 2)``.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ .. seealso::
+
+ :meth:`int.bit_length` returns the number of bits necessary to represent
+ an integer in binary, excluding the sign and leading zeros.
+
+
.. function:: log10(x)
Return the base-10 logarithm of *x*. This is usually more accurate
diff --git a/Doc/library/mmap.rst b/Doc/library/mmap.rst
index 5f0f004..1a19a7e 100644
--- a/Doc/library/mmap.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/mmap.rst
@@ -196,12 +196,16 @@ To map anonymous memory, -1 should be passed as the fileno along with the length
move will raise a :exc:`TypeError` exception.
- .. method:: read(num)
+ .. method:: read([n])
- Return a :class:`bytes` containing up to *num* bytes starting from the
- current file position; the file position is updated to point after the
- bytes that were returned.
+ Return a :class:`bytes` containing up to *n* bytes starting from the
+ current file position. If the argument is omitted, *None* or negative,
+ return all bytes from the current file position to the end of the
+ mapping. The file position is updated to point after the bytes that were
+ returned.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Argument can be omitted or *None*.
.. method:: read_byte()
diff --git a/Doc/library/msvcrt.rst b/Doc/library/msvcrt.rst
index 889a0c5..9d23720 100644
--- a/Doc/library/msvcrt.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/msvcrt.rst
@@ -20,6 +20,11 @@ api. The normal API deals only with ASCII characters and is of limited use
for internationalized applications. The wide char API should be used where
ever possible
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Operations in this module now raise :exc:`OSError` where :exc:`IOError`
+ was raised.
+
+
.. _msvcrt-files:
File Operations
@@ -29,7 +34,7 @@ File Operations
.. function:: locking(fd, mode, nbytes)
Lock part of a file based on file descriptor *fd* from the C runtime. Raises
- :exc:`IOError` on failure. The locked region of the file extends from the
+ :exc:`OSError` on failure. The locked region of the file extends from the
current file position for *nbytes* bytes, and may continue beyond the end of the
file. *mode* must be one of the :const:`LK_\*` constants listed below. Multiple
regions in a file may be locked at the same time, but may not overlap. Adjacent
@@ -41,13 +46,13 @@ File Operations
Locks the specified bytes. If the bytes cannot be locked, the program
immediately tries again after 1 second. If, after 10 attempts, the bytes cannot
- be locked, :exc:`IOError` is raised.
+ be locked, :exc:`OSError` is raised.
.. data:: LK_NBLCK
LK_NBRLCK
- Locks the specified bytes. If the bytes cannot be locked, :exc:`IOError` is
+ Locks the specified bytes. If the bytes cannot be locked, :exc:`OSError` is
raised.
@@ -73,7 +78,7 @@ File Operations
.. function:: get_osfhandle(fd)
- Return the file handle for the file descriptor *fd*. Raises :exc:`IOError` if
+ Return the file handle for the file descriptor *fd*. Raises :exc:`OSError` if
*fd* is not recognized.
@@ -144,4 +149,4 @@ Other Functions
.. function:: heapmin()
Force the :c:func:`malloc` heap to clean itself up and return unused blocks to
- the operating system. On failure, this raises :exc:`IOError`.
+ the operating system. On failure, this raises :exc:`OSError`.
diff --git a/Doc/library/multiprocessing.rst b/Doc/library/multiprocessing.rst
index ebc41f8..106ccd7 100644
--- a/Doc/library/multiprocessing.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/multiprocessing.rst
@@ -297,7 +297,7 @@ The :mod:`multiprocessing` package mostly replicates the API of the
:class:`Process` and exceptions
~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
-.. class:: Process([group[, target[, name[, args[, kwargs]]]]])
+.. class:: Process([group[, target[, name[, args[, kwargs]]]]], *, daemon=None)
Process objects represent activity that is run in a separate process. The
:class:`Process` class has equivalents of all the methods of
@@ -312,13 +312,19 @@ The :mod:`multiprocessing` package mostly replicates the API of the
:sub:`1`,N\ :sub:`2`,...,N\ :sub:`k` is a sequence of integers whose length
is determined by the *generation* of the process. *args* is the argument
tuple for the target invocation. *kwargs* is a dictionary of keyword
- arguments for the target invocation. By default, no arguments are passed to
- *target*.
+ arguments for the target invocation. If provided, the keyword-only *daemon* argument
+ sets the process :attr:`daemon` flag to ``True`` or ``False``. If ``None``
+ (the default), this flag will be inherited from the creating process.
+
+ By default, no arguments are passed to *target*.
If a subclass overrides the constructor, it must make sure it invokes the
base class constructor (:meth:`Process.__init__`) before doing anything else
to the process.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *daemon* argument.
+
.. method:: run()
Method representing the process's activity.
@@ -337,10 +343,9 @@ The :mod:`multiprocessing` package mostly replicates the API of the
.. method:: join([timeout])
- Block the calling thread until the process whose :meth:`join` method is
- called terminates or until the optional timeout occurs.
-
- If *timeout* is ``None`` then there is no timeout.
+ If the optional argument *timeout* is ``None`` (the default), the method
+ blocks until the process whose :meth:`join` method is called terminates.
+ If *timeout* is a positive number, it blocks at most *timeout* seconds.
A process can be joined many times.
@@ -405,6 +410,20 @@ The :mod:`multiprocessing` package mostly replicates the API of the
See :ref:`multiprocessing-auth-keys`.
+ .. attribute:: sentinel
+
+ A numeric handle of a system object which will become "ready" when
+ the process ends.
+
+ On Windows, this is an OS handle usable with the ``WaitForSingleObject``
+ and ``WaitForMultipleObjects`` family of API calls. On Unix, this is
+ a file descriptor usable with primitives from the :mod:`select` module.
+
+ You can use this value if you want to wait on several events at once.
+ Otherwise calling :meth:`join()` is simpler.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. method:: terminate()
Terminate the process. On Unix this is done using the ``SIGTERM`` signal;
@@ -767,9 +786,14 @@ Connection objects are usually created using :func:`Pipe` -- see also
to receive and the other end has closed.
If *maxlength* is specified and the message is longer than *maxlength*
- then :exc:`IOError` is raised and the connection will no longer be
+ then :exc:`OSError` is raised and the connection will no longer be
readable.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`IOError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+
.. method:: recv_bytes_into(buffer[, offset])
Read into *buffer* a complete message of byte data sent from the other end
@@ -1640,6 +1664,24 @@ with the :class:`Pool` class.
returned iterator should be considered arbitrary. (Only when there is
only one worker process is the order guaranteed to be "correct".)
+ .. method:: starmap(func, iterable[, chunksize])
+
+ Like :meth:`map` except that the elements of the `iterable` are expected
+ to be iterables that are unpacked as arguments.
+
+ Hence an `iterable` of `[(1,2), (3, 4)]` results in `[func(1,2),
+ func(3,4)]`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ .. method:: starmap_async(func, iterable[, chunksize[, callback[, error_back]]])
+
+ A combination of :meth:`starmap` and :meth:`map_async` that iterates over
+ `iterable` of iterables and calls `func` with the iterables unpacked.
+ Returns a result object.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. method:: close()
Prevents any more tasks from being submitted to the pool. Once all the
diff --git a/Doc/library/nntplib.rst b/Doc/library/nntplib.rst
index ef507e1..62da72c 100644
--- a/Doc/library/nntplib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/nntplib.rst
@@ -70,10 +70,23 @@ The module itself defines the following classes:
connecting to an NNTP server on the local machine and intend to call
reader-specific commands, such as ``group``. If you get unexpected
:exc:`NNTPPermanentError`\ s, you might need to set *readermode*.
+ :class:`NNTP` class supports the :keyword:`with` statement to
+ unconditionally consume :exc:`socket.error` exceptions and to close the NNTP
+ connection when done. Here is a sample on how using it:
+
+ >>> from nntplib import NNTP
+ >>> with NNTP('news.gmane.org') as n:
+ ... n.group('gmane.comp.python.committers')
+ ...
+ ('211 1755 1 1755 gmane.comp.python.committers', 1755, 1, 1755, 'gmane.comp.python.committers')
+ >>>
+
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
*usenetrc* is now False by default.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Support for the :keyword:`with` statement was added.
.. class:: NNTP_SSL(host, port=563, user=None, password=None, ssl_context=None, readermode=None, usenetrc=False, [timeout])
@@ -504,6 +517,9 @@ them have been superseded by newer commands in :rfc:`3977`.
article with message ID *id*. Most of the time, this extension is not
enabled by NNTP server administrators.
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ The XPATH extension is not actively used.
+
.. XXX deprecated:
diff --git a/Doc/library/os.rst b/Doc/library/os.rst
index be322a0..c3dfb3d 100644
--- a/Doc/library/os.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/os.rst
@@ -221,6 +221,17 @@ process and user.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: getgrouplist(user, group)
+
+ Return list of group ids that *user* belongs to. If *group* is not in the
+ list, it is included; typically, *group* is specified as the group ID
+ field from the password record for *user*.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: getgroups()
Return list of supplemental group ids associated with the current process.
@@ -288,6 +299,22 @@ process and user.
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Added support for Windows.
+.. function:: getpriority(which, who)
+
+ .. index:: single: process; scheduling priority
+
+ Get program scheduling priority. The value *which* is one of
+ :const:`PRIO_PROCESS`, :const:`PRIO_PGRP`, or :const:`PRIO_USER`, and *who*
+ is interpreted relative to *which* (a process identifier for
+ :const:`PRIO_PROCESS`, process group identifier for :const:`PRIO_PGRP`, and a
+ user ID for :const:`PRIO_USER`). A zero value for *who* denotes
+ (respectively) the calling process, the process group of the calling process,
+ or the real user ID of the calling process.
+
+ Availability: Unix
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: getresuid()
Return a tuple (ruid, euid, suid) denoting the current process's
@@ -338,6 +365,15 @@ process and user.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+.. data:: PRIO_PROCESS
+ PRIO_PGRP
+ PRIO_USER
+
+ Parameters for :func:`getpriority` and :func:`setpriority` functions.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. function:: putenv(key, value)
@@ -407,6 +443,25 @@ process and user.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: setpriority(which, who, priority)
+
+ .. index:: single: process; scheduling priority
+
+ Set program scheduling priority. The value *which* is one of
+ :const:`PRIO_PROCESS`, :const:`PRIO_PGRP`, or :const:`PRIO_USER`, and *who*
+ is interpreted relative to *which* (a process identifier for
+ :const:`PRIO_PROCESS`, process group identifier for :const:`PRIO_PGRP`, and a
+ user ID for :const:`PRIO_USER`). A zero value for *who* denotes
+ (respectively) the calling process, the process group of the calling process,
+ or the real user ID of the calling process.
+ *priority* is a value in the range -20 to 19. The default priority is 0;
+ lower priorities cause more favorable scheduling.
+
+ Availability: Unix
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: setregid(rgid, egid)
Set the current process's real and effective group ids.
@@ -536,7 +591,8 @@ These functions create new :term:`file objects <file object>`. (See also :func:`
the built-in :func:`open` function.
When specified, the *mode* argument must start with one of the letters
- ``'r'``, ``'w'``, or ``'a'``, otherwise a :exc:`ValueError` is raised.
+ ``'r'``, ``'w'``, ``'x'`` or ``'a'``, otherwise a :exc:`ValueError` is
+ raised.
On Unix, when the *mode* argument starts with ``'a'``, the *O_APPEND* flag is
set on the file descriptor (which the :c:func:`fdopen` implementation already
@@ -544,6 +600,8 @@ These functions create new :term:`file objects <file object>`. (See also :func:`
Availability: Unix, Windows.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The ``'x'`` mode was added.
.. _os-fd-ops:
@@ -564,6 +622,21 @@ associated with a :term:`file object` when required. Note that using the file
descriptor directly will bypass the file object methods, ignoring aspects such
as internal buffering of data.
+.. data:: AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW
+ AT_EACCESS
+ AT_FDCWD
+ AT_REMOVEDIR
+ AT_SYMLINK_FOLLOW
+ UTIME_NOW
+ UTIME_OMIT
+
+ These parameters are used as flags to the \*at family of functions.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: close(fd)
Close file descriptor *fd*.
@@ -612,6 +685,19 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix, Windows.
+.. function:: faccessat(dirfd, path, mode, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`access` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and can be constructed by ORing together zero or more
+ of these values: :data:`AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW`, :data:`AT_EACCESS`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: fchmod(fd, mode)
Change the mode of the file given by *fd* to the numeric *mode*. See the docs
@@ -620,6 +706,18 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: fchmodat(dirfd, path, mode, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`chmod` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 or :data:`AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: fchown(fd, uid, gid)
Change the owner and group id of the file given by *fd* to the numeric *uid*
@@ -628,6 +726,18 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: fchownat(dirfd, path, uid, gid, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`chown` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 or :data:`AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: fdatasync(fd)
Force write of file with filedescriptor *fd* to disk. Does not force update of
@@ -639,6 +749,47 @@ as internal buffering of data.
This function is not available on MacOS.
+.. function:: fgetxattr(fd, attr)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`getxattr` but operates on a file descriptor,
+ *fd*, instead of a path.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: flistxattr(fd)
+
+ This is exactly like :func:`listxattr` but operates on a file descriptor,
+ *fd*, instead of a path.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: flistdir(fd)
+
+ Like :func:`listdir`, but uses a file descriptor instead and always returns
+ strings.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: fexecve(fd, args, env)
+
+ Execute the program specified by a file descriptor *fd* with arguments given
+ by *args* and environment given by *env*, replacing the current process.
+ *args* and *env* are given as in :func:`execve`.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: fpathconf(fd, name)
Return system configuration information relevant to an open file. *name*
@@ -663,6 +814,17 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix, Windows.
+.. function:: fstatat(dirfd, path, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`stat` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 or :data:`AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: fstatvfs(fd)
@@ -692,6 +854,80 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: fremovexattr(fd, attr)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`removexattr` but operates on a file
+ descriptor, *fd*, instead of a path.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: fsetxattr(fd, attr, value, flags=0)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`setxattr` but on a file descriptor, *fd*,
+ instead of a path.
+
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: futimesat(dirfd, path[, times])
+
+ Like :func:`utime` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory. *times* must be a
+ 2-tuple of numbers, of the form ``(atime, mtime)``, or None.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: futimens(fd[, atimes, mtimes])
+
+ Updates the timestamps of a file specified by the file descriptor *fd*, with
+ nanosecond precision.
+ If no second argument is given, set *atime* and *mtime* to the current time.
+ *atimes* and *mtimes* must be 2-tuples of numbers, of the form
+ ``(atime_sec, atime_nsec)`` and ``(mtime_sec, mtime_nsec)`` respectively,
+ or ``None``.
+ If *atime_nsec* or *mtime_nsec* is specified as :data:`UTIME_NOW`, the corresponding
+ timestamp is updated to the current time.
+ If *atime_nsec* or *mtime_nsec* is specified as :data:`UTIME_OMIT`, the corresponding
+ timestamp is not updated.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: UTIME_NOW
+ UTIME_OMIT
+
+ Flags used with :func:`futimens` to specify that the timestamp must be
+ updated either to the current time or not updated at all.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: futimes(fd[, times])
+
+ Set the access and modified time of the file specified by the file
+ descriptor *fd* to the given values. *atimes* must be a 2-tuple of numbers,
+ of the form ``(atime, mtime)``, or None. If no second argument is used,
+ set the access and modified times to the current time.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: isatty(fd)
Return ``True`` if the file descriptor *fd* is open and connected to a
@@ -700,6 +936,44 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: linkat(srcfd, srcpath, dstfd, dstpath, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`link` but if *srcpath* is relative, it is taken as relative to *srcfd*
+ and if *dstpath* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dstfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 or :data:`AT_SYMLINK_FOLLOW`.
+ If *srcpath* is relative and *srcfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then
+ *srcpath* is interpreted relative to the current working directory. This
+ also applies for *dstpath*.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: lockf(fd, cmd, len)
+
+ Apply, test or remove a POSIX lock on an open file descriptor.
+ *fd* is an open file descriptor.
+ *cmd* specifies the command to use - one of :data:`F_LOCK`, :data:`F_TLOCK`,
+ :data:`F_ULOCK` or :data:`F_TEST`.
+ *len* specifies the section of the file to lock.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: F_LOCK
+ F_TLOCK
+ F_ULOCK
+ F_TEST
+
+ Flags that specify what action :func:`lockf` will take.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: lseek(fd, pos, how)
Set the current position of file descriptor *fd* to position *pos*, modified
@@ -719,6 +993,39 @@ as internal buffering of data.
respectively. Availability: Windows, Unix.
+.. function:: mkdirat(dirfd, path, mode=0o777)
+
+ Like :func:`mkdir` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: mkfifoat(dirfd, path, mode=0o666)
+
+ Like :func:`mkfifo` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: mknodat(dirfd, path, mode=0o600, device=0)
+
+ Like :func:`mknod` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: open(file, flags[, mode])
Open the file *file* and set various flags according to *flags* and possibly
@@ -741,6 +1048,17 @@ as internal buffering of data.
wrap a file descriptor in a file object, use :func:`fdopen`.
+.. function:: openat(dirfd, path, flags, mode=0o777)
+
+ Like :func:`open` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: openpty()
.. index:: module: pty
@@ -760,6 +1078,79 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix, Windows.
+.. function:: pipe2(flags)
+
+ Create a pipe with *flags* set atomically.
+ *flags* can be constructed by ORing together one or more of these values:
+ :data:`O_NONBLOCK`, :data:`O_CLOEXEC`.
+ Return a pair of file descriptors ``(r, w)`` usable for reading and writing,
+ respectively.
+
+ Availability: some flavors of Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: posix_fallocate(fd, offset, len)
+
+ Ensures that enough disk space is allocated for the file specified by *fd*
+ starting from *offset* and continuing for *len* bytes.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: posix_fadvise(fd, offset, len, advice)
+
+ Announces an intention to access data in a specific pattern thus allowing
+ the kernel to make optimizations.
+ The advice applies to the region of the file specified by *fd* starting at
+ *offset* and continuing for *len* bytes.
+ *advice* is one of :data:`POSIX_FADV_NORMAL`, :data:`POSIX_FADV_SEQUENTIAL`,
+ :data:`POSIX_FADV_RANDOM`, :data:`POSIX_FADV_NOREUSE`,
+ :data:`POSIX_FADV_WILLNEED` or :data:`POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED`.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: POSIX_FADV_NORMAL
+ POSIX_FADV_SEQUENTIAL
+ POSIX_FADV_RANDOM
+ POSIX_FADV_NOREUSE
+ POSIX_FADV_WILLNEED
+ POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED
+
+ Flags that can be used in *advice* in :func:`posix_fadvise` that specify
+ the access pattern that is likely to be used.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: pread(fd, buffersize, offset)
+
+ Read from a file descriptor, *fd*, at a position of *offset*. It will read up
+ to *buffersize* number of bytes. The file offset remains unchanged.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: pwrite(fd, string, offset)
+
+ Write *string* to a file descriptor, *fd*, from *offset*, leaving the file
+ offset unchanged.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: read(fd, n)
Read at most *n* bytes from file descriptor *fd*. Return a bytestring containing the
@@ -777,6 +1168,93 @@ as internal buffering of data.
:meth:`~file.readline` methods.
+.. function:: sendfile(out, in, offset, nbytes)
+ sendfile(out, in, offset, nbytes, headers=None, trailers=None, flags=0)
+
+ Copy *nbytes* bytes from file descriptor *in* to file descriptor *out*
+ starting at *offset*.
+ Return the number of bytes sent. When EOF is reached return 0.
+
+ The first function notation is supported by all platforms that define
+ :func:`sendfile`.
+
+ On Linux, if *offset* is given as ``None``, the bytes are read from the
+ current position of *in* and the position of *in* is updated.
+
+ The second case may be used on Mac OS X and FreeBSD where *headers* and
+ *trailers* are arbitrary sequences of buffers that are written before and
+ after the data from *in* is written. It returns the same as the first case.
+
+ On Mac OS X and FreeBSD, a value of 0 for *nbytes* specifies to send until
+ the end of *in* is reached.
+
+ On Solaris, *out* may be the file descriptor of a regular file or the file
+ descriptor of a socket. On all other platforms, *out* must be the file
+ descriptor of an open socket.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: SF_NODISKIO
+ SF_MNOWAIT
+ SF_SYNC
+
+ Parameters to the :func:`sendfile` function, if the implementation supports
+ them.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: readlinkat(dirfd, path)
+
+ Like :func:`readlink` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: renameat(olddirfd, oldpath, newdirfd, newpath)
+
+ Like :func:`rename` but if *oldpath* is relative, it is taken as relative to
+ *olddirfd* and if *newpath* is relative, it is taken as relative to *newdirfd*.
+ If *oldpath* is relative and *olddirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then
+ *oldpath* is interpreted relative to the current working directory. This
+ also applies for *newpath*.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: symlinkat(src, dstfd, dst)
+
+ Like :func:`symlink` but if *dst* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dstfd*.
+ If *dst* is relative and *dstfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *dst*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: readv(fd, buffers)
+
+ Read from a file descriptor into a number of writable buffers. *buffers* is
+ an arbitrary sequence of writable buffers. Returns the total number of bytes
+ read.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: tcgetpgrp(fd)
Return the process group associated with the terminal given by *fd* (an open
@@ -802,6 +1280,38 @@ as internal buffering of data.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: unlinkat(dirfd, path, flags=0)
+
+ Like :func:`unlink` but if *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 or :data:`AT_REMOVEDIR`. If :data:`AT_REMOVEDIR` is
+ specified, :func:`unlinkat` behaves like :func:`rmdir`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: utimensat(dirfd, path[, atime=(atime_sec, atime_nsec), mtime=(mtime_sec, mtime_nsec), flags=0])
+
+ Updates the timestamps of a file with nanosecond precision.
+ The *atime* and *mtime* tuples default to ``None``, which sets those
+ values to the current time.
+ If *atime_nsec* or *mtime_nsec* is specified as :data:`UTIME_NOW`, the corresponding
+ timestamp is updated to the current time.
+ If *atime_nsec* or *mtime_nsec* is specified as :data:`UTIME_OMIT`, the corresponding
+ timestamp is not updated.
+ If *path* is relative, it is taken as relative to *dirfd*.
+ *flags* is optional and may be 0 (the default) or :data:`AT_SYMLINK_NOFOLLOW`.
+ If *path* is relative and *dirfd* is the special value :data:`AT_FDCWD`, then *path*
+ is interpreted relative to the current working directory.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: write(fd, str)
Write the bytestring in *str* to file descriptor *fd*. Return the number of
@@ -818,6 +1328,17 @@ as internal buffering of data.
:meth:`~file.write` method.
+.. function:: writev(fd, buffers)
+
+ Write the contents of *buffers* to file descriptor *fd*, where *buffers*
+ is an arbitrary sequence of buffers.
+ Returns the total number of bytes written.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. _open-constants:
``open()`` flag constants
@@ -849,9 +1370,12 @@ or `the MSDN <http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z0kc8e3z.aspx>`_ on Window
O_NOCTTY
O_SHLOCK
O_EXLOCK
+ O_CLOEXEC
These constants are only available on Unix.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Add :data:`O_CLOEXEC` constant.
.. data:: O_BINARY
O_NOINHERIT
@@ -874,6 +1398,56 @@ or `the MSDN <http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z0kc8e3z.aspx>`_ on Window
the C library.
+.. data:: RTLD_LAZY
+ RTLD_NOW
+ RTLD_GLOBAL
+ RTLD_LOCAL
+ RTLD_NODELETE
+ RTLD_NOLOAD
+ RTLD_DEEPBIND
+
+ See the Unix manual page :manpage:`dlopen(3)`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. _terminal-size:
+
+Querying the size of a terminal
+~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. function:: get_terminal_size(fd=STDOUT_FILENO)
+
+ Return the size of the terminal window as ``(columns, lines)``,
+ tuple of type :class:`terminal_size`.
+
+ The optional argument ``fd`` (default ``STDOUT_FILENO``, or standard
+ output) specifies which file descriptor should be queried.
+
+ If the file descriptor is not connected to a terminal, an :exc:`OSError`
+ is thrown.
+
+ :func:`shutil.get_terminal_size` is the high-level function which
+ should normally be used, ``os.get_terminal_size`` is the low-level
+ implementation.
+
+ Availability: Unix, Windows.
+
+.. class:: terminal_size(tuple)
+
+ A tuple of ``(columns, lines)`` for holding terminal window size.
+
+ .. attribute:: columns
+
+ Width of the terminal window in characters.
+
+ .. attribute:: lines
+
+ Height of the terminal window in characters.
+
+
.. _os-file-dir:
Files and Directories
@@ -909,11 +1483,8 @@ Files and Directories
try:
fp = open("myfile")
- except IOError as e:
- if e.errno == errno.EACCES:
- return "some default data"
- # Not a permission error.
- raise
+ except PermissionError:
+ return "some default data"
else:
with fp:
return fp.read()
@@ -1049,9 +1620,23 @@ Files and Directories
Change the owner and group id of *path* to the numeric *uid* and *gid*. To leave
one of the ids unchanged, set it to -1.
+ See :func:`shutil.chown` for a higher-level function that accepts names in
+ addition to numeric ids.
+
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: getxattr(path, attr)
+
+ Return the value of the extended filesystem attribute *attr* for
+ *path*. *attr* can be bytes or str. If it is str, it is encoded with the
+ filesystem encoding.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: lchflags(path, flags)
Set the flags of *path* to the numeric *flags*, like :func:`chflags`, but do not
@@ -1077,6 +1662,15 @@ Files and Directories
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: lgetxattr(path, attr)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`getxattr` but doesn't follow symlinks.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: link(source, link_name)
Create a hard link pointing to *source* named *link_name*.
@@ -1101,6 +1695,44 @@ Files and Directories
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
The *path* parameter became optional.
+
+.. function:: listxattr(path)
+
+ Return a list of the extended filesystem attributes on *path*. Attributes are
+ returned as string decoded with the filesystem encoding.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: llistxattr(path)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`listxattr` but doesn't follow symlinks.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: lremovexattr(path, attr)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`removexattr` but doesn't follow symlinks.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: lsetxattr(path, attr, value, flags=0)
+
+ This works exactly like :func:`setxattr` but doesn't follow symlinks.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: lstat(path)
Perform the equivalent of an :c:func:`lstat` system call on the given path.
@@ -1112,6 +1744,18 @@ Files and Directories
Added support for Windows 6.0 (Vista) symbolic links.
+.. function:: lutimes(path[, times])
+
+ Like :func:`utime`, but if *path* is a symbolic link, it is not
+ dereferenced. *times* must be a 2-tuple of numbers, of the form
+ ``(atime, mtime)``, or None.
+
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: mkfifo(path[, mode])
Create a FIFO (a named pipe) named *path* with numeric mode *mode*. The
@@ -1263,6 +1907,17 @@ Files and Directories
successfully removed.
+.. function:: removexattr(path, attr)
+
+ Removes the extended filesystem attribute *attr* from *path*. *attr* should
+ be bytes or str. If it is a string, it is encoded with the filesystem
+ encoding.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: rename(src, dst)
Rename the file or directory *src* to *dst*. If *dst* is a directory,
@@ -1271,8 +1926,9 @@ Files and Directories
Unix flavors if *src* and *dst* are on different filesystems. If successful,
the renaming will be an atomic operation (this is a POSIX requirement). On
Windows, if *dst* already exists, :exc:`OSError` will be raised even if it is a
- file; there may be no way to implement an atomic rename when *dst* names an
- existing file.
+ file.
+
+ If you want cross-platform overwriting of the destination, use :func:`replace`.
Availability: Unix, Windows.
@@ -1290,6 +1946,19 @@ Files and Directories
permissions needed to remove the leaf directory or file.
+.. function:: replace(src, dst)
+
+ Rename the file or directory *src* to *dst*. If *dst* is a directory,
+ :exc:`OSError` will be raised. If *dst* exists and is a file, it will
+ be replaced silently if the user has permission. The operation may fail
+ if *src* and *dst* are on different filesystems. If successful,
+ the renaming will be an atomic operation (this is a POSIX requirement).
+
+ Availability: Unix, Windows
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: rmdir(path)
Remove (delete) the directory *path*. Only works when the directory is
@@ -1299,6 +1968,44 @@ Files and Directories
Availability: Unix, Windows.
+.. data:: XATTR_SIZE_MAX
+
+ The maximum size the value of an extended attribute can be. Currently, this
+ is 64 kilobytes on Linux.
+
+
+.. data:: XATTR_CREATE
+
+ This is a possible value for the flags argument in :func:`setxattr`. It
+ indicates the operation must create an attribute.
+
+
+.. data:: XATTR_REPLACE
+
+ This is a possible value for the flags argument in :func:`setxattr`. It
+ indicates the operation must replace an existing attribute.
+
+
+.. function:: setxattr(path, attr, value, flags=0)
+
+ Set the extended filesystem attribute *attr* on *path* to *value*. *attr*
+ must be a bytes or str with no embedded NULs. If it is str, it is encoded
+ with the filesystem encoding. *flags* may be :data:`XATTR_REPLACE` or
+ :data:`XATTR_CREATE`. If :data:`XATTR_REPLACE` is given and the attribute
+ does not exist, ``EEXISTS`` will be raised. If :data:`XATTR_CREATE` is given
+ and the attribute already exists, the attribute will not be created and
+ ``ENODATA`` will be raised.
+
+ Availability: Linux
+
+ .. note::
+
+ A bug in Linux kernel versions less than 2.6.39 caused the flags argument
+ to be ignored on some filesystems.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: stat(path)
Perform the equivalent of a :c:func:`stat` system call on the given path.
@@ -1453,6 +2160,25 @@ Files and Directories
Added support for Windows 6.0 (Vista) symbolic links.
+.. function:: sync()
+
+ Force write of everything to disk.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: truncate(path, length)
+
+ Truncate the file corresponding to *path*, so that it is at most
+ *length* bytes in size.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: unlink(path)
Remove (delete) the file *path*. This is the same function as
@@ -1462,18 +2188,19 @@ Files and Directories
Availability: Unix, Windows.
-.. function:: utime(path, times)
+.. function:: utime(path[, times])
Set the access and modified times of the file specified by *path*. If *times*
- is ``None``, then the file's access and modified times are set to the current
- time. (The effect is similar to running the Unix program :program:`touch` on
- the path.) Otherwise, *times* must be a 2-tuple of numbers, of the form
- ``(atime, mtime)`` which is used to set the access and modified times,
- respectively. Whether a directory can be given for *path* depends on whether
- the operating system implements directories as files (for example, Windows
- does not). Note that the exact times you set here may not be returned by a
- subsequent :func:`~os.stat` call, depending on the resolution with which your
- operating system records access and modification times; see :func:`~os.stat`.
+ is ``None`` or not specified, then the file's access and modified times are
+ set to the current time. (The effect is similar to running the Unix program
+ :program:`touch` on the path.) Otherwise, *times* must be a 2-tuple of
+ numbers, of the form ``(atime, mtime)`` which is used to set the access and
+ modified times, respectively. Whether a directory can be given for *path*
+ depends on whether the operating system implements directories as files
+ (for example, Windows does not). Note that the exact times you set here may
+ not be returned by a subsequent :func:`~os.stat` call, depending on the
+ resolution with which your operating system records access and modification
+ times; see :func:`~os.stat`.
Availability: Unix, Windows.
@@ -1561,6 +2288,57 @@ Files and Directories
os.rmdir(os.path.join(root, name))
+.. function:: fwalk(top, topdown=True, onerror=None, followlinks=False)
+
+ .. index::
+ single: directory; walking
+ single: directory; traversal
+
+ This behaves exactly like :func:`walk`, except that it yields a 4-tuple
+ ``(dirpath, dirnames, filenames, dirfd)``.
+
+ *dirpath*, *dirnames* and *filenames* are identical to :func:`walk` output,
+ and *dirfd* is a file descriptor referring to the directory *dirpath*.
+
+ .. note::
+
+ Since :func:`fwalk` yields file descriptors, those are only valid until
+ the next iteration step, so you should duplicate them (e.g. with
+ :func:`dup`) if you want to keep them longer.
+
+ This example displays the number of bytes taken by non-directory files in each
+ directory under the starting directory, except that it doesn't look under any
+ CVS subdirectory::
+
+ import os
+ for root, dirs, files, rootfd in os.fwalk('python/Lib/email'):
+ print(root, "consumes", end="")
+ print(sum([os.fstatat(rootfd, name).st_size for name in files]),
+ end="")
+ print("bytes in", len(files), "non-directory files")
+ if 'CVS' in dirs:
+ dirs.remove('CVS') # don't visit CVS directories
+
+ In the next example, walking the tree bottom-up is essential:
+ :func:`unlinkat` doesn't allow deleting a directory before the directory is
+ empty::
+
+ # Delete everything reachable from the directory named in "top",
+ # assuming there are no symbolic links.
+ # CAUTION: This is dangerous! For example, if top == '/', it
+ # could delete all your disk files.
+ import os
+ for root, dirs, files, rootfd in os.fwalk(top, topdown=False):
+ for name in files:
+ os.unlinkat(rootfd, name)
+ for name in dirs:
+ os.unlinkat(rootfd, name, os.AT_REMOVEDIR)
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. _os-process:
Process Management
@@ -1825,6 +2603,8 @@ written in Python, such as a mail server's external command delivery program.
will be set to *sig*. The Windows version of :func:`kill` additionally takes
process handles to be killed.
+ See also :func:`signal.pthread_kill`.
+
.. versionadded:: 3.2
Windows support.
@@ -2035,6 +2815,58 @@ written in Python, such as a mail server's external command delivery program.
Availability: Unix.
+.. function:: waitid(idtype, id, options)
+
+ Wait for the completion of one or more child processes.
+ *idtype* can be :data:`P_PID`, :data:`P_PGID` or :data:`P_ALL`.
+ *id* specifies the pid to wait on.
+ *options* is constructed from the ORing of one or more of :data:`WEXITED`,
+ :data:`WSTOPPED` or :data:`WCONTINUED` and additionally may be ORed with
+ :data:`WNOHANG` or :data:`WNOWAIT`. The return value is an object
+ representing the data contained in the :c:type:`siginfo_t` structure, namely:
+ :attr:`si_pid`, :attr:`si_uid`, :attr:`si_signo`, :attr:`si_status`,
+ :attr:`si_code` or ``None`` if :data:`WNOHANG` is specified and there are no
+ children in a waitable state.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: P_PID
+ P_PGID
+ P_ALL
+
+ These are the possible values for *idtype* in :func:`waitid`. They affect
+ how *id* is interpreted.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: WEXITED
+ WSTOPPED
+ WNOWAIT
+
+ Flags that can be used in *options* in :func:`waitid` that specify what
+ child signal to wait for.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: CLD_EXITED
+ CLD_DUMPED
+ CLD_TRAPPED
+ CLD_CONTINUED
+
+ These are the possible values for :attr:`si_code` in the result returned by
+ :func:`waitid`.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: waitpid(pid, options)
@@ -2176,6 +3008,155 @@ used to determine the disposition of a process.
Availability: Unix.
+Interface to the scheduler
+--------------------------
+
+These functions control how a process is allocated CPU time by the operating
+system. They are only available on some Unix platforms. For more detailed
+information, consult your Unix manpages.
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+The following scheduling policies are exposed if they are a supported by the
+operating system.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_OTHER
+
+ The default scheduling policy.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_BATCH
+
+ Scheduling policy for CPU-intensive processes that tries to preserve
+ interactivity on the rest of the computer.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_IDLE
+
+ Scheduling policy for extremely low priority background tasks.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_SPORADIC
+
+ Scheduling policy for sporadic server programs.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_FIFO
+
+ A First In First Out scheduling policy.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_RR
+
+ A round-robin scheduling policy.
+
+.. data:: SCHED_RESET_ON_FORK
+
+ This flag can OR'ed with any other scheduling policy. When a process with
+ this flag set forks, its child's scheduling policy and priority are reset to
+ the default.
+
+
+.. class:: sched_param(sched_priority)
+
+ This class represents tunable scheduling parameters used in
+ :func:`sched_setparam`, :func:`sched_setscheduler`, and
+ :func:`sched_getparam`. It is immutable.
+
+ At the moment, there is only one possible parameter:
+
+ .. attribute:: sched_priority
+
+ The scheduling priority for a scheduling policy.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_get_priority_min(policy)
+
+ Get the minimum priority value for *policy*. *policy* is one of the
+ scheduling policy constants above.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_get_priority_max(policy)
+
+ Get the maximum priority value for *policy*. *policy* is one of the
+ scheduling policy constants above.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_setscheduler(pid, policy, param)
+
+ Set the scheduling policy for the process with PID *pid*. A *pid* of 0 means
+ the calling process. *policy* is one of the scheduling policy constants
+ above. *param* is a :class:`sched_param` instance.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_getscheduler(pid)
+
+ Return the scheduling policy for the process with PID *pid*. A *pid* of 0
+ means the calling process. The result is one of the scheduling policy
+ constants above.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_setparam(pid, param)
+
+ Set a scheduling parameters for the process with PID *pid*. A *pid* of 0 means
+ the calling process. *param* is a :class:`sched_param` instance.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_getparam(pid)
+
+ Return the scheduling parameters as a :class:`sched_param` instance for the
+ process with PID *pid*. A *pid* of 0 means the calling process.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_rr_get_interval(pid)
+
+ Return the round-robin quantum in seconds for the process with PID *pid*. A
+ *pid* of 0 means the calling process.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_yield()
+
+ Voluntarily relinquish the CPU.
+
+
+.. class:: cpu_set(ncpus)
+
+ :class:`cpu_set` represents a set of CPUs on which a process is eligible to
+ run. *ncpus* is the number of CPUs the set should describe. Methods on
+ :class:`cpu_set` allow CPUs to be add or removed.
+
+ :class:`cpu_set` supports the AND, OR, and XOR bitwise operations. For
+ example, given two cpu_sets, ``one`` and ``two``, ``one | two`` returns a
+ :class:`cpu_set` containing the cpus enabled both in ``one`` and ``two``.
+
+ .. method:: set(i)
+
+ Enable CPU *i*.
+
+ .. method:: clear(i)
+
+ Remove CPU *i*.
+
+ .. method:: isset(i)
+
+ Return ``True`` if CPU *i* is enabled in the set.
+
+ .. method:: count()
+
+ Return the number of enabled CPUs in the set.
+
+ .. method:: zero()
+
+ Clear the set completely.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_setaffinity(pid, mask)
+
+ Restrict the process with PID *pid* to a set of CPUs. *mask* is a
+ :class:`cpu_set` instance.
+
+
+.. function:: sched_getaffinity(pid, size)
+
+ Return the :class:`cpu_set` the process with PID *pid* is restricted to. The
+ result will contain *size* CPUs.
+
+
.. _os-path:
Miscellaneous System Information
diff --git a/Doc/library/ossaudiodev.rst b/Doc/library/ossaudiodev.rst
index 0a08428..51c5857 100644
--- a/Doc/library/ossaudiodev.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/ossaudiodev.rst
@@ -38,6 +38,10 @@ the standard audio interface for Linux and recent versions of FreeBSD.
This probably all warrants a footnote or two, but I don't understand
things well enough right now to write it! --GPW
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Operations in this module now raise :exc:`OSError` where :exc:`IOError`
+ was raised.
+
.. seealso::
@@ -56,7 +60,7 @@ the standard audio interface for Linux and recent versions of FreeBSD.
what went wrong.
(If :mod:`ossaudiodev` receives an error from a system call such as
- :c:func:`open`, :c:func:`write`, or :c:func:`ioctl`, it raises :exc:`IOError`.
+ :c:func:`open`, :c:func:`write`, or :c:func:`ioctl`, it raises :exc:`OSError`.
Errors detected directly by :mod:`ossaudiodev` result in :exc:`OSSAudioError`.)
(For backwards compatibility, the exception class is also available as
@@ -168,7 +172,7 @@ The following methods each map to exactly one :func:`ioctl` system call. The
correspondence is obvious: for example, :meth:`setfmt` corresponds to the
``SNDCTL_DSP_SETFMT`` ioctl, and :meth:`sync` to ``SNDCTL_DSP_SYNC`` (this can
be useful when consulting the OSS documentation). If the underlying
-:func:`ioctl` fails, they all raise :exc:`IOError`.
+:func:`ioctl` fails, they all raise :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: oss_audio_device.nonblock()
@@ -344,7 +348,7 @@ The mixer object provides two file-like methods:
.. method:: oss_mixer_device.close()
This method closes the open mixer device file. Any further attempts to use the
- mixer after this file is closed will raise an :exc:`IOError`.
+ mixer after this file is closed will raise an :exc:`OSError`.
.. method:: oss_mixer_device.fileno()
@@ -403,7 +407,7 @@ The remaining methods are specific to audio mixing:
returned, but both volumes are the same.
Raises :exc:`OSSAudioError` if an invalid control was is specified, or
- :exc:`IOError` if an unsupported control is specified.
+ :exc:`OSError` if an unsupported control is specified.
.. method:: oss_mixer_device.set(control, (left, right))
@@ -427,7 +431,7 @@ The remaining methods are specific to audio mixing:
.. method:: oss_mixer_device.set_recsrc(bitmask)
Call this function to specify a recording source. Returns a bitmask indicating
- the new recording source (or sources) if successful; raises :exc:`IOError` if an
+ the new recording source (or sources) if successful; raises :exc:`OSError` if an
invalid source was specified. To set the current recording source to the
microphone input::
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging-misc.rst b/Doc/library/packaging-misc.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5e56247
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging-misc.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
+.. temporary file for modules that don't need a dedicated file yet
+
+:mod:`packaging.errors` --- Packaging exceptions
+================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.errors
+ :synopsis: Packaging exceptions.
+
+
+Provides exceptions used by the Packaging modules. Note that Packaging modules
+may raise standard exceptions; in particular, SystemExit is usually raised for
+errors that are obviously the end-user's fault (e.g. bad command-line arguments).
+
+This module is safe to use in ``from ... import *`` mode; it only exports
+symbols whose names start with ``Packaging`` and end with ``Error``.
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.manifest` --- The Manifest class
+================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.manifest
+ :synopsis: The Manifest class, used for poking about the file system and
+ building lists of files.
+
+
+This module provides the :class:`Manifest` class, used for poking about the
+filesystem and building lists of files.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.command.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.command.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6a85351
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.command.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+:mod:`packaging.command` --- Standard Packaging commands
+========================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.command
+ :synopsis: Standard packaging commands.
+
+
+This subpackage contains one module for each standard Packaging command, such as
+:command:`build` or :command:`upload`. Each command is implemented as a
+separate module, with the command name as the name of the module and of the
+class defined therein.
+
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.command.cmd` --- Abstract base class for Packaging commands
+===========================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.command.cmd
+ :synopsis: Abstract base class for commands.
+
+
+This module supplies the abstract base class :class:`Command`. This class is
+subclassed by the modules in the packaging.command subpackage.
+
+
+.. class:: Command(dist)
+
+ Abstract base class for defining command classes, the "worker bees" of the
+ Packaging. A useful analogy for command classes is to think of them as
+ subroutines with local variables called *options*. The options are declared
+ in :meth:`initialize_options` and defined (given their final values) in
+ :meth:`finalize_options`, both of which must be defined by every command
+ class. The distinction between the two is necessary because option values
+ might come from the outside world (command line, config file, ...), and any
+ options dependent on other options must be computed after these outside
+ influences have been processed --- hence :meth:`finalize_options`. The body
+ of the subroutine, where it does all its work based on the values of its
+ options, is the :meth:`run` method, which must also be implemented by every
+ command class.
+
+ The class constructor takes a single argument *dist*, a
+ :class:`~packaging.dist.Distribution` instance.
+
+
+Creating a new Packaging command
+--------------------------------
+
+This section outlines the steps to create a new Packaging command.
+
+.. XXX the following paragraph is focused on the stdlib; expand it to document
+ how to write and register a command in third-party projects
+
+A new command lives in a module in the :mod:`packaging.command` package. There
+is a sample template in that directory called :file:`command_template`. Copy
+this file to a new module with the same name as the new command you're
+implementing. This module should implement a class with the same name as the
+module (and the command). So, for instance, to create the command
+``peel_banana`` (so that users can run ``setup.py peel_banana``), you'd copy
+:file:`command_template` to :file:`packaging/command/peel_banana.py`, then edit
+it so that it's implementing the class :class:`peel_banana`, a subclass of
+:class:`Command`. It must define the following methods:
+
+.. method:: Command.initialize_options()
+
+ Set default values for all the options that this command supports. Note that
+ these defaults may be overridden by other commands, by the setup script, by
+ config files, or by the command line. Thus, this is not the place to code
+ dependencies between options; generally, :meth:`initialize_options`
+ implementations are just a bunch of ``self.foo = None`` assignments.
+
+
+.. method:: Command.finalize_options()
+
+ Set final values for all the options that this command supports. This is
+ always called as late as possible, i.e. after any option assignments from the
+ command line or from other commands have been done. Thus, this is the place
+ to code option dependencies: if *foo* depends on *bar*, then it is safe to
+ set *foo* from *bar* as long as *foo* still has the same value it was
+ assigned in :meth:`initialize_options`.
+
+
+.. method:: Command.run()
+
+ A command's raison d'etre: carry out the action it exists to perform,
+ controlled by the options initialized in :meth:`initialize_options`,
+ customized by other commands, the setup script, the command line, and config
+ files, and finalized in :meth:`finalize_options`. All terminal output and
+ filesystem interaction should be done by :meth:`run`.
+
+
+Command classes may define this attribute:
+
+
+.. attribute:: Command.sub_commands
+
+ *sub_commands* formalizes the notion of a "family" of commands,
+ e.g. ``install_dist`` as the parent with sub-commands ``install_lib``,
+ ``install_headers``, etc. The parent of a family of commands defines
+ *sub_commands* as a class attribute; it's a list of 2-tuples ``(command_name,
+ predicate)``, with *command_name* a string and *predicate* a function, a
+ string or ``None``. *predicate* is a method of the parent command that
+ determines whether the corresponding command is applicable in the current
+ situation. (E.g. ``install_headers`` is only applicable if we have any C
+ header files to install.) If *predicate* is ``None``, that command is always
+ applicable.
+
+ *sub_commands* is usually defined at the *end* of a class, because
+ predicates can be methods of the class, so they must already have been
+ defined. The canonical example is the :command:`install_dist` command.
+
+.. XXX document how to add a custom command to another one's subcommands
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.compiler.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.compiler.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f23c551
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.compiler.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,681 @@
+:mod:`packaging.compiler` --- Compiler classes
+==============================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.compiler
+ :synopsis: Compiler classes to build C/C++ extensions or libraries.
+
+
+This subpackage contains an abstract base class representing a compiler and
+concrete implementations for common compilers. The compiler classes should not
+be instantiated directly, but created using the :func:`new_compiler` factory
+function. Compiler types provided by Packaging are listed in
+:ref:`packaging-standard-compilers`.
+
+
+Public functions
+----------------
+
+.. function:: new_compiler(plat=None, compiler=None, dry_run=False, force=False)
+
+ Factory function to generate an instance of some
+ :class:`~.ccompiler.CCompiler` subclass for the requested platform or
+ compiler type.
+
+ If no argument is given for *plat* and *compiler*, the default compiler type
+ for the platform (:attr:`os.name`) will be used: ``'unix'`` for Unix and
+ Mac OS X, ``'msvc'`` for Windows.
+
+ If *plat* is given, it must be one of ``'posix'``, ``'darwin'`` or ``'nt'``.
+ An invalid value will not raise an exception but use the default compiler
+ type for the current platform.
+
+ .. XXX errors should never pass silently; this behavior is particularly
+ harmful when a compiler type is given as first argument
+
+ If *compiler* is given, *plat* will be ignored, allowing you to get for
+ example a ``'unix'`` compiler object under Windows or an ``'msvc'`` compiler
+ under Unix. However, not all compiler types can be instantiated on every
+ platform.
+
+
+.. function:: customize_compiler(compiler)
+
+ Do any platform-specific customization of a CCompiler instance. Mainly
+ needed on Unix to plug in the information that varies across Unices and is
+ stored in CPython's Makefile.
+
+
+.. function:: gen_lib_options(compiler, library_dirs, runtime_library_dirs, libraries)
+
+ Generate linker options for searching library directories and linking with
+ specific libraries. *libraries* and *library_dirs* are, respectively, lists
+ of library names (not filenames!) and search directories. Returns a list of
+ command-line options suitable for use with some compiler (depending on the
+ two format strings passed in).
+
+
+.. function:: gen_preprocess_options(macros, include_dirs)
+
+ Generate C preprocessor options (:option:`-D`, :option:`-U`, :option:`-I`) as
+ used by at least two types of compilers: the typical Unix compiler and Visual
+ C++. *macros* is the usual thing, a list of 1- or 2-tuples, where ``(name,)``
+ means undefine (:option:`-U`) macro *name*, and ``(name, value)`` means
+ define (:option:`-D`) macro *name* to *value*. *include_dirs* is just a list
+ of directory names to be added to the header file search path (:option:`-I`).
+ Returns a list of command-line options suitable for either Unix compilers or
+ Visual C++.
+
+
+.. function:: get_default_compiler(osname, platform)
+
+ Determine the default compiler to use for the given platform.
+
+ *osname* should be one of the standard Python OS names (i.e. the ones
+ returned by ``os.name``) and *platform* the common value returned by
+ ``sys.platform`` for the platform in question.
+
+ The default values are ``os.name`` and ``sys.platform``.
+
+
+.. function:: set_compiler(location)
+
+ Add or change a compiler
+
+
+.. function:: show_compilers()
+
+ Print list of available compilers (used by the :option:`--help-compiler`
+ options to :command:`build`, :command:`build_ext`, :command:`build_clib`).
+
+
+.. _packaging-standard-compilers:
+
+Standard compilers
+------------------
+
+Concrete subclasses of :class:`~.ccompiler.CCompiler` are provided in submodules
+of the :mod:`packaging.compiler` package. You do not need to import them, using
+:func:`new_compiler` is the public API to use. This table documents the
+standard compilers; be aware that they can be replaced by other classes on your
+platform.
+
+=============== ======================================================== =======
+name description notes
+=============== ======================================================== =======
+``'unix'`` typical Unix-style command-line C compiler [#]_
+``'msvc'`` Microsoft compiler [#]_
+``'bcpp'`` Borland C++ compiler
+``'cygwin'`` Cygwin compiler (Windows port of GCC)
+``'mingw32'`` Mingw32 port of GCC (same as Cygwin in no-Cygwin mode)
+=============== ======================================================== =======
+
+
+.. [#] The Unix compiler class assumes this behavior:
+
+ * macros defined with :option:`-Dname[=value]`
+
+ * macros undefined with :option:`-Uname`
+
+ * include search directories specified with :option:`-Idir`
+
+ * libraries specified with :option:`-llib`
+
+ * library search directories specified with :option:`-Ldir`
+
+ * compile handled by :program:`cc` (or similar) executable with
+ :option:`-c` option: compiles :file:`.c` to :file:`.o`
+
+ * link static library handled by :program:`ar` command (possibly with
+ :program:`ranlib`)
+
+ * link shared library handled by :program:`cc` :option:`-shared`
+
+
+.. [#] On Windows, extension modules typically need to be compiled with the same
+ compiler that was used to compile CPython (for example Microsoft Visual
+ Studio .NET 2003 for CPython 2.4 and 2.5). The AMD64 and Itanium
+ binaries are created using the Platform SDK.
+
+ Under the hood, there are actually two different subclasses of
+ :class:`~.ccompiler.CCompiler` defined: one is compatible with MSVC 2005
+ and 2008, the other works with older versions. This should not be a
+ concern for regular use of the functions in this module.
+
+ Packaging will normally choose the right compiler, linker etc. on its
+ own. To override this choice, the environment variables
+ *DISTUTILS_USE_SDK* and *MSSdk* must be both set. *MSSdk* indicates that
+ the current environment has been setup by the SDK's ``SetEnv.Cmd``
+ script, or that the environment variables had been registered when the
+ SDK was installed; *DISTUTILS_USE_SDK* indicates that the user has made
+ an explicit choice to override the compiler selection done by Packaging.
+
+ .. TODO document the envvars in Doc/using and the man page
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.compiler.ccompiler` --- CCompiler base class
+============================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.compiler.ccompiler
+ :synopsis: Abstract CCompiler class.
+
+
+This module provides the abstract base class for the :class:`CCompiler`
+classes. A :class:`CCompiler` instance can be used for all the compile and
+link steps needed to build a single project. Methods are provided to set
+options for the compiler --- macro definitions, include directories, link path,
+libraries and the like.
+
+.. class:: CCompiler(dry_run=False, force=False)
+
+ The abstract base class :class:`CCompiler` defines the interface that must be
+ implemented by real compiler classes. The class also has some utility
+ methods used by several compiler classes.
+
+ The basic idea behind a compiler abstraction class is that each instance can
+ be used for all the compile/link steps in building a single project. Thus,
+ attributes common to all of those compile and link steps --- include
+ directories, macros to define, libraries to link against, etc. --- are
+ attributes of the compiler instance. To allow for variability in how
+ individual files are treated, most of those attributes may be varied on a
+ per-compilation or per-link basis.
+
+ The constructor for each subclass creates an instance of the Compiler object.
+ Flags are *dry_run* (don't actually execute
+ the steps) and *force* (rebuild everything, regardless of dependencies). All
+ of these flags default to ``False`` (off). Note that you probably don't want to
+ instantiate :class:`CCompiler` or one of its subclasses directly - use the
+ :func:`new_compiler` factory function instead.
+
+ The following methods allow you to manually alter compiler options for the
+ instance of the Compiler class.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.add_include_dir(dir)
+
+ Add *dir* to the list of directories that will be searched for header
+ files. The compiler is instructed to search directories in the order in
+ which they are supplied by successive calls to :meth:`add_include_dir`.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_include_dirs(dirs)
+
+ Set the list of directories that will be searched to *dirs* (a list of
+ strings). Overrides any preceding calls to :meth:`add_include_dir`;
+ subsequent calls to :meth:`add_include_dir` add to the list passed to
+ :meth:`set_include_dirs`. This does not affect any list of standard
+ include directories that the compiler may search by default.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.add_library(libname)
+
+ Add *libname* to the list of libraries that will be included in all links
+ driven by this compiler object. Note that *libname* should *not* be the
+ name of a file containing a library, but the name of the library itself:
+ the actual filename will be inferred by the linker, the compiler, or the
+ compiler class (depending on the platform).
+
+ The linker will be instructed to link against libraries in the order they
+ were supplied to :meth:`add_library` and/or :meth:`set_libraries`. It is
+ perfectly valid to duplicate library names; the linker will be instructed
+ to link against libraries as many times as they are mentioned.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_libraries(libnames)
+
+ Set the list of libraries to be included in all links driven by this
+ compiler object to *libnames* (a list of strings). This does not affect
+ any standard system libraries that the linker may include by default.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.add_library_dir(dir)
+
+ Add *dir* to the list of directories that will be searched for libraries
+ specified to :meth:`add_library` and :meth:`set_libraries`. The linker
+ will be instructed to search for libraries in the order they are supplied
+ to :meth:`add_library_dir` and/or :meth:`set_library_dirs`.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_library_dirs(dirs)
+
+ Set the list of library search directories to *dirs* (a list of strings).
+ This does not affect any standard library search path that the linker may
+ search by default.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.add_runtime_library_dir(dir)
+
+ Add *dir* to the list of directories that will be searched for shared
+ libraries at runtime.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_runtime_library_dirs(dirs)
+
+ Set the list of directories to search for shared libraries at runtime to
+ *dirs* (a list of strings). This does not affect any standard search path
+ that the runtime linker may search by default.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.define_macro(name[, value=None])
+
+ Define a preprocessor macro for all compilations driven by this compiler
+ object. The optional parameter *value* should be a string; if it is not
+ supplied, then the macro will be defined without an explicit value and the
+ exact outcome depends on the compiler used (XXX true? does ANSI say
+ anything about this?)
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.undefine_macro(name)
+
+ Undefine a preprocessor macro for all compilations driven by this compiler
+ object. If the same macro is defined by :meth:`define_macro` and
+ undefined by :meth:`undefine_macro` the last call takes precedence
+ (including multiple redefinitions or undefinitions). If the macro is
+ redefined/undefined on a per-compilation basis (i.e. in the call to
+ :meth:`compile`), then that takes precedence.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.add_link_object(object)
+
+ Add *object* to the list of object files (or analogues, such as explicitly
+ named library files or the output of "resource compilers") to be included
+ in every link driven by this compiler object.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_link_objects(objects)
+
+ Set the list of object files (or analogues) to be included in every link
+ to *objects*. This does not affect any standard object files that the
+ linker may include by default (such as system libraries).
+
+ The following methods implement methods for autodetection of compiler
+ options, providing some functionality similar to GNU :program:`autoconf`.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.detect_language(sources)
+
+ Detect the language of a given file, or list of files. Uses the instance
+ attributes :attr:`language_map` (a dictionary), and :attr:`language_order`
+ (a list) to do the job.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.find_library_file(dirs, lib[, debug=0])
+
+ Search the specified list of directories for a static or shared library file
+ *lib* and return the full path to that file. If *debug* is true, look for a
+ debugging version (if that makes sense on the current platform). Return
+ ``None`` if *lib* wasn't found in any of the specified directories.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.has_function(funcname [, includes=None, include_dirs=None, libraries=None, library_dirs=None])
+
+ Return a boolean indicating whether *funcname* is supported on the current
+ platform. The optional arguments can be used to augment the compilation
+ environment by providing additional include files and paths and libraries and
+ paths.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.library_dir_option(dir)
+
+ Return the compiler option to add *dir* to the list of directories searched for
+ libraries.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.library_option(lib)
+
+ Return the compiler option to add *dir* to the list of libraries linked into the
+ shared library or executable.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.runtime_library_dir_option(dir)
+
+ Return the compiler option to add *dir* to the list of directories searched for
+ runtime libraries.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.set_executables(**args)
+
+ Define the executables (and options for them) that will be run to perform the
+ various stages of compilation. The exact set of executables that may be
+ specified here depends on the compiler class (via the 'executables' class
+ attribute), but most will have:
+
+ +--------------+------------------------------------------+
+ | attribute | description |
+ +==============+==========================================+
+ | *compiler* | the C/C++ compiler |
+ +--------------+------------------------------------------+
+ | *linker_so* | linker used to create shared objects and |
+ | | libraries |
+ +--------------+------------------------------------------+
+ | *linker_exe* | linker used to create binary executables |
+ +--------------+------------------------------------------+
+ | *archiver* | static library creator |
+ +--------------+------------------------------------------+
+
+ On platforms with a command line (Unix, DOS/Windows), each of these is a string
+ that will be split into executable name and (optional) list of arguments.
+ (Splitting the string is done similarly to how Unix shells operate: words are
+ delimited by spaces, but quotes and backslashes can override this. See
+ :func:`packaging.util.split_quoted`.)
+
+ The following methods invoke stages in the build process.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.compile(sources[, output_dir=None, macros=None, include_dirs=None, debug=0, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None, depends=None])
+
+ Compile one or more source files. Generates object files (e.g. transforms a
+ :file:`.c` file to a :file:`.o` file.)
+
+ *sources* must be a list of filenames, most likely C/C++ files, but in reality
+ anything that can be handled by a particular compiler and compiler class (e.g.
+ an ``'msvc'`` compiler can handle resource files in *sources*). Return a list of
+ object filenames, one per source filename in *sources*. Depending on the
+ implementation, not all source files will necessarily be compiled, but all
+ corresponding object filenames will be returned.
+
+ If *output_dir* is given, object files will be put under it, while retaining
+ their original path component. That is, :file:`foo/bar.c` normally compiles to
+ :file:`foo/bar.o` (for a Unix implementation); if *output_dir* is *build*, then
+ it would compile to :file:`build/foo/bar.o`.
+
+ *macros*, if given, must be a list of macro definitions. A macro definition is
+ either a ``(name, value)`` 2-tuple or a ``(name,)`` 1-tuple. The former defines
+ a macro; if the value is ``None``, the macro is defined without an explicit
+ value. The 1-tuple case undefines a macro. Later
+ definitions/redefinitions/undefinitions take precedence.
+
+ *include_dirs*, if given, must be a list of strings, the directories to add to
+ the default include file search path for this compilation only.
+
+ *debug* is a boolean; if true, the compiler will be instructed to output debug
+ symbols in (or alongside) the object file(s).
+
+ *extra_preargs* and *extra_postargs* are implementation-dependent. On platforms
+ that have the notion of a command line (e.g. Unix, DOS/Windows), they are most
+ likely lists of strings: extra command-line arguments to prepend/append to the
+ compiler command line. On other platforms, consult the implementation class
+ documentation. In any event, they are intended as an escape hatch for those
+ occasions when the abstract compiler framework doesn't cut the mustard.
+
+ *depends*, if given, is a list of filenames that all targets depend on. If a
+ source file is older than any file in depends, then the source file will be
+ recompiled. This supports dependency tracking, but only at a coarse
+ granularity.
+
+ Raises :exc:`CompileError` on failure.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.create_static_lib(objects, output_libname[, output_dir=None, debug=0, target_lang=None])
+
+ Link a bunch of stuff together to create a static library file. The "bunch of
+ stuff" consists of the list of object files supplied as *objects*, the extra
+ object files supplied to :meth:`add_link_object` and/or
+ :meth:`set_link_objects`, the libraries supplied to :meth:`add_library` and/or
+ :meth:`set_libraries`, and the libraries supplied as *libraries* (if any).
+
+ *output_libname* should be a library name, not a filename; the filename will be
+ inferred from the library name. *output_dir* is the directory where the library
+ file will be put. XXX defaults to what?
+
+ *debug* is a boolean; if true, debugging information will be included in the
+ library (note that on most platforms, it is the compile step where this matters:
+ the *debug* flag is included here just for consistency).
+
+ *target_lang* is the target language for which the given objects are being
+ compiled. This allows specific linkage time treatment of certain languages.
+
+ Raises :exc:`LibError` on failure.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.link(target_desc, objects, output_filename[, output_dir=None, libraries=None, library_dirs=None, runtime_library_dirs=None, export_symbols=None, debug=0, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None, build_temp=None, target_lang=None])
+
+ Link a bunch of stuff together to create an executable or shared library file.
+
+ The "bunch of stuff" consists of the list of object files supplied as *objects*.
+ *output_filename* should be a filename. If *output_dir* is supplied,
+ *output_filename* is relative to it (i.e. *output_filename* can provide
+ directory components if needed).
+
+ *libraries* is a list of libraries to link against. These are library names,
+ not filenames, since they're translated into filenames in a platform-specific
+ way (e.g. *foo* becomes :file:`libfoo.a` on Unix and :file:`foo.lib` on
+ DOS/Windows). However, they can include a directory component, which means the
+ linker will look in that specific directory rather than searching all the normal
+ locations.
+
+ *library_dirs*, if supplied, should be a list of directories to search for
+ libraries that were specified as bare library names (i.e. no directory
+ component). These are on top of the system default and those supplied to
+ :meth:`add_library_dir` and/or :meth:`set_library_dirs`. *runtime_library_dirs*
+ is a list of directories that will be embedded into the shared library and used
+ to search for other shared libraries that \*it\* depends on at run-time. (This
+ may only be relevant on Unix.)
+
+ *export_symbols* is a list of symbols that the shared library will export.
+ (This appears to be relevant only on Windows.)
+
+ *debug* is as for :meth:`compile` and :meth:`create_static_lib`, with the
+ slight distinction that it actually matters on most platforms (as opposed to
+ :meth:`create_static_lib`, which includes a *debug* flag mostly for form's
+ sake).
+
+ *extra_preargs* and *extra_postargs* are as for :meth:`compile` (except of
+ course that they supply command-line arguments for the particular linker being
+ used).
+
+ *target_lang* is the target language for which the given objects are being
+ compiled. This allows specific linkage time treatment of certain languages.
+
+ Raises :exc:`LinkError` on failure.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.link_executable(objects, output_progname[, output_dir=None, libraries=None, library_dirs=None, runtime_library_dirs=None, debug=0, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None, target_lang=None])
+
+ Link an executable. *output_progname* is the name of the file executable, while
+ *objects* are a list of object filenames to link in. Other arguments are as for
+ the :meth:`link` method.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.link_shared_lib(objects, output_libname[, output_dir=None, libraries=None, library_dirs=None, runtime_library_dirs=None, export_symbols=None, debug=0, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None, build_temp=None, target_lang=None])
+
+ Link a shared library. *output_libname* is the name of the output library,
+ while *objects* is a list of object filenames to link in. Other arguments are
+ as for the :meth:`link` method.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.link_shared_object(objects, output_filename[, output_dir=None, libraries=None, library_dirs=None, runtime_library_dirs=None, export_symbols=None, debug=0, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None, build_temp=None, target_lang=None])
+
+ Link a shared object. *output_filename* is the name of the shared object that
+ will be created, while *objects* is a list of object filenames to link in.
+ Other arguments are as for the :meth:`link` method.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.preprocess(source[, output_file=None, macros=None, include_dirs=None, extra_preargs=None, extra_postargs=None])
+
+ Preprocess a single C/C++ source file, named in *source*. Output will be written
+ to file named *output_file*, or *stdout* if *output_file* not supplied.
+ *macros* is a list of macro definitions as for :meth:`compile`, which will
+ augment the macros set with :meth:`define_macro` and :meth:`undefine_macro`.
+ *include_dirs* is a list of directory names that will be added to the default
+ list, in the same way as :meth:`add_include_dir`.
+
+ Raises :exc:`PreprocessError` on failure.
+
+ The following utility methods are defined by the :class:`CCompiler` class, for
+ use by the various concrete subclasses.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.executable_filename(basename[, strip_dir=0, output_dir=''])
+
+ Returns the filename of the executable for the given *basename*. Typically for
+ non-Windows platforms this is the same as the basename, while Windows will get
+ a :file:`.exe` added.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.library_filename(libname[, lib_type='static', strip_dir=0, output_dir=''])
+
+ Returns the filename for the given library name on the current platform. On Unix
+ a library with *lib_type* of ``'static'`` will typically be of the form
+ :file:`liblibname.a`, while a *lib_type* of ``'dynamic'`` will be of the form
+ :file:`liblibname.so`.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.object_filenames(source_filenames[, strip_dir=0, output_dir=''])
+
+ Returns the name of the object files for the given source files.
+ *source_filenames* should be a list of filenames.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.shared_object_filename(basename[, strip_dir=0, output_dir=''])
+
+ Returns the name of a shared object file for the given file name *basename*.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.execute(func, args[, msg=None, level=1])
+
+ Invokes :func:`packaging.util.execute` This method invokes a Python function
+ *func* with the given arguments *args*, after logging and taking into account
+ the *dry_run* flag. XXX see also.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.spawn(cmd)
+
+ Invokes :func:`packaging.util.spawn`. This invokes an external process to run
+ the given command. XXX see also.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.mkpath(name[, mode=511])
+
+ Invokes :func:`packaging.dir_util.mkpath`. This creates a directory and any
+ missing ancestor directories. XXX see also.
+
+
+ .. method:: CCompiler.move_file(src, dst)
+
+ Invokes :meth:`packaging.file_util.move_file`. Renames *src* to *dst*. XXX see
+ also.
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.compiler.extension` --- The Extension class
+===========================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.compiler.extension
+ :synopsis: Class used to represent C/C++ extension modules.
+
+
+This module provides the :class:`Extension` class, used to represent C/C++
+extension modules.
+
+.. class:: Extension
+
+ The Extension class describes a single C or C++ extension module. It accepts
+ the following keyword arguments in its constructor:
+
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | argument name | value | type |
+ +========================+================================+===========================+
+ | *name* | the full name of the | string |
+ | | extension, including any | |
+ | | packages --- i.e. *not* a | |
+ | | filename or pathname, but | |
+ | | Python dotted name | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *sources* | list of source filenames, | list of strings |
+ | | relative to the distribution | |
+ | | root (where the setup script | |
+ | | lives), in Unix form (slash- | |
+ | | separated) for portability. | |
+ | | Source files may be C, C++, | |
+ | | SWIG (.i), platform-specific | |
+ | | resource files, or whatever | |
+ | | else is recognized by the | |
+ | | :command:`build_ext` command | |
+ | | as source for a Python | |
+ | | extension. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *include_dirs* | list of directories to search | list of strings |
+ | | for C/C++ header files (in | |
+ | | Unix form for portability) | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *define_macros* | list of macros to define; each | list of tuples |
+ | | macro is defined using a | |
+ | | 2-tuple ``(name, value)``, | |
+ | | where *value* is | |
+ | | either the string to define it | |
+ | | to or ``None`` to define it | |
+ | | without a particular value | |
+ | | (equivalent of ``#define FOO`` | |
+ | | in source or :option:`-DFOO` | |
+ | | on Unix C compiler command | |
+ | | line) | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *undef_macros* | list of macros to undefine | list of strings |
+ | | explicitly | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *library_dirs* | list of directories to search | list of strings |
+ | | for C/C++ libraries at link | |
+ | | time | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *libraries* | list of library names (not | list of strings |
+ | | filenames or paths) to link | |
+ | | against | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *runtime_library_dirs* | list of directories to search | list of strings |
+ | | for C/C++ libraries at run | |
+ | | time (for shared extensions, | |
+ | | this is when the extension is | |
+ | | loaded) | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *extra_objects* | list of extra files to link | list of strings |
+ | | with (e.g. object files not | |
+ | | implied by 'sources', static | |
+ | | library that must be | |
+ | | explicitly specified, binary | |
+ | | resource files, etc.) | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *extra_compile_args* | any extra platform- and | list of strings |
+ | | compiler-specific information | |
+ | | to use when compiling the | |
+ | | source files in 'sources'. For | |
+ | | platforms and compilers where | |
+ | | a command line makes sense, | |
+ | | this is typically a list of | |
+ | | command-line arguments, but | |
+ | | for other platforms it could | |
+ | | be anything. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *extra_link_args* | any extra platform- and | list of strings |
+ | | compiler-specific information | |
+ | | to use when linking object | |
+ | | files together to create the | |
+ | | extension (or to create a new | |
+ | | static Python interpreter). | |
+ | | Similar interpretation as for | |
+ | | 'extra_compile_args'. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *export_symbols* | list of symbols to be exported | list of strings |
+ | | from a shared extension. Not | |
+ | | used on all platforms, and not | |
+ | | generally necessary for Python | |
+ | | extensions, which typically | |
+ | | export exactly one symbol: | |
+ | | ``init`` + extension_name. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *depends* | list of files that the | list of strings |
+ | | extension depends on | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *language* | extension language (i.e. | string |
+ | | ``'c'``, ``'c++'``, | |
+ | | ``'objc'``). Will be detected | |
+ | | from the source extensions if | |
+ | | not provided. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+ | *optional* | specifies that a build failure | boolean |
+ | | in the extension should not | |
+ | | abort the build process, but | |
+ | | simply skip the extension. | |
+ +------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------------+
+
+To distribute extension modules that live in a package (e.g. ``package.ext``),
+you need to create a :file:`{package}/__init__.py` file to let Python recognize
+and import your module.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.database.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.database.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aaa2cb9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.database.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,324 @@
+:mod:`packaging.database` --- Database of installed distributions
+=================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.database
+ :synopsis: Functions to query and manipulate installed distributions.
+
+
+This module provides an implementation of :PEP:`376`. It was originally
+intended to land in :mod:`pkgutil`, but with the inclusion of Packaging in the
+standard library, it was thought best to include it in a submodule of
+:mod:`packaging`, leaving :mod:`pkgutil` to deal with imports.
+
+Installed Python distributions are represented by instances of
+:class:`Distribution`, or :class:`EggInfoDistribution` for legacy egg formats.
+Most functions also provide an extra argument ``use_egg_info`` to take legacy
+distributions into account.
+
+
+Classes representing installed distributions
+--------------------------------------------
+
+.. class:: Distribution(path)
+
+ Class representing an installed distribution. It is different from
+ :class:`packaging.dist.Distribution` which holds the list of files, the
+ metadata and options during the run of a Packaging command.
+
+ Instantiate with the *path* to a ``.dist-info`` directory. Instances can be
+ compared and sorted. Other available methods are:
+
+ .. XXX describe how comparison works
+
+ .. method:: get_distinfo_file(path, binary=False)
+
+ Return a read-only file object for a file located at
+ :file:`{project}-{version}.dist-info/{path}`. *path* should be a
+ ``'/'``-separated path relative to the ``.dist-info`` directory or an
+ absolute path; if it is an absolute path and doesn't start with the path
+ to the :file:`.dist-info` directory, a :class:`PackagingError` is raised.
+
+ If *binary* is ``True``, the file is opened in binary mode.
+
+ .. method:: get_resource_path(relative_path)
+
+ .. TODO
+
+ .. method:: list_distinfo_files(local=False)
+
+ Return an iterator over all files located in the :file:`.dist-info`
+ directory. If *local* is ``True``, each returned path is transformed into
+ a local absolute path, otherwise the raw value found in the :file:`RECORD`
+ file is returned.
+
+ .. method:: list_installed_files(local=False)
+
+ Iterate over the files installed with the distribution and registered in
+ the :file:`RECORD` file and yield a tuple ``(path, md5, size)`` for each
+ line. If *local* is ``True``, the returned path is transformed into a
+ local absolute path, otherwise the raw value is returned.
+
+ A local absolute path is an absolute path in which occurrences of ``'/'``
+ have been replaced by :data:`os.sep`.
+
+ .. method:: uses(path)
+
+ Check whether *path* was installed by this distribution (i.e. if the path
+ is present in the :file:`RECORD` file). *path* can be a local absolute
+ path or a relative ``'/'``-separated path. Returns a boolean.
+
+ Available attributes:
+
+ .. attribute:: metadata
+
+ Instance of :class:`packaging.metadata.Metadata` filled with the contents
+ of the :file:`{project}-{version}.dist-info/METADATA` file.
+
+ .. attribute:: name
+
+ Shortcut for ``metadata['Name']``.
+
+ .. attribute:: version
+
+ Shortcut for ``metadata['Version']``.
+
+ .. attribute:: requested
+
+ Boolean indicating whether this distribution was requested by the user of
+ automatically installed as a dependency.
+
+
+.. class:: EggInfoDistribution(path)
+
+ Class representing a legacy distribution. It is compatible with distutils'
+ and setuptools' :file:`.egg-info` and :file:`.egg` files and directories.
+
+ .. FIXME should be named EggDistribution
+
+ Instantiate with the *path* to an egg file or directory. Instances can be
+ compared and sorted. Other available methods are:
+
+ .. method:: list_installed_files(local=False)
+
+ .. method:: uses(path)
+
+ Available attributes:
+
+ .. attribute:: metadata
+
+ Instance of :class:`packaging.metadata.Metadata` filled with the contents
+ of the :file:`{project-version}.egg-info/PKG-INFO` or
+ :file:`{project-version}.egg` file.
+
+ .. attribute:: name
+
+ Shortcut for ``metadata['Name']``.
+
+ .. attribute:: version
+
+ Shortcut for ``metadata['Version']``.
+
+
+Functions to work with the database
+-----------------------------------
+
+.. function:: get_distribution(name, use_egg_info=False, paths=None)
+
+ Return an instance of :class:`Distribution` or :class:`EggInfoDistribution`
+ for the first installed distribution matching *name*. Egg distributions are
+ considered only if *use_egg_info* is true; if both a dist-info and an egg
+ file are found, the dist-info prevails. The directories to be searched are
+ given in *paths*, which defaults to :data:`sys.path`. Return ``None`` if no
+ matching distribution is found.
+
+ .. FIXME param should be named use_egg
+
+
+.. function:: get_distributions(use_egg_info=False, paths=None)
+
+ Return an iterator of :class:`Distribution` instances for all installed
+ distributions found in *paths* (defaults to :data:`sys.path`). If
+ *use_egg_info* is true, also return instances of :class:`EggInfoDistribution`
+ for legacy distributions found.
+
+
+.. function:: get_file_users(path)
+
+ Return an iterator over all distributions using *path*, a local absolute path
+ or a relative ``'/'``-separated path.
+
+ .. XXX does this work with prefixes or full file path only?
+
+
+.. function:: obsoletes_distribution(name, version=None, use_egg_info=False)
+
+ Return an iterator over all distributions that declare they obsolete *name*.
+ *version* is an optional argument to match only specific releases (see
+ :mod:`packaging.version`). If *use_egg_info* is true, legacy egg
+ distributions will be considered as well.
+
+
+.. function:: provides_distribution(name, version=None, use_egg_info=False)
+
+ Return an iterator over all distributions that declare they provide *name*.
+ *version* is an optional argument to match only specific releases (see
+ :mod:`packaging.version`). If *use_egg_info* is true, legacy egg
+ distributions will be considered as well.
+
+
+Utility functions
+-----------------
+
+.. function:: distinfo_dirname(name, version)
+
+ Escape *name* and *version* into a filename-safe form and return the
+ directory name built from them, for example
+ :file:`{safename}-{safeversion}.dist-info.` In *name*, runs of
+ non-alphanumeric characters are replaced with one ``'_'``; in *version*,
+ spaces become dots, and runs of other non-alphanumeric characters (except
+ dots) a replaced by one ``'-'``.
+
+ .. XXX wth spaces in version numbers?
+
+For performance purposes, the list of distributions is being internally
+cached. Caching is enabled by default, but you can control it with these
+functions:
+
+.. function:: clear_cache()
+
+ Clear the cache.
+
+.. function:: disable_cache()
+
+ Disable the cache, without clearing it.
+
+.. function:: enable_cache()
+
+ Enable the internal cache, without clearing it.
+
+
+Examples
+--------
+
+Print all information about a distribution
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+Given a path to a ``.dist-info`` distribution, we shall print out all
+information that can be obtained using functions provided in this module::
+
+ import sys
+ import packaging.database
+
+ path = input()
+ # first create the Distribution instance
+ try:
+ dist = packaging.database.Distribution(path)
+ except FileNotFoundError:
+ sys.exit('No such distribution')
+
+ print('Information about %r' % dist.name)
+ print()
+
+ print('Files')
+ print('=====')
+ for path, md5, size in dist.list_installed_files():
+ print('* Path: %s' % path)
+ print(' Hash %s, Size: %s bytes' % (md5, size))
+ print()
+
+ print('Metadata')
+ print('========')
+ for key, value in dist.metadata.items():
+ print('%20s: %s' % (key, value))
+ print()
+
+ print('Extra')
+ print('=====')
+ if dist.requested:
+ print('* It was installed by user request')
+ else:
+ print('* It was installed as a dependency')
+
+If we save the script above as ``print_info.py``, we can use it to extract
+information from a :file:`.dist-info` directory. By typing in the console:
+
+.. code-block:: sh
+
+ $ echo /tmp/choxie/choxie-2.0.0.9.dist-info | python3 print_info.py
+
+we get the following output:
+
+.. code-block:: none
+
+ Information about 'choxie'
+
+ Files
+ =====
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9/truffles.py
+ Hash 5e052db6a478d06bad9ae033e6bc08af, Size: 111 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9/choxie/chocolate.py
+ Hash ac56bf496d8d1d26f866235b95f31030, Size: 214 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9/choxie/__init__.py
+ Hash 416aab08dfa846f473129e89a7625bbc, Size: 25 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9.dist-info/INSTALLER
+ Hash d41d8cd98f00b204e9800998ecf8427e, Size: 0 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9.dist-info/METADATA
+ Hash 696a209967fef3c8b8f5a7bb10386385, Size: 225 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9.dist-info/REQUESTED
+ Hash d41d8cd98f00b204e9800998ecf8427e, Size: 0 bytes
+ * Path: ../tmp/distutils2/tests/fake_dists/choxie-2.0.0.9.dist-info/RECORD
+ Hash None, Size: None bytes
+
+ Metadata
+ ========
+ Metadata-Version: 1.2
+ Name: choxie
+ Version: 2.0.0.9
+ Platform: []
+ Supported-Platform: UNKNOWN
+ Summary: Chocolate with a kick!
+ Description: UNKNOWN
+ Keywords: []
+ Home-page: UNKNOWN
+ Author: UNKNOWN
+ Author-email: UNKNOWN
+ Maintainer: UNKNOWN
+ Maintainer-email: UNKNOWN
+ License: UNKNOWN
+ Classifier: []
+ Download-URL: UNKNOWN
+ Obsoletes-Dist: ['truffles (<=0.8,>=0.5)', 'truffles (<=0.9,>=0.6)']
+ Project-URL: []
+ Provides-Dist: ['truffles (1.0)']
+ Requires-Dist: ['towel-stuff (0.1)']
+ Requires-Python: UNKNOWN
+ Requires-External: []
+
+ Extra
+ =====
+ * It was installed as a dependency
+
+
+Find out obsoleted distributions
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+Now, we take tackle a different problem, we are interested in finding out
+which distributions have been obsoleted. This can be easily done as follows::
+
+ import packaging.database
+
+ # iterate over all distributions in the system
+ for dist in packaging.database.get_distributions():
+ name, version = dist.name, dist.version
+ # find out which distributions obsolete this name/version combination
+ replacements = packaging.database.obsoletes_distribution(name, version)
+ if replacements:
+ print('%r %s is obsoleted by' % (name, version),
+ ', '.join(repr(r.name) for r in replacements))
+
+This is how the output might look like:
+
+.. code-block:: none
+
+ 'strawberry' 0.6 is obsoleted by 'choxie'
+ 'grammar' 1.0a4 is obsoleted by 'towel-stuff'
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.depgraph.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.depgraph.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c384788
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.depgraph.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,199 @@
+:mod:`packaging.depgraph` --- Dependency graph builder
+======================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.depgraph
+ :synopsis: Graph builder for dependencies between releases.
+
+
+This module provides the means to analyse the dependencies between various
+distributions and to create a graph representing these dependency relationships.
+In this document, "distribution" refers to an instance of
+:class:`packaging.database.Distribution` or
+:class:`packaging.database.EggInfoDistribution`.
+
+.. XXX terminology problem with dist vs. release: dists are installed, but deps
+ use releases
+
+.. XXX explain how to use it with dists not installed: Distribution can only be
+ instantiated with a path, but this module is useful for remote dist too
+
+.. XXX functions should accept and return iterators, not lists
+
+
+The :class:`DependencyGraph` class
+----------------------------------
+
+.. class:: DependencyGraph
+
+ Represent a dependency graph between releases. The nodes are distribution
+ instances; the edge model dependencies. An edge from ``a`` to ``b`` means
+ that ``a`` depends on ``b``.
+
+ .. method:: add_distribution(distribution)
+
+ Add *distribution* to the graph.
+
+ .. method:: add_edge(x, y, label=None)
+
+ Add an edge from distribution *x* to distribution *y* with the given
+ *label* (string).
+
+ .. method:: add_missing(distribution, requirement)
+
+ Add a missing *requirement* (string) for the given *distribution*.
+
+ .. method:: repr_node(dist, level=1)
+
+ Print a subgraph starting from *dist*. *level* gives the depth of the
+ subgraph.
+
+ Direct access to the graph nodes and edges is provided through these
+ attributes:
+
+ .. attribute:: adjacency_list
+
+ Dictionary mapping distributions to a list of ``(other, label)`` tuples
+ where ``other`` is a distribution and the edge is labeled with ``label``
+ (i.e. the version specifier, if such was provided).
+
+ .. attribute:: reverse_list
+
+ Dictionary mapping distributions to a list of predecessors. This allows
+ efficient traversal.
+
+ .. attribute:: missing
+
+ Dictionary mapping distributions to a list of requirements that were not
+ provided by any distribution.
+
+
+Auxiliary functions
+-------------------
+
+.. function:: dependent_dists(dists, dist)
+
+ Recursively generate a list of distributions from *dists* that are dependent
+ on *dist*.
+
+ .. XXX what does member mean here: "dist is a member of *dists* for which we
+ are interested"
+
+.. function:: generate_graph(dists)
+
+ Generate a :class:`DependencyGraph` from the given list of distributions.
+
+ .. XXX make this alternate constructor a DepGraph classmethod or rename;
+ 'generate' can suggest it creates a file or an image, use 'make'
+
+.. function:: graph_to_dot(graph, f, skip_disconnected=True)
+
+ Write a DOT output for the graph to the file-like object *f*.
+
+ If *skip_disconnected* is true, all distributions that are not dependent on
+ any other distribution are skipped.
+
+ .. XXX why is this not a DepGraph method?
+
+
+Example Usage
+-------------
+
+Depict all dependenciess in the system
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+First, we shall generate a graph of all the distributions on the system
+and then create an image out of it using the tools provided by
+`Graphviz <http://www.graphviz.org/>`_::
+
+ from packaging.database import get_distributions
+ from packaging.depgraph import generate_graph
+
+ dists = list(get_distributions())
+ graph = generate_graph(dists)
+
+It would be interesting to print out the missing requirements. This can be done
+as follows::
+
+ for dist, reqs in graph.missing.items():
+ if reqs:
+ reqs = ' ,'.join(repr(req) for req in reqs)
+ print('Missing dependencies for %r: %s' % (dist.name, reqs))
+
+Example output is:
+
+.. code-block:: none
+
+ Missing dependencies for 'TurboCheetah': 'Cheetah'
+ Missing dependencies for 'TurboGears': 'ConfigObj', 'DecoratorTools', 'RuleDispatch'
+ Missing dependencies for 'jockey': 'PyKDE4.kdecore', 'PyKDE4.kdeui', 'PyQt4.QtCore', 'PyQt4.QtGui'
+ Missing dependencies for 'TurboKid': 'kid'
+ Missing dependencies for 'TurboJson: 'DecoratorTools', 'RuleDispatch'
+
+Now, we proceed with generating a graphical representation of the graph. First
+we write it to a file, and then we generate a PNG image using the
+:program:`dot` command-line tool::
+
+ from packaging.depgraph import graph_to_dot
+ with open('output.dot', 'w') as f:
+ # only show the interesting distributions, skipping the disconnected ones
+ graph_to_dot(graph, f, skip_disconnected=True)
+
+We can create the final picture using:
+
+.. code-block:: sh
+
+ $ dot -Tpng output.dot > output.png
+
+An example result is:
+
+.. figure:: depgraph-output.png
+ :alt: Example PNG output from packaging.depgraph and dot
+
+If you want to include egg distributions as well, then the code requires only
+one change, namely the line::
+
+ dists = list(packaging.database.get_distributions())
+
+has to be replaced with::
+
+ dists = list(packaging.database.get_distributions(use_egg_info=True))
+
+On many platforms, a richer graph is obtained because at the moment most
+distributions are provided in the egg rather than the new standard
+``.dist-info`` format.
+
+.. XXX missing image
+
+ An example of a more involved graph for illustrative reasons can be seen
+ here:
+
+ .. image:: depgraph_big.png
+
+
+List all dependent distributions
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+We will list all distributions that are dependent on some given distibution.
+This time, egg distributions will be considered as well::
+
+ import sys
+ from packaging.database import get_distribution, get_distributions
+ from packaging.depgraph import dependent_dists
+
+ dists = list(get_distributions(use_egg_info=True))
+ dist = get_distribution('bacon', use_egg_info=True)
+ if dist is None:
+ sys.exit('No such distribution in the system')
+
+ deps = dependent_dists(dists, dist)
+ deps = ', '.join(repr(x.name) for x in deps)
+ print('Distributions depending on %r: %s' % (dist.name, deps))
+
+And this is example output:
+
+.. with the dependency relationships as in the previous section
+ (depgraph_big)
+
+.. code-block:: none
+
+ Distributions depending on 'bacon': 'towel-stuff', 'choxie', 'grammar'
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.dist.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.dist.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..25cb62b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.dist.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,108 @@
+:mod:`packaging.dist` --- The Distribution class
+================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.dist
+ :synopsis: Core Distribution class.
+
+
+This module provides the :class:`Distribution` class, which represents the
+module distribution being built/packaged/distributed/installed.
+
+.. class:: Distribution(arguments)
+
+ A :class:`Distribution` describes how to build, package, distribute and
+ install a Python project.
+
+ The arguments accepted by the constructor are laid out in the following
+ table. Some of them will end up in a metadata object, the rest will become
+ data attributes of the :class:`Distribution` instance.
+
+ .. TODO improve constructor to take a Metadata object + named params?
+ (i.e. Distribution(metadata, cmdclass, py_modules, etc)
+ .. TODO also remove obsolete(?) script_name, etc. parameters? see what
+ py2exe and other tools need
+
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | argument name | value | type |
+ +====================+================================+=============================================================+
+ | *name* | The name of the project | a string |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *version* | The version number of the | a string |
+ | | release; see | |
+ | | :mod:`packaging.version` | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *summary* | A single line describing the | a string |
+ | | project | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *description* | Longer description of the | a string |
+ | | project | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *author* | The name of the project author | a string |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *author_email* | The email address of the | a string |
+ | | project author | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *maintainer* | The name of the current | a string |
+ | | maintainer, if different from | |
+ | | the author | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *maintainer_email* | The email address of the | a string |
+ | | current maintainer, if | |
+ | | different from the author | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *home_page* | A URL for the proejct | a string |
+ | | (homepage) | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *download_url* | A URL to download the project | a string |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *packages* | A list of Python packages that | a list of strings |
+ | | packaging will manipulate | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *py_modules* | A list of Python modules that | a list of strings |
+ | | packaging will manipulate | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *scripts* | A list of standalone scripts | a list of strings |
+ | | to be built and installed | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *ext_modules* | A list of Python extensions to | a list of instances of |
+ | | be built | :class:`packaging.compiler.extension.Extension` |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *classifiers* | A list of categories for the | a list of strings; valid classifiers are listed on `PyPi |
+ | | distribution | <http://pypi.python.org/pypi?:action=list_classifiers>`_. |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *distclass* | the :class:`Distribution` | a subclass of |
+ | | class to use | :class:`packaging.dist.Distribution` |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *script_name* | The name of the setup.py | a string |
+ | | script - defaults to | |
+ | | ``sys.argv[0]`` | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *script_args* | Arguments to supply to the | a list of strings |
+ | | setup script | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *options* | default options for the setup | a string |
+ | | script | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *license* | The license for the | a string |
+ | | distribution; should be used | |
+ | | when there is no suitable | |
+ | | License classifier, or to | |
+ | | refine a classifier | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *keywords* | Descriptive keywords; used by | a list of strings or a comma-separated string |
+ | | catalogs such as PyPI | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *platforms* | Platforms compatible with this | a list of strings or a comma-separated string |
+ | | distribution; should be used | |
+ | | when there is no suitable | |
+ | | Platform classifier | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *cmdclass* | A mapping of command names to | a dictionary |
+ | | :class:`Command` subclasses | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *data_files* | A list of data files to | a list |
+ | | install | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
+ | *package_dir* | A mapping of Python packages | a dictionary |
+ | | to directory names | |
+ +--------------------+--------------------------------+-------------------------------------------------------------+
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.fancy_getopt.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.fancy_getopt.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2c69341
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.fancy_getopt.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+:mod:`packaging.fancy_getopt` --- Wrapper around the getopt module
+==================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.fancy_getopt
+ :synopsis: Additional getopt functionality.
+
+
+.. warning::
+ This module is deprecated and will be replaced with :mod:`optparse`.
+
+This module provides a wrapper around the standard :mod:`getopt` module that
+provides the following additional features:
+
+* short and long options are tied together
+
+* options have help strings, so :func:`fancy_getopt` could potentially create a
+ complete usage summary
+
+* options set attributes of a passed-in object
+
+* boolean options can have "negative aliases" --- e.g. if :option:`--quiet` is
+ the "negative alias" of :option:`--verbose`, then :option:`--quiet` on the
+ command line sets *verbose* to false.
+
+.. function:: fancy_getopt(options, negative_opt, object, args)
+
+ Wrapper function. *options* is a list of ``(long_option, short_option,
+ help_string)`` 3-tuples as described in the constructor for
+ :class:`FancyGetopt`. *negative_opt* should be a dictionary mapping option names
+ to option names, both the key and value should be in the *options* list.
+ *object* is an object which will be used to store values (see the :meth:`getopt`
+ method of the :class:`FancyGetopt` class). *args* is the argument list. Will use
+ ``sys.argv[1:]`` if you pass ``None`` as *args*.
+
+
+.. class:: FancyGetopt([option_table=None])
+
+ The option_table is a list of 3-tuples: ``(long_option, short_option,
+ help_string)``
+
+ If an option takes an argument, its *long_option* should have ``'='`` appended;
+ *short_option* should just be a single character, no ``':'`` in any case.
+ *short_option* should be ``None`` if a *long_option* doesn't have a
+ corresponding *short_option*. All option tuples must have long options.
+
+The :class:`FancyGetopt` class provides the following methods:
+
+
+.. method:: FancyGetopt.getopt([args=None, object=None])
+
+ Parse command-line options in args. Store as attributes on *object*.
+
+ If *args* is ``None`` or not supplied, uses ``sys.argv[1:]``. If *object* is
+ ``None`` or not supplied, creates a new :class:`OptionDummy` instance, stores
+ option values there, and returns a tuple ``(args, object)``. If *object* is
+ supplied, it is modified in place and :func:`getopt` just returns *args*; in
+ both cases, the returned *args* is a modified copy of the passed-in *args* list,
+ which is left untouched.
+
+ .. TODO and args returned are?
+
+
+.. method:: FancyGetopt.get_option_order()
+
+ Returns the list of ``(option, value)`` tuples processed by the previous run of
+ :meth:`getopt` Raises :exc:`RuntimeError` if :meth:`getopt` hasn't been called
+ yet.
+
+
+.. method:: FancyGetopt.generate_help([header=None])
+
+ Generate help text (a list of strings, one per suggested line of output) from
+ the option table for this :class:`FancyGetopt` object.
+
+ If supplied, prints the supplied *header* at the top of the help.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.install.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.install.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3e00750
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.install.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,112 @@
+:mod:`packaging.install` --- Installation tools
+===============================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.install
+ :synopsis: Download and installation building blocks
+
+
+Packaging provides a set of tools to deal with downloads and installation of
+distributions. Their role is to download the distribution from indexes, resolve
+the dependencies, and provide a safe way to install distributions. An operation
+that fails will cleanly roll back, not leave half-installed distributions on the
+system. Here's the basic process followed:
+
+#. Move all distributions that will be removed to a temporary location.
+
+#. Install all the distributions that will be installed in a temporary location.
+
+#. If the installation fails, move the saved distributions back to their
+ location and delete the installed distributions.
+
+#. Otherwise, move the installed distributions to the right location and delete
+ the temporary locations.
+
+This is a higher-level module built on :mod:`packaging.database` and
+:mod:`packaging.pypi`.
+
+
+Public functions
+----------------
+
+.. function:: get_infos(requirements, index=None, installed=None, \
+ prefer_final=True)
+
+ Return information about what's going to be installed and upgraded.
+ *requirements* is a string containing the requirements for this
+ project, for example ``'FooBar 1.1'`` or ``'BarBaz (<1.2)'``.
+
+ .. XXX are requirements comma-separated?
+
+ If you want to use another index than the main PyPI, give its URI as *index*
+ argument.
+
+ *installed* is a list of already installed distributions used to find
+ satisfied dependencies, obsoleted distributions and eventual conflicts.
+
+ By default, alpha, beta and candidate versions are not picked up. Set
+ *prefer_final* to false to accept them too.
+
+ The results are returned in a dictionary containing all the information
+ needed to perform installation of the requirements with the
+ :func:`install_from_infos` function:
+
+ >>> get_install_info("FooBar (<=1.2)")
+ {'install': [<FooBar 1.1>], 'remove': [], 'conflict': []}
+
+ .. TODO should return tuple or named tuple, not dict
+ .. TODO use "predicate" or "requirement" consistently in version and here
+ .. FIXME "info" cannot be plural in English, s/infos/info/
+
+
+.. function:: install(project)
+
+
+.. function:: install_dists(dists, path, paths=None)
+
+ Safely install all distributions provided in *dists* into *path*. *paths* is
+ a list of paths where already-installed distributions will be looked for to
+ find satisfied dependencies and conflicts (default: :data:`sys.path`).
+ Returns a list of installed dists.
+
+ .. FIXME dists are instances of what?
+
+
+.. function:: install_from_infos(install_path=None, install=[], remove=[], \
+ conflicts=[], paths=None)
+
+ Safely install and remove given distributions. This function is designed to
+ work with the return value of :func:`get_infos`: *install*, *remove* and
+ *conflicts* should be list of distributions returned by :func:`get_infos`.
+ If *install* is not empty, *install_path* must be given to specify the path
+ where the distributions should be installed. *paths* is a list of paths
+ where already-installed distributions will be looked for (default:
+ :data:`sys.path`).
+
+ This function is a very basic installer; if *conflicts* is not empty, the
+ system will be in a conflicting state after the function completes. It is a
+ building block for more sophisticated installers with conflict resolution
+ systems.
+
+ .. TODO document typical value for install_path
+ .. TODO document integration with default schemes, esp. user site-packages
+
+
+.. function:: install_local_project(path)
+
+ Install a distribution from a source directory, which must contain either a
+ Packaging-compliant :file:`setup.cfg` file or a legacy Distutils
+ :file:`setup.py` script (in which case Distutils will be used under the hood
+ to perform the installation).
+
+
+.. function:: remove(project_name, paths=None, auto_confirm=True)
+
+ Remove one distribution from the system.
+
+ .. FIXME this is the only function using "project" instead of dist/release
+
+..
+ Example usage
+ --------------
+
+ Get the scheme of what's gonna be installed if we install "foobar":
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.metadata.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.metadata.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..332d69d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.metadata.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
+:mod:`packaging.metadata` --- Metadata handling
+===============================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.metadata
+ :synopsis: Class holding the metadata of a release.
+
+
+.. TODO use sphinx-autogen to generate basic doc from the docstrings
+
+.. class:: Metadata
+
+ This class can read and write metadata files complying with any of the
+ defined versions: 1.0 (:PEP:`241`), 1.1 (:PEP:`314`) and 1.2 (:PEP:`345`). It
+ implements methods to parse Metadata files and write them, and a mapping
+ interface to its contents.
+
+ The :PEP:`345` implementation supports the micro-language for the environment
+ markers, and displays warnings when versions that are supposed to be
+ :PEP:`386`-compliant are violating the specification.
+
+
+Reading metadata
+----------------
+
+The :class:`Metadata` class can be instantiated
+with the path of the metadata file, and provides a dict-like interface to the
+values::
+
+ >>> from packaging.metadata import Metadata
+ >>> metadata = Metadata('PKG-INFO')
+ >>> metadata.keys()[:5]
+ ('Metadata-Version', 'Name', 'Version', 'Platform', 'Supported-Platform')
+ >>> metadata['Name']
+ 'CLVault'
+ >>> metadata['Version']
+ '0.5'
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist']
+ ["pywin32; sys.platform == 'win32'", "Sphinx"]
+
+
+The fields that support environment markers can be automatically ignored if
+the object is instantiated using the ``platform_dependent`` option.
+:class:`Metadata` will interpret in this case
+the markers and will automatically remove the fields that are not compliant
+with the running environment. Here's an example under Mac OS X. The win32
+dependency we saw earlier is ignored::
+
+ >>> from packaging.metadata import Metadata
+ >>> metadata = Metadata('PKG-INFO', platform_dependent=True)
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist']
+ ['Sphinx']
+
+
+If you want to provide your own execution context, let's say to test the
+metadata under a particular environment that is not the current environment,
+you can provide your own values in the ``execution_context`` option, which
+is the dict that may contain one or more keys of the context the micro-language
+expects.
+
+Here's an example, simulating a win32 environment::
+
+ >>> from packaging.metadata import Metadata
+ >>> context = {'sys.platform': 'win32'}
+ >>> metadata = Metadata('PKG-INFO', platform_dependent=True,
+ ... execution_context=context)
+ ...
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist'] = ["pywin32; sys.platform == 'win32'",
+ ... "Sphinx"]
+ ...
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist']
+ ['pywin32', 'Sphinx']
+
+
+Writing metadata
+----------------
+
+Writing metadata can be done using the ``write`` method::
+
+ >>> metadata.write('/to/my/PKG-INFO')
+
+The class will pick the best version for the metadata, depending on the values
+provided. If all the values provided exist in all versions, the class will
+use :attr:`PKG_INFO_PREFERRED_VERSION`. It is set by default to 1.0, the most
+widespread version.
+
+
+Conflict checking and best version
+----------------------------------
+
+Some fields in :PEP:`345` have to comply with the version number specification
+defined in :PEP:`386`. When they don't comply, a warning is emitted::
+
+ >>> from packaging.metadata import Metadata
+ >>> metadata = Metadata()
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist'] = ['Funky (Groovie)']
+ "Funky (Groovie)" is not a valid predicate
+ >>> metadata['Requires-Dist'] = ['Funky (1.2)']
+
+See also :mod:`packaging.version`.
+
+
+.. TODO talk about check()
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.markers` --- Environment markers
+================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.markers
+ :synopsis: Micro-language for environment markers
+
+
+This is an implementation of environment markers `as defined in PEP 345
+<http://www.python.org/dev/peps/pep-0345/#environment-markers>`_. It is used
+for some metadata fields.
+
+.. function:: interpret(marker, execution_context=None)
+
+ Interpret a marker and return a boolean result depending on the environment.
+ Example:
+
+ >>> interpret("python_version > '1.0'")
+ True
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.dist.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.dist.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aaaaab7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.dist.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.dist` --- Classes representing query results
+=================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi.dist
+ :synopsis: Classes representing the results of queries to indexes.
+
+
+Information coming from the indexes is held in instances of the classes defined
+in this module.
+
+Keep in mind that each project (eg. FooBar) can have several releases
+(eg. 1.1, 1.2, 1.3), and each of these releases can be provided in multiple
+distributions (eg. a source distribution, a binary one, etc).
+
+
+ReleaseInfo
+-----------
+
+Each release has a project name, version, metadata, and related distributions.
+
+This information is stored in :class:`ReleaseInfo`
+objects.
+
+.. class:: ReleaseInfo
+
+
+DistInfo
+---------
+
+:class:`DistInfo` is a simple class that contains
+information related to distributions; mainly the URLs where distributions
+can be found.
+
+.. class:: DistInfo
+
+
+ReleasesList
+------------
+
+The :mod:`~packaging.pypi.dist` module provides a class which works
+with lists of :class:`ReleaseInfo` classes;
+used to filter and order results.
+
+.. class:: ReleasesList
+
+
+Example usage
+-------------
+
+Build a list of releases and order them
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+Assuming we have a list of releases::
+
+ >>> from packaging.pypi.dist import ReleasesList, ReleaseInfo
+ >>> fb10 = ReleaseInfo("FooBar", "1.0")
+ >>> fb11 = ReleaseInfo("FooBar", "1.1")
+ >>> fb11a = ReleaseInfo("FooBar", "1.1a1")
+ >>> ReleasesList("FooBar", [fb11, fb11a, fb10])
+ >>> releases.sort_releases()
+ >>> releases.get_versions()
+ ['1.1', '1.1a1', '1.0']
+ >>> releases.add_release("1.2a1")
+ >>> releases.get_versions()
+ ['1.1', '1.1a1', '1.0', '1.2a1']
+ >>> releases.sort_releases()
+ ['1.2a1', '1.1', '1.1a1', '1.0']
+ >>> releases.sort_releases(prefer_final=True)
+ >>> releases.get_versions()
+ ['1.1', '1.0', '1.2a1', '1.1a1']
+
+
+Add distribution related information to releases
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+It's easy to add distribution information to releases::
+
+ >>> from packaging.pypi.dist import ReleasesList, ReleaseInfo
+ >>> r = ReleaseInfo("FooBar", "1.0")
+ >>> r.add_distribution("sdist", url="http://example.org/foobar-1.0.tar.gz")
+ >>> r.dists
+ {'sdist': FooBar 1.0 sdist}
+ >>> r['sdist'].url
+ {'url': 'http://example.org/foobar-1.0.tar.gz', 'hashname': None, 'hashval':
+ None, 'is_external': True}
+
+
+Getting attributes from the dist objects
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+To abstract querying information returned from the indexes, attributes and
+release information can be retrieved directly from dist objects.
+
+For instance, if you have a release instance that does not contain the metadata
+attribute, it can be fetched by using the "fetch_metadata" method::
+
+ >>> r = Release("FooBar", "1.1")
+ >>> print r.metadata
+ None # metadata field is actually set to "None"
+ >>> r.fetch_metadata()
+ <Metadata for FooBar 1.1>
+
+.. XXX add proper roles to these constructs
+
+
+It's possible to retrieve a project's releases (`fetch_releases`),
+metadata (`fetch_metadata`) and distributions (`fetch_distributions`) using
+a similar work flow.
+
+.. XXX what is possible?
+
+Internally, this is possible because while retrieving information about
+projects, releases or distributions, a reference to the client used is
+stored which can be accessed using the objects `_index` attribute.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..14602ce
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+:mod:`packaging.pypi` --- Interface to projects indexes
+=======================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi
+ :synopsis: Low-level and high-level APIs to query projects indexes.
+
+
+Packaging queries PyPI to get information about projects or download them. The
+low-level facilities used internally are also part of the public API designed to
+be used by other tools.
+
+The :mod:`packaging.pypi` package provides those facilities, which can be
+used to access information about Python projects registered at indexes, the
+main one being PyPI, located ad http://pypi.python.org/.
+
+There is two ways to retrieve data from these indexes: a screen-scraping
+interface called the "simple API", and XML-RPC. The first one uses HTML pages
+located under http://pypi.python.org/simple/, the second one makes XML-RPC
+requests to http://pypi.python.org/pypi/. All functions and classes also work
+with other indexes such as mirrors, which typically implement only the simple
+interface.
+
+Packaging provides a class that wraps both APIs to provide full query and
+download functionality: :class:`packaging.pypi.client.ClientWrapper`. If you
+want more control, you can use the underlying classes
+:class:`packaging.pypi.simple.Crawler` and :class:`packaging.pypi.xmlrpc.Client`
+to connect to one specific interface.
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.client` --- High-level query API
+=====================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi.client
+ :synopsis: Wrapper around :mod;`packaging.pypi.xmlrpc` and
+ :mod:`packaging.pypi.simple` to query indexes.
+
+
+This module provides a high-level API to query indexes and search
+for releases and distributions. The aim of this module is to choose the best
+way to query the API automatically, either using XML-RPC or the simple index,
+with a preference toward the latter.
+
+.. class:: ClientWrapper
+
+ Instances of this class will use the simple interface or XML-RPC requests to
+ query indexes and return :class:`packaging.pypi.dist.ReleaseInfo` and
+ :class:`packaging.pypi.dist.ReleasesList` objects.
+
+ .. method:: find_projects
+
+ .. method:: get_release
+
+ .. method:: get_releases
+
+
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.base` --- Base class for index crawlers
+============================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi.base
+ :synopsis: Base class used to implement crawlers.
+
+
+.. class:: BaseClient(prefer_final, prefer_source)
+
+ Base class containing common methods for the index crawlers or clients. One
+ method is currently defined:
+
+ .. method:: download_distribution(requirements, temp_path=None, \
+ prefer_source=None, prefer_final=None)
+
+ Download a distribution from the last release according to the
+ requirements. If *temp_path* is provided, download to this path,
+ otherwise, create a temporary directory for the download. If a release is
+ found, the full path to the downloaded file is returned.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.simple.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.simple.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f579b18
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.simple.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,218 @@
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.simple` --- Crawler using the PyPI "simple" interface
+==========================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi.simple
+ :synopsis: Crawler using the screen-scraping "simple" interface to fetch info
+ and distributions.
+
+
+The class provided by :mod:`packaging.pypi.simple` can access project indexes
+and provide useful information about distributions. PyPI, other indexes and
+local indexes are supported.
+
+You should use this module to search distributions by name and versions, process
+index external pages and download distributions. It is not suited for things
+that will end up in too long index processing (like "finding all distributions
+with a specific version, no matter the name"); use :mod:`packaging.pypi.xmlrpc`
+for that.
+
+
+API
+---
+
+.. class:: Crawler(index_url=DEFAULT_SIMPLE_INDEX_URL, \
+ prefer_final=False, prefer_source=True, \
+ hosts=('*',), follow_externals=False, \
+ mirrors_url=None, mirrors=None, timeout=15, \
+ mirrors_max_tries=0)
+
+ *index_url* is the address of the index to use for requests.
+
+ The first two parameters control the query results. *prefer_final*
+ indicates whether a final version (not alpha, beta or candidate) is to be
+ preferred over a newer but non-final version (for example, whether to pick
+ up 1.0 over 2.0a3). It is used only for queries that don't give a version
+ argument. Likewise, *prefer_source* tells whether to prefer a source
+ distribution over a binary one, if no distribution argument was prodived.
+
+ Other parameters are related to external links (that is links that go
+ outside the simple index): *hosts* is a list of hosts allowed to be
+ processed if *follow_externals* is true (default behavior is to follow all
+ hosts), *follow_externals* enables or disables following external links
+ (default is false, meaning disabled).
+
+ The remaining parameters are related to the mirroring infrastructure
+ defined in :PEP:`381`. *mirrors_url* gives a URL to look on for DNS
+ records giving mirror adresses; *mirrors* is a list of mirror URLs (see
+ the PEP). If both *mirrors* and *mirrors_url* are given, *mirrors_url*
+ will only be used if *mirrors* is set to ``None``. *timeout* is the time
+ (in seconds) to wait before considering a URL has timed out;
+ *mirrors_max_tries"* is the number of times to try requesting informations
+ on mirrors before switching.
+
+ The following methods are defined:
+
+ .. method:: get_distributions(project_name, version)
+
+ Return the distributions found in the index for the given release.
+
+ .. method:: get_metadata(project_name, version)
+
+ Return the metadata found on the index for this project name and
+ version. Currently downloads and unpacks a distribution to read the
+ PKG-INFO file.
+
+ .. method:: get_release(requirements, prefer_final=None)
+
+ Return one release that fulfills the given requirements.
+
+ .. method:: get_releases(requirements, prefer_final=None, force_update=False)
+
+ Search for releases and return a
+ :class:`~packaging.pypi.dist.ReleasesList` object containing the
+ results.
+
+ .. method:: search_projects(name=None)
+
+ Search the index for projects containing the given name and return a
+ list of matching names.
+
+ See also the base class :class:`packaging.pypi.base.BaseClient` for inherited
+ methods.
+
+
+.. data:: DEFAULT_SIMPLE_INDEX_URL
+
+ The address used by default by the crawler class. It is currently
+ ``'http://a.pypi.python.org/simple/'``, the main PyPI installation.
+
+
+
+
+Usage Examples
+---------------
+
+To help you understand how using the `Crawler` class, here are some basic
+usages.
+
+Request the simple index to get a specific distribution
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+Supposing you want to scan an index to get a list of distributions for
+the "foobar" project. You can use the "get_releases" method for that.
+The get_releases method will browse the project page, and return
+:class:`ReleaseInfo` objects for each found link that rely on downloads. ::
+
+ >>> from packaging.pypi.simple import Crawler
+ >>> crawler = Crawler()
+ >>> crawler.get_releases("FooBar")
+ [<ReleaseInfo "Foobar 1.1">, <ReleaseInfo "Foobar 1.2">]
+
+
+Note that you also can request the client about specific versions, using version
+specifiers (described in `PEP 345
+<http://www.python.org/dev/peps/pep-0345/#version-specifiers>`_)::
+
+ >>> client.get_releases("FooBar < 1.2")
+ [<ReleaseInfo "FooBar 1.1">, ]
+
+
+`get_releases` returns a list of :class:`ReleaseInfo`, but you also can get the
+best distribution that fullfil your requirements, using "get_release"::
+
+ >>> client.get_release("FooBar < 1.2")
+ <ReleaseInfo "FooBar 1.1">
+
+
+Download distributions
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+As it can get the urls of distributions provided by PyPI, the `Crawler`
+client also can download the distributions and put it for you in a temporary
+destination::
+
+ >>> client.download("foobar")
+ /tmp/temp_dir/foobar-1.2.tar.gz
+
+
+You also can specify the directory you want to download to::
+
+ >>> client.download("foobar", "/path/to/my/dir")
+ /path/to/my/dir/foobar-1.2.tar.gz
+
+
+While downloading, the md5 of the archive will be checked, if not matches, it
+will try another time, then if fails again, raise `MD5HashDoesNotMatchError`.
+
+Internally, that's not the Crawler which download the distributions, but the
+`DistributionInfo` class. Please refer to this documentation for more details.
+
+
+Following PyPI external links
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+The default behavior for packaging is to *not* follow the links provided
+by HTML pages in the "simple index", to find distributions related
+downloads.
+
+It's possible to tell the PyPIClient to follow external links by setting the
+`follow_externals` attribute, on instantiation or after::
+
+ >>> client = Crawler(follow_externals=True)
+
+or ::
+
+ >>> client = Crawler()
+ >>> client.follow_externals = True
+
+
+Working with external indexes, and mirrors
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+The default `Crawler` behavior is to rely on the Python Package index stored
+on PyPI (http://pypi.python.org/simple).
+
+As you can need to work with a local index, or private indexes, you can specify
+it using the index_url parameter::
+
+ >>> client = Crawler(index_url="file://filesystem/path/")
+
+or ::
+
+ >>> client = Crawler(index_url="http://some.specific.url/")
+
+
+You also can specify mirrors to fallback on in case the first index_url you
+provided doesnt respond, or not correctly. The default behavior for
+`Crawler` is to use the list provided by Python.org DNS records, as
+described in the :PEP:`381` about mirroring infrastructure.
+
+If you don't want to rely on these, you could specify the list of mirrors you
+want to try by specifying the `mirrors` attribute. It's a simple iterable::
+
+ >>> mirrors = ["http://first.mirror","http://second.mirror"]
+ >>> client = Crawler(mirrors=mirrors)
+
+
+Searching in the simple index
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+It's possible to search for projects with specific names in the package index.
+Assuming you want to find all projects containing the "distutils" keyword::
+
+ >>> c.search_projects("distutils")
+ [<Project "collective.recipe.distutils">, <Project "Distutils">, <Project
+ "Packaging">, <Project "distutilscross">, <Project "lpdistutils">, <Project
+ "taras.recipe.distutils">, <Project "zerokspot.recipe.distutils">]
+
+
+You can also search the projects starting with a specific text, or ending with
+that text, using a wildcard::
+
+ >>> c.search_projects("distutils*")
+ [<Project "Distutils">, <Project "Packaging">, <Project "distutilscross">]
+
+ >>> c.search_projects("*distutils")
+ [<Project "collective.recipe.distutils">, <Project "Distutils">, <Project
+ "lpdistutils">, <Project "taras.recipe.distutils">, <Project
+ "zerokspot.recipe.distutils">]
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.xmlrpc.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.xmlrpc.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5242e4c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.pypi.xmlrpc.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,143 @@
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.xmlrpc` --- Crawler using the PyPI XML-RPC interface
+=========================================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.pypi.xmlrpc
+ :synopsis: Client using XML-RPC requests to fetch info and distributions.
+
+
+Indexes can be queried using XML-RPC calls, and Packaging provides a simple
+way to interface with XML-RPC.
+
+You should **use** XML-RPC when:
+
+* Searching the index for projects **on other fields than project
+ names**. For instance, you can search for projects based on the
+ author_email field.
+* Searching all the versions that have existed for a project.
+* you want to retrieve METADATAs information from releases or
+ distributions.
+
+
+You should **avoid using** XML-RPC method calls when:
+
+* Retrieving the last version of a project
+* Getting the projects with a specific name and version.
+* The simple index can match your needs
+
+
+When dealing with indexes, keep in mind that the index queries will always
+return you :class:`packaging.pypi.dist.ReleaseInfo` and
+:class:`packaging.pypi.dist.ReleasesList` objects.
+
+Some methods here share common APIs with the one you can find on
+:class:`packaging.pypi.simple`, internally, :class:`packaging.pypi.client`
+is inherited by :class:`Client`
+
+
+API
+---
+
+.. class:: Client
+
+
+Usage examples
+--------------
+
+Use case described here are use case that are not common to the other clients.
+If you want to see all the methods, please refer to API or to usage examples
+described in :class:`packaging.pypi.client.Client`
+
+
+Finding releases
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+It's a common use case to search for "things" within the index. We can
+basically search for projects by their name, which is the most used way for
+users (eg. "give me the last version of the FooBar project").
+
+This can be accomplished using the following syntax::
+
+ >>> client = xmlrpc.Client()
+ >>> client.get_release("Foobar (<= 1.3))
+ <FooBar 1.2.1>
+ >>> client.get_releases("FooBar (<= 1.3)")
+ [FooBar 1.1, FooBar 1.1.1, FooBar 1.2, FooBar 1.2.1]
+
+
+And we also can find for specific fields::
+
+ >>> client.search_projects(field=value)
+
+
+You could specify the operator to use, default is "or"::
+
+ >>> client.search_projects(field=value, operator="and")
+
+
+The specific fields you can search are:
+
+* name
+* version
+* author
+* author_email
+* maintainer
+* maintainer_email
+* home_page
+* license
+* summary
+* description
+* keywords
+* platform
+* download_url
+
+
+Getting metadata information
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+XML-RPC is a preferred way to retrieve metadata information from indexes.
+It's really simple to do so::
+
+ >>> client = xmlrpc.Client()
+ >>> client.get_metadata("FooBar", "1.1")
+ <ReleaseInfo FooBar 1.1>
+
+
+Assuming we already have a :class:`packaging.pypi.ReleaseInfo` object defined,
+it's possible to pass it to the xmlrpc client to retrieve and complete its
+metadata::
+
+ >>> foobar11 = ReleaseInfo("FooBar", "1.1")
+ >>> client = xmlrpc.Client()
+ >>> returned_release = client.get_metadata(release=foobar11)
+ >>> returned_release
+ <ReleaseInfo FooBar 1.1>
+
+
+Get all the releases of a project
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+To retrieve all the releases for a project, you can build them using
+`get_releases`::
+
+ >>> client = xmlrpc.Client()
+ >>> client.get_releases("FooBar")
+ [<ReleaseInfo FooBar 0.9>, <ReleaseInfo FooBar 1.0>, <ReleaseInfo 1.1>]
+
+
+Get information about distributions
+^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+
+Indexes have information about projects, releases **and** distributions.
+If you're not familiar with those, please refer to the documentation of
+:mod:`packaging.pypi.dist`.
+
+It's possible to retrieve information about distributions, e.g "what are the
+existing distributions for this release ? How to retrieve them ?"::
+
+ >>> client = xmlrpc.Client()
+ >>> release = client.get_distributions("FooBar", "1.1")
+ >>> release.dists
+ {'sdist': <FooBar 1.1 sdist>, 'bdist': <FooBar 1.1 bdist>}
+
+As you see, this does not return a list of distributions, but a release,
+because a release can be used like a list of distributions.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c6bff47
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+:mod:`packaging` --- Packaging support
+======================================
+
+.. module:: packaging
+ :synopsis: Packaging system and building blocks for other packaging systems.
+.. sectionauthor:: Fred L. Drake, Jr. <fdrake@acm.org>, distutils and packaging
+ contributors
+
+
+The :mod:`packaging` package provides support for building, packaging,
+distributing and installing additional projects into a Python installation.
+Projects may include Python modules, extension modules, packages and scripts.
+:mod:`packaging` also provides building blocks for other packaging systems
+that are not tied to the command system.
+
+This manual is the reference documentation for those standalone building
+blocks and for extending Packaging. If you're looking for the user-centric
+guides to install a project or package your own code, head to `See also`__.
+
+
+Building blocks
+---------------
+
+.. toctree::
+ :maxdepth: 2
+
+ packaging-misc
+ packaging.version
+ packaging.metadata
+ packaging.database
+ packaging.depgraph
+ packaging.pypi
+ packaging.pypi.dist
+ packaging.pypi.simple
+ packaging.pypi.xmlrpc
+ packaging.install
+
+
+The command machinery
+---------------------
+
+.. toctree::
+ :maxdepth: 2
+
+ packaging.dist
+ packaging.command
+ packaging.compiler
+ packaging.fancy_getopt
+
+
+Other utilities
+----------------
+
+.. toctree::
+ :maxdepth: 2
+
+ packaging.util
+ packaging.tests.pypi_server
+
+.. XXX missing: compat config create (dir_util) run pypi.{base,mirrors}
+
+
+.. __:
+
+.. seealso::
+
+ :ref:`packaging-index`
+ The manual for developers of Python projects who want to package and
+ distribute them. This describes how to use :mod:`packaging` to make
+ projects easily found and added to an existing Python installation.
+
+ :ref:`packaging-install-index`
+ A user-centered manual which includes information on adding projects
+ into an existing Python installation. You do not need to be a Python
+ programmer to read this manual.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.tests.pypi_server.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.tests.pypi_server.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f3b7720
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.tests.pypi_server.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,105 @@
+:mod:`packaging.tests.pypi_server` --- PyPI mock server
+=======================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.tests.pypi_server
+ :synopsis: Mock server used to test PyPI-related modules and commands.
+
+
+When you are testing code that works with Packaging, you might find these tools
+useful.
+
+
+The mock server
+---------------
+
+.. class:: PyPIServer
+
+ PyPIServer is a class that implements an HTTP server running in a separate
+ thread. All it does is record the requests for further inspection. The recorded
+ data is available under ``requests`` attribute. The default
+ HTTP response can be overridden with the ``default_response_status``,
+ ``default_response_headers`` and ``default_response_data`` attributes.
+
+ By default, when accessing the server with urls beginning with `/simple/`,
+ the server also record your requests, but will look for files under
+ the `/tests/pypiserver/simple/` path.
+
+ You can tell the sever to serve static files for other paths. This could be
+ accomplished by using the `static_uri_paths` parameter, as below::
+
+ server = PyPIServer(static_uri_paths=["first_path", "second_path"])
+
+
+ You need to create the content that will be served under the
+ `/tests/pypiserver/default` path. If you want to serve content from another
+ place, you also can specify another filesystem path (which needs to be under
+ `tests/pypiserver/`. This will replace the default behavior of the server, and
+ it will not serve content from the `default` dir ::
+
+ server = PyPIServer(static_filesystem_paths=["path/to/your/dir"])
+
+
+ If you just need to add some paths to the existing ones, you can do as shown,
+ keeping in mind that the server will always try to load paths in reverse order
+ (e.g here, try "another/super/path" then the default one) ::
+
+ server = PyPIServer(test_static_path="another/super/path")
+ server = PyPIServer("another/super/path")
+ # or
+ server.static_filesystem_paths.append("another/super/path")
+
+
+ As a result of what, in your tests, while you need to use the PyPIServer, in
+ order to isolates the test cases, the best practice is to place the common files
+ in the `default` folder, and to create a directory for each specific test case::
+
+ server = PyPIServer(static_filesystem_paths = ["default", "test_pypi_server"],
+ static_uri_paths=["simple", "external"])
+
+
+Base class and decorator for tests
+----------------------------------
+
+.. class:: PyPIServerTestCase
+
+ ``PyPIServerTestCase`` is a test case class with setUp and tearDown methods that
+ take care of a single PyPIServer instance attached as a ``pypi`` attribute on
+ the test class. Use it as one of the base classes in your test case::
+
+
+ class UploadTestCase(PyPIServerTestCase):
+
+ def test_something(self):
+ cmd = self.prepare_command()
+ cmd.ensure_finalized()
+ cmd.repository = self.pypi.full_address
+ cmd.run()
+
+ environ, request_data = self.pypi.requests[-1]
+ self.assertEqual(request_data, EXPECTED_REQUEST_DATA)
+
+
+.. decorator:: use_pypi_server
+
+ You also can use a decorator for your tests, if you do not need the same server
+ instance along all you test case. So, you can specify, for each test method,
+ some initialisation parameters for the server.
+
+ For this, you need to add a `server` parameter to your method, like this::
+
+ class SampleTestCase(TestCase):
+
+ @use_pypi_server()
+ def test_something(self, server):
+ ...
+
+
+ The decorator will instantiate the server for you, and run and stop it just
+ before and after your method call. You also can pass the server initializer,
+ just like this::
+
+ class SampleTestCase(TestCase):
+
+ @use_pypi_server("test_case_name")
+ def test_something(self, server):
+ ...
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.util.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.util.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e628c32
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.util.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,155 @@
+:mod:`packaging.util` --- Miscellaneous utility functions
+=========================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.util
+ :synopsis: Miscellaneous utility functions.
+
+
+This module contains various helpers for the other modules.
+
+.. XXX a number of functions are missing, but the module may be split first
+ (it's ginormous right now, some things could go to compat for example)
+
+.. function:: get_platform()
+
+ Return a string that identifies the current platform. This is used mainly to
+ distinguish platform-specific build directories and platform-specific built
+ distributions. Typically includes the OS name and version and the
+ architecture (as supplied by 'os.uname()'), although the exact information
+ included depends on the OS; e.g. for IRIX the architecture isn't particularly
+ important (IRIX only runs on SGI hardware), but for Linux the kernel version
+ isn't particularly important.
+
+ Examples of returned values:
+
+ * ``linux-i586``
+ * ``linux-alpha``
+ * ``solaris-2.6-sun4u``
+ * ``irix-5.3``
+ * ``irix64-6.2``
+
+ For non-POSIX platforms, currently just returns ``sys.platform``.
+
+ For Mac OS X systems the OS version reflects the minimal version on which
+ binaries will run (that is, the value of ``MACOSX_DEPLOYMENT_TARGET``
+ during the build of Python), not the OS version of the current system.
+
+ For universal binary builds on Mac OS X the architecture value reflects
+ the univeral binary status instead of the architecture of the current
+ processor. For 32-bit universal binaries the architecture is ``fat``,
+ for 64-bit universal binaries the architecture is ``fat64``, and
+ for 4-way universal binaries the architecture is ``universal``. Starting
+ from Python 2.7 and Python 3.2 the architecture ``fat3`` is used for
+ a 3-way universal build (ppc, i386, x86_64) and ``intel`` is used for
+ a univeral build with the i386 and x86_64 architectures
+
+ Examples of returned values on Mac OS X:
+
+ * ``macosx-10.3-ppc``
+
+ * ``macosx-10.3-fat``
+
+ * ``macosx-10.5-universal``
+
+ * ``macosx-10.6-intel``
+
+ .. XXX reinvention of platform module?
+
+
+.. function:: convert_path(pathname)
+
+ Return 'pathname' as a name that will work on the native filesystem, i.e.
+ split it on '/' and put it back together again using the current directory
+ separator. Needed because filenames in the setup script are always supplied
+ in Unix style, and have to be converted to the local convention before we
+ can actually use them in the filesystem. Raises :exc:`ValueError` on
+ non-Unix-ish systems if *pathname* either starts or ends with a slash.
+
+
+.. function:: change_root(new_root, pathname)
+
+ Return *pathname* with *new_root* prepended. If *pathname* is relative, this
+ is equivalent to ``os.path.join(new_root,pathname)`` Otherwise, it requires
+ making *pathname* relative and then joining the two, which is tricky on
+ DOS/Windows.
+
+
+.. function:: check_environ()
+
+ Ensure that 'os.environ' has all the environment variables we guarantee that
+ users can use in config files, command-line options, etc. Currently this
+ includes:
+
+ * :envvar:`HOME` - user's home directory (Unix only)
+ * :envvar:`PLAT` - description of the current platform, including hardware
+ and OS (see :func:`get_platform`)
+
+
+.. function:: find_executable(executable, path=None)
+
+ Search the path for a given executable name.
+
+
+.. function:: execute(func, args, msg=None, dry_run=False)
+
+ Perform some action that affects the outside world (for instance, writing to
+ the filesystem). Such actions are special because they are disabled by the
+ *dry_run* flag. This method takes care of all that bureaucracy for you;
+ all you have to do is supply the function to call and an argument tuple for
+ it (to embody the "external action" being performed), and an optional message
+ to print.
+
+
+.. function:: newer(source, target)
+
+ Return true if *source* exists and is more recently modified than *target*,
+ or if *source* exists and *target* doesn't. Return false if both exist and
+ *target* is the same age or newer than *source*. Raise
+ :exc:`PackagingFileError` if *source* does not exist.
+
+
+.. function:: strtobool(val)
+
+ Convert a string representation of truth to true (1) or false (0).
+
+ True values are ``y``, ``yes``, ``t``, ``true``, ``on`` and ``1``; false
+ values are ``n``, ``no``, ``f``, ``false``, ``off`` and ``0``. Raises
+ :exc:`ValueError` if *val* is anything else.
+
+
+.. function:: byte_compile(py_files, optimize=0, force=0, prefix=None, \
+ base_dir=None, dry_run=0, direct=None)
+
+ Byte-compile a collection of Python source files to either :file:`.pyc` or
+ :file:`.pyo` files in a :file:`__pycache__` subdirectory (see :pep:`3147`),
+ or to the same directory when using the distutils2 backport on Python
+ versions older than 3.2.
+
+ *py_files* is a list of files to compile; any files that don't end in
+ :file:`.py` are silently skipped. *optimize* must be one of the following:
+
+ * ``0`` - don't optimize (generate :file:`.pyc`)
+ * ``1`` - normal optimization (like ``python -O``)
+ * ``2`` - extra optimization (like ``python -OO``)
+
+ This function is independent from the running Python's :option:`-O` or
+ :option:`-B` options; it is fully controlled by the parameters passed in.
+
+ If *force* is true, all files are recompiled regardless of timestamps.
+
+ The source filename encoded in each :term:`bytecode` file defaults to the filenames
+ listed in *py_files*; you can modify these with *prefix* and *basedir*.
+ *prefix* is a string that will be stripped off of each source filename, and
+ *base_dir* is a directory name that will be prepended (after *prefix* is
+ stripped). You can supply either or both (or neither) of *prefix* and
+ *base_dir*, as you wish.
+
+ If *dry_run* is true, doesn't actually do anything that would affect the
+ filesystem.
+
+ Byte-compilation is either done directly in this interpreter process with the
+ standard :mod:`py_compile` module, or indirectly by writing a temporary
+ script and executing it. Normally, you should let :func:`byte_compile`
+ figure out to use direct compilation or not (see the source for details).
+ The *direct* flag is used by the script generated in indirect mode; unless
+ you know what you're doing, leave it set to ``None``.
diff --git a/Doc/library/packaging.version.rst b/Doc/library/packaging.version.rst
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f36cdab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/library/packaging.version.rst
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+:mod:`packaging.version` --- Version number classes
+===================================================
+
+.. module:: packaging.version
+ :synopsis: Classes that represent project version numbers.
+
+
+This module contains classes and functions useful to deal with version numbers.
+It's an implementation of version specifiers `as defined in PEP 345
+<http://www.python.org/dev/peps/pep-0345/#version-specifiers>`_.
+
+
+Version numbers
+---------------
+
+.. class:: NormalizedVersion(self, s, error_on_huge_major_num=True)
+
+ A specific version of a distribution, as described in PEP 345. *s* is a
+ string object containing the version number (for example ``'1.2b1'``),
+ *error_on_huge_major_num* a boolean specifying whether to consider an
+ apparent use of a year or full date as the major version number an error.
+
+ The rationale for the second argument is that there were projects using years
+ or full dates as version numbers, which could cause problems with some
+ packaging systems sorting.
+
+ Instances of this class can be compared and sorted::
+
+ >>> NormalizedVersion('1.2b1') < NormalizedVersion('1.2')
+ True
+
+ :class:`NormalizedVersion` is used internally by :class:`VersionPredicate` to
+ do its work.
+
+
+.. class:: IrrationalVersionError
+
+ Exception raised when an invalid string is given to
+ :class:`NormalizedVersion`.
+
+ >>> NormalizedVersion("irrational_version_number")
+ ...
+ IrrationalVersionError: irrational_version_number
+
+
+.. function:: suggest_normalized_version(s)
+
+ Before standardization in PEP 386, various schemes were in use. Packaging
+ provides a function to try to convert any string to a valid, normalized
+ version::
+
+ >>> suggest_normalized_version('2.1-rc1')
+ 2.1c1
+
+
+ If :func:`suggest_normalized_version` can't make sense of the given string,
+ it will return ``None``::
+
+ >>> print(suggest_normalized_version('not a version'))
+ None
+
+
+Version predicates
+------------------
+
+.. class:: VersionPredicate(predicate)
+
+ This class deals with the parsing of field values like
+ ``ProjectName (>=version)``.
+
+ .. method:: match(version)
+
+ Test if a version number matches the predicate:
+
+ >>> version = VersionPredicate("ProjectName (<1.2, >1.0)")
+ >>> version.match("1.2.1")
+ False
+ >>> version.match("1.1.1")
+ True
+
+
+Validation helpers
+------------------
+
+If you want to use :term:`LBYL`-style checks instead of instantiating the
+classes and catching :class:`IrrationalVersionError` and :class:`ValueError`,
+you can use these functions:
+
+.. function:: is_valid_version(predicate)
+
+ Check whether the given string is a valid version number. Example of valid
+ strings: ``'1.2'``, ``'4.2.0.dev4'``, ``'2.5.4.post2'``.
+
+
+.. function:: is_valid_versions(predicate)
+
+ Check whether the given string is a valid value for specifying multiple
+ versions, such as in the Requires-Python field. Example: ``'2.7, >=3.2'``.
+
+
+.. function:: is_valid_predicate(predicate)
+
+ Check whether the given string is a valid version predicate. Examples:
+ ``'some.project == 4.5, <= 4.7'``, ``'speciallib (> 1.0, != 1.4.2, < 2.0)'``.
diff --git a/Doc/library/platform.rst b/Doc/library/platform.rst
index 85eca9a..938c270 100644
--- a/Doc/library/platform.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/platform.rst
@@ -214,6 +214,10 @@ Win95/98 specific
preferring :func:`win32pipe.popen`. On Windows NT, :func:`win32pipe.popen`
should work; on Windows 9x it hangs due to bugs in the MS C library.
+ .. deprecated:: 3.3
+ This function is obsolete. Use the :mod:`subprocess` module. Check
+ especially the :ref:`subprocess-replacements` section.
+
Mac OS Platform
---------------
diff --git a/Doc/library/python.rst b/Doc/library/python.rst
index b67fbfc..07eadb4 100644
--- a/Doc/library/python.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/python.rst
@@ -25,4 +25,5 @@ overview:
inspect.rst
site.rst
fpectl.rst
+ packaging.rst
distutils.rst
diff --git a/Doc/library/random.rst b/Doc/library/random.rst
index 31cb945..2b10e6e 100644
--- a/Doc/library/random.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/random.rst
@@ -43,6 +43,12 @@ The :mod:`random` module also provides the :class:`SystemRandom` class which
uses the system function :func:`os.urandom` to generate random numbers
from sources provided by the operating system.
+.. warning::
+
+ The generators of the :mod:`random` module should not be used for security
+ purposes. Use :func:`ssl.RAND_bytes` if you require a cryptographically
+ secure pseudorandom number generator.
+
Bookkeeping functions:
diff --git a/Doc/library/re.rst b/Doc/library/re.rst
index b196a28..d3d97c0 100644
--- a/Doc/library/re.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/re.rst
@@ -699,9 +699,12 @@ form.
.. function:: escape(string)
- Return *string* with all non-alphanumerics backslashed; this is useful if you
- want to match an arbitrary literal string that may have regular expression
- metacharacters in it.
+ Escape all the characters in pattern except ASCII letters, numbers and ``'_'``.
+ This is useful if you want to match an arbitrary literal string that may
+ have regular expression metacharacters in it.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The ``'_'`` character is no longer escaped.
.. function:: purge()
diff --git a/Doc/library/readline.rst b/Doc/library/readline.rst
index ab55197..1134619 100644
--- a/Doc/library/readline.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/readline.rst
@@ -199,7 +199,7 @@ normally be executed automatically during interactive sessions from the user's
histfile = os.path.join(os.path.expanduser("~"), ".pyhist")
try:
readline.read_history_file(histfile)
- except IOError:
+ except FileNotFoundError:
pass
import atexit
atexit.register(readline.write_history_file, histfile)
@@ -224,7 +224,7 @@ support history save/restore. ::
if hasattr(readline, "read_history_file"):
try:
readline.read_history_file(histfile)
- except IOError:
+ except FileNotFoundError:
pass
atexit.register(self.save_history, histfile)
diff --git a/Doc/library/resource.rst b/Doc/library/resource.rst
index c16b013..03a7cb5 100644
--- a/Doc/library/resource.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/resource.rst
@@ -14,13 +14,15 @@ resources utilized by a program.
Symbolic constants are used to specify particular system resources and to
request usage information about either the current process or its children.
-A single exception is defined for errors:
+An :exc:`OSError` is raised on syscall failure.
.. exception:: error
- The functions described below may raise this error if the underlying system call
- failures unexpectedly.
+ A deprecated alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Following :pep:`3151`, this class was made an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
Resource Limits
diff --git a/Doc/library/sched.rst b/Doc/library/sched.rst
index 000dba0..957bdd3 100644
--- a/Doc/library/sched.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/sched.rst
@@ -14,7 +14,7 @@
The :mod:`sched` module defines a class which implements a general purpose event
scheduler:
-.. class:: scheduler(timefunc, delayfunc)
+.. class:: scheduler(timefunc=time.time, delayfunc=time.sleep)
The :class:`scheduler` class defines a generic interface to scheduling events.
It needs two functions to actually deal with the "outside world" --- *timefunc*
@@ -25,6 +25,12 @@ scheduler:
event is run to allow other threads an opportunity to run in multi-threaded
applications.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timefunc* and *delayfunc* parameters are optional.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :class:`scheduler` class can be safely used in multi-threaded
+ environments.
+
Example::
>>> import sched, time
@@ -44,33 +50,6 @@ Example::
From print_time 930343700.273
930343700.276
-In multi-threaded environments, the :class:`scheduler` class has limitations
-with respect to thread-safety, inability to insert a new task before
-the one currently pending in a running scheduler, and holding up the main
-thread until the event queue is empty. Instead, the preferred approach
-is to use the :class:`threading.Timer` class instead.
-
-Example::
-
- >>> import time
- >>> from threading import Timer
- >>> def print_time():
- ... print("From print_time", time.time())
- ...
- >>> def print_some_times():
- ... print(time.time())
- ... Timer(5, print_time, ()).start()
- ... Timer(10, print_time, ()).start()
- ... time.sleep(11) # sleep while time-delay events execute
- ... print(time.time())
- ...
- >>> print_some_times()
- 930343690.257
- From print_time 930343695.274
- From print_time 930343700.273
- 930343701.301
-
-
.. _scheduler-objects:
Scheduler Objects
@@ -79,26 +58,38 @@ Scheduler Objects
:class:`scheduler` instances have the following methods and attributes:
-.. method:: scheduler.enterabs(time, priority, action, argument)
+.. method:: scheduler.enterabs(time, priority, action, argument=[], kwargs={})
Schedule a new event. The *time* argument should be a numeric type compatible
with the return value of the *timefunc* function passed to the constructor.
Events scheduled for the same *time* will be executed in the order of their
*priority*.
- Executing the event means executing ``action(*argument)``. *argument* must be a
- sequence holding the parameters for *action*.
+ Executing the event means executing ``action(*argument, **kwargs)``.
+ *argument* must be a sequence holding the parameters for *action*.
+ *kwargs* must be a dictionary holding the keyword parameters for *action*.
Return value is an event which may be used for later cancellation of the event
(see :meth:`cancel`).
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *argument* parameter is optional.
-.. method:: scheduler.enter(delay, priority, action, argument)
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ *kwargs* parameter was added.
+
+
+.. method:: scheduler.enter(delay, priority, action, argument=[], kwargs={})
Schedule an event for *delay* more time units. Other than the relative time, the
other arguments, the effect and the return value are the same as those for
:meth:`enterabs`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *argument* parameter is optional.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ *kwargs* parameter was added.
.. method:: scheduler.cancel(event)
@@ -111,12 +102,15 @@ Scheduler Objects
Return true if the event queue is empty.
-.. method:: scheduler.run()
+.. method:: scheduler.run(blocking=True)
- Run all scheduled events. This function will wait (using the :func:`delayfunc`
+ Run all scheduled events. This method will wait (using the :func:`delayfunc`
function passed to the constructor) for the next event, then execute it and so
on until there are no more scheduled events.
+ If *blocking* is False executes the scheduled events due to expire soonest
+ (if any) and then return.
+
Either *action* or *delayfunc* can raise an exception. In either case, the
scheduler will maintain a consistent state and propagate the exception. If an
exception is raised by *action*, the event will not be attempted in future calls
@@ -127,6 +121,9 @@ Scheduler Objects
the calling code is responsible for canceling events which are no longer
pertinent.
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ *blocking* parameter was added.
+
.. attribute:: scheduler.queue
Read-only attribute returning a list of upcoming events in the order they
diff --git a/Doc/library/select.rst b/Doc/library/select.rst
index f1fd126..d9d802b 100644
--- a/Doc/library/select.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/select.rst
@@ -6,7 +6,8 @@
This module provides access to the :c:func:`select` and :c:func:`poll` functions
-available in most operating systems, :c:func:`epoll` available on Linux 2.5+ and
+available in most operating systems, :c:func:`devpoll` available on
+Solaris and derivatives, :c:func:`epoll` available on Linux 2.5+ and
:c:func:`kqueue` available on most BSD.
Note that on Windows, it only works for sockets; on other operating systems,
it also works for other file types (in particular, on Unix, it works on pipes).
@@ -18,17 +19,39 @@ The module defines the following:
.. exception:: error
- The exception raised when an error occurs. The accompanying value is a pair
- containing the numeric error code from :c:data:`errno` and the corresponding
- string, as would be printed by the C function :c:func:`perror`.
+ A deprecated alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Following :pep:`3151`, this class was made an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
-.. function:: epoll(sizehint=-1)
- (Only supported on Linux 2.5.44 and newer.) Returns an edge polling object,
- which can be used as Edge or Level Triggered interface for I/O events; see
- section :ref:`epoll-objects` below for the methods supported by epolling
- objects.
+.. function:: devpoll()
+
+ (Only supported on Solaris and derivatives.) Returns a ``/dev/poll``
+ polling object; see section :ref:`devpoll-objects` below for the
+ methods supported by devpoll objects.
+
+ :c:func:`devpoll` objects are linked to the number of file
+ descriptors allowed at the time of instantiation. If your program
+ reduces this value, :c:func:`devpoll` will fail. If your program
+ increases this value, :c:func:`devpoll` may return an
+ incomplete list of active file descriptors.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. function:: epoll(sizehint=-1, flags=0)
+
+ (Only supported on Linux 2.5.44 and newer.) Return an edge polling object,
+ which can be used as Edge or Level Triggered interface for I/O
+ events. *sizehint* is deprecated and completely ignored. *flags* can be set
+ to :const:`EPOLL_CLOEXEC`, which causes the epoll descriptor to be closed
+ automatically when :func:`os.execve` is called. See section
+ :ref:`epoll-objects` below for the methods supported by epolling objects.
+
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+
+ Added the *flags* parameter.
.. function:: poll()
@@ -106,6 +129,74 @@ The module defines the following:
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+.. _devpoll-objects:
+
+``/dev/poll`` Polling Objects
+----------------------------------------------
+
+ http://developers.sun.com/solaris/articles/using_devpoll.html
+ http://developers.sun.com/solaris/articles/polling_efficient.html
+
+Solaris and derivatives have ``/dev/poll``. While :c:func:`select` is
+O(highest file descriptor) and :c:func:`poll` is O(number of file
+descriptors), ``/dev/poll`` is O(active file descriptors).
+
+``/dev/poll`` behaviour is very close to the standard :c:func:`poll`
+object.
+
+
+.. method:: devpoll.register(fd[, eventmask])
+
+ Register a file descriptor with the polling object. Future calls to the
+ :meth:`poll` method will then check whether the file descriptor has any pending
+ I/O events. *fd* can be either an integer, or an object with a :meth:`fileno`
+ method that returns an integer. File objects implement :meth:`fileno`, so they
+ can also be used as the argument.
+
+ *eventmask* is an optional bitmask describing the type of events you want to
+ check for. The constants are the same that with :c:func:`poll`
+ object. The default value is a combination of the constants :const:`POLLIN`,
+ :const:`POLLPRI`, and :const:`POLLOUT`.
+
+ .. warning::
+
+ Registering a file descriptor that's already registered is not an
+ error, but the result is undefined. The appropiate action is to
+ unregister or modify it first. This is an important difference
+ compared with :c:func:`poll`.
+
+
+.. method:: devpoll.modify(fd[, eventmask])
+
+ This method does an :meth:`unregister` followed by a
+ :meth:`register`. It is (a bit) more efficient that doing the same
+ explicitly.
+
+
+.. method:: devpoll.unregister(fd)
+
+ Remove a file descriptor being tracked by a polling object. Just like the
+ :meth:`register` method, *fd* can be an integer or an object with a
+ :meth:`fileno` method that returns an integer.
+
+ Attempting to remove a file descriptor that was never registered is
+ safely ignored.
+
+
+.. method:: devpoll.poll([timeout])
+
+ Polls the set of registered file descriptors, and returns a possibly-empty list
+ containing ``(fd, event)`` 2-tuples for the descriptors that have events or
+ errors to report. *fd* is the file descriptor, and *event* is a bitmask with
+ bits set for the reported events for that descriptor --- :const:`POLLIN` for
+ waiting input, :const:`POLLOUT` to indicate that the descriptor can be written
+ to, and so forth. An empty list indicates that the call timed out and no file
+ descriptors had any events to report. If *timeout* is given, it specifies the
+ length of time in milliseconds which the system will wait for events before
+ returning. If *timeout* is omitted, -1, or :const:`None`, the call will
+ block until there is an event for this poll object.
+
+
.. _epoll-objects:
Edge and Level Trigger Polling (epoll) Objects
@@ -165,11 +256,6 @@ Edge and Level Trigger Polling (epoll) Objects
Register a fd descriptor with the epoll object.
- .. note::
-
- Registering a file descriptor that's already registered raises an
- IOError -- contrary to :ref:`poll-objects`'s register.
-
.. method:: epoll.modify(fd, eventmask)
diff --git a/Doc/library/shlex.rst b/Doc/library/shlex.rst
index 0113fb7..908f996 100644
--- a/Doc/library/shlex.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/shlex.rst
@@ -34,6 +34,39 @@ The :mod:`shlex` module defines the following functions:
passing ``None`` for *s* will read the string to split from standard
input.
+
+.. function:: quote(s)
+
+ Return a shell-escaped version of the string *s*. The returned value is a
+ string that can safely be used as one token in a shell command line, for
+ cases where you cannot use a list.
+
+ This idiom would be unsafe::
+
+ >>> filename = 'somefile; rm -rf ~'
+ >>> command = 'ls -l {}'.format(filename)
+ >>> print(command) # executed by a shell: boom!
+ ls -l somefile; rm -rf ~
+
+ :func:`quote` lets you plug the security hole::
+
+ >>> command = 'ls -l {}'.format(quote(filename))
+ >>> print(command)
+ ls -l 'somefile; rm -rf ~'
+ >>> remote_command = 'ssh home {}'.format(quote(command))
+ >>> print(remote_command)
+ ssh home 'ls -l '"'"'somefile; rm -rf ~'"'"''
+
+ The quoting is compatible with UNIX shells and with :func:`split`:
+
+ >>> remote_command = split(remote_command)
+ >>> remote_command
+ ['ssh', 'home', "ls -l 'somefile; rm -rf ~'"]
+ >>> command = split(remote_command[-1])
+ >>> command
+ ['ls', '-l', 'somefile; rm -rf ~']
+
+
The :mod:`shlex` module defines the following class:
@@ -282,5 +315,4 @@ parsing rules.
* EOF is signaled with a :const:`None` value;
-* Quoted empty strings (``''``) are allowed;
-
+* Quoted empty strings (``''``) are allowed.
diff --git a/Doc/library/shutil.rst b/Doc/library/shutil.rst
index 3b44774..bae7db8 100644
--- a/Doc/library/shutil.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/shutil.rst
@@ -47,45 +47,67 @@ Directory and files operations
be copied.
-.. function:: copyfile(src, dst)
+.. function:: copyfile(src, dst[, symlinks=False])
Copy the contents (no metadata) of the file named *src* to a file named *dst*.
*dst* must be the complete target file name; look at :func:`copy` for a copy that
accepts a target directory path. If *src* and *dst* are the same files,
:exc:`Error` is raised.
- The destination location must be writable; otherwise, an :exc:`IOError` exception
+ The destination location must be writable; otherwise, an :exc:`OSError` exception
will be raised. If *dst* already exists, it will be replaced. Special files
such as character or block devices and pipes cannot be copied with this
function. *src* and *dst* are path names given as strings.
+ If *symlinks* is true and *src* is a symbolic link, a new symbolic link will
+ be created instead of copying the file *src* points to.
-.. function:: copymode(src, dst)
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised instead of :exc:`OSError`.
+ Added *symlinks* argument.
+
+
+.. function:: copymode(src, dst[, symlinks=False])
Copy the permission bits from *src* to *dst*. The file contents, owner, and
- group are unaffected. *src* and *dst* are path names given as strings.
+ group are unaffected. *src* and *dst* are path names given as strings. If
+ *symlinks* is true, *src* a symbolic link and the operating system supports
+ modes for symbolic links (for example BSD-based ones), the mode of the link
+ will be copied.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added *symlinks* argument.
-.. function:: copystat(src, dst)
+.. function:: copystat(src, dst[, symlinks=False])
Copy the permission bits, last access time, last modification time, and flags
from *src* to *dst*. The file contents, owner, and group are unaffected. *src*
- and *dst* are path names given as strings.
+ and *dst* are path names given as strings. If *src* and *dst* are both
+ symbolic links and *symlinks* true, the stats of the link will be copied as
+ far as the platform allows.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added *symlinks* argument.
-.. function:: copy(src, dst)
+.. function:: copy(src, dst[, symlinks=False]))
Copy the file *src* to the file or directory *dst*. If *dst* is a directory, a
file with the same basename as *src* is created (or overwritten) in the
directory specified. Permission bits are copied. *src* and *dst* are path
- names given as strings.
+ names given as strings. If *symlinks* is true, symbolic links won't be
+ followed but recreated instead -- this resembles GNU's :program:`cp -P`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added *symlinks* argument.
-.. function:: copy2(src, dst)
+.. function:: copy2(src, dst[, symlinks=False])
Similar to :func:`copy`, but metadata is copied as well -- in fact, this is just
:func:`copy` followed by :func:`copystat`. This is similar to the
- Unix command :program:`cp -p`.
+ Unix command :program:`cp -p`. If *symlinks* is true, symbolic links won't
+ be followed but recreated instead -- this resembles GNU's :program:`cp -P`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added *symlinks* argument.
.. function:: ignore_patterns(\*patterns)
@@ -103,9 +125,9 @@ Directory and files operations
:func:`copy2`.
If *symlinks* is true, symbolic links in the source tree are represented as
- symbolic links in the new tree, but the metadata of the original links is NOT
- copied; if false or omitted, the contents and metadata of the linked files
- are copied to the new tree.
+ symbolic links in the new tree and the metadata of the original links will
+ be copied as far as the platform allows; if false or omitted, the contents
+ and metadata of the linked files are copied to the new tree.
When *symlinks* is false, if the file pointed by the symlink doesn't
exist, a exception will be added in the list of errors raised in
@@ -139,6 +161,9 @@ Directory and files operations
Added the *ignore_dangling_symlinks* argument to silent dangling symlinks
errors when *symlinks* is false.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Copy metadata when *symlinks* is false.
+
.. function:: rmtree(path, ignore_errors=False, onerror=None)
@@ -173,7 +198,35 @@ Directory and files operations
If the destination is on the current filesystem, then :func:`os.rename` is
used. Otherwise, *src* is copied (using :func:`copy2`) to *dst* and then
- removed.
+ removed. In case of symlinks, a new symlink pointing to the target of *src*
+ will be created in or as *dst* and *src* will be removed.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added explicit symlink handling for foreign filesystems, thus adapting
+ it to the behavior of GNU's :program:`mv`.
+
+.. function:: disk_usage(path)
+
+ Return disk usage statistics about the given path as a :term:`named tuple`
+ with the attributes *total*, *used* and *free*, which are the amount of
+ total, used and free space, in bytes.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ Availability: Unix, Windows.
+
+.. function:: chown(path, user=None, group=None)
+
+ Change owner *user* and/or *group* of the given *path*.
+
+ *user* can be a system user name or a uid; the same applies to *group*. At
+ least one argument is required.
+
+ See also :func:`os.chown`, the underlying function.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. exception:: Error
@@ -406,3 +459,36 @@ The resulting archive contains::
-rw------- tarek/staff 1675 2008-06-09 13:26:54 ./id_rsa
-rw-r--r-- tarek/staff 397 2008-06-09 13:26:54 ./id_rsa.pub
-rw-r--r-- tarek/staff 37192 2010-02-06 18:23:10 ./known_hosts
+
+
+Querying the size of the output terminal
+----------------------------------------
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. function:: get_terminal_size(fallback=(columns, lines))
+
+ Get the size of the terminal window.
+
+ For each of the two dimensions, the environment variable, ``COLUMNS``
+ and ``LINES`` respectively, is checked. If the variable is defined and
+ the value is a positive integer, it is used.
+
+ When ``COLUMNS`` or ``LINES`` is not defined, which is the common case,
+ the terminal connected to :data:`sys.__stdout__` is queried
+ by invoking :func:`os.get_terminal_size`.
+
+ If the terminal size cannot be successfully queried, either because
+ the system doesn't support querying, or because we are not
+ connected to a terminal, the value given in ``fallback`` parameter
+ is used. ``fallback`` defaults to ``(80, 24)`` which is the default
+ size used by many terminal emulators.
+
+ The value returned is a named tuple of type :class:`os.terminal_size`.
+
+ See also: The Single UNIX Specification, Version 2,
+ `Other Environment Variables`_.
+
+.. _`Other Environment Variables`:
+ http://pubs.opengroup.org/onlinepubs/7908799/xbd/envvar.html#tag_002_003
+
diff --git a/Doc/library/signal.rst b/Doc/library/signal.rst
index 698b1e7..4fc3fd6 100644
--- a/Doc/library/signal.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/signal.rst
@@ -13,9 +13,6 @@ rules for working with signals and their handlers:
underlying implementation), with the exception of the handler for
:const:`SIGCHLD`, which follows the underlying implementation.
-* There is no way to "block" signals temporarily from critical sections (since
- this is not supported by all Unix flavors).
-
* Although Python signal handlers are called asynchronously as far as the Python
user is concerned, they can only occur between the "atomic" instructions of the
Python interpreter. This means that signals arriving during long calculations
@@ -119,6 +116,28 @@ The variables defined in the :mod:`signal` module are:
in user and kernel space. SIGPROF is delivered upon expiration.
+.. data:: SIG_BLOCK
+
+ A possible value for the *how* parameter to :func:`pthread_sigmask`
+ indicating that signals are to be blocked.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: SIG_UNBLOCK
+
+ A possible value for the *how* parameter to :func:`pthread_sigmask`
+ indicating that signals are to be unblocked.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: SIG_SETMASK
+
+ A possible value for the *how* parameter to :func:`pthread_sigmask`
+ indicating that the signal mask is to be replaced.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
The :mod:`signal` module defines one exception:
.. exception:: ItimerError
@@ -126,7 +145,11 @@ The :mod:`signal` module defines one exception:
Raised to signal an error from the underlying :func:`setitimer` or
:func:`getitimer` implementation. Expect this error if an invalid
interval timer or a negative time is passed to :func:`setitimer`.
- This error is a subtype of :exc:`IOError`.
+ This error is a subtype of :exc:`OSError`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ This error used to be a subtype of :exc:`IOError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
The :mod:`signal` module defines the following functions:
@@ -160,6 +183,60 @@ The :mod:`signal` module defines the following functions:
will then be called. Returns nothing. Not on Windows. (See the Unix man page
:manpage:`signal(2)`.)
+ See also :func:`sigwait`, :func:`sigwaitinfo`, :func:`sigtimedwait` and
+ :func:`sigpending`.
+
+
+.. function:: pthread_kill(thread_id, signum)
+
+ Send the signal *signum* to the thread *thread_id*, another thread in the same
+ process as the caller. The signal is asynchronously directed to thread.
+
+ Use :func:`threading.get_ident()` or the :attr:`~threading.Thread.ident`
+ attribute of :attr:`threading.Thread` to get a 'thread identifier' for
+ *thread_id*.
+
+ If *signum* is 0, then no signal is sent, but error checking is still
+ performed; this can be used to check if a thread is still running.
+
+ Availability: Unix (see the man page :manpage:`pthread_kill(3)` for further
+ information).
+
+ See also :func:`os.kill`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: pthread_sigmask(how, mask)
+
+ Fetch and/or change the signal mask of the calling thread. The signal mask
+ is the set of signals whose delivery is currently blocked for the caller.
+ Return the old signal mask as a set of signals.
+
+ The behavior of the call is dependent on the value of *how*, as follows.
+
+ * :data:`SIG_BLOCK`: The set of blocked signals is the union of the current
+ set and the *mask* argument.
+ * :data:`SIG_UNBLOCK`: The signals in *mask* are removed from the current
+ set of blocked signals. It is permissible to attempt to unblock a
+ signal which is not blocked.
+ * :data:`SIG_SETMASK`: The set of blocked signals is set to the *mask*
+ argument.
+
+ *mask* is a set of signal numbers (e.g. {:const:`signal.SIGINT`,
+ :const:`signal.SIGTERM`}). Use ``range(1, signal.NSIG)`` for a full mask
+ including all signals.
+
+ For example, ``signal.pthread_sigmask(signal.SIG_BLOCK, [])`` reads the
+ signal mask of the calling thread.
+
+ Availability: Unix. See the man page :manpage:`sigprocmask(3)` and
+ :manpage:`pthread_sigmask(3)` for further information.
+
+ See also :func:`pause`, :func:`sigpending` and :func:`sigwait`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: setitimer(which, seconds[, interval])
@@ -189,13 +266,17 @@ The :mod:`signal` module defines the following functions:
.. function:: set_wakeup_fd(fd)
- Set the wakeup fd to *fd*. When a signal is received, a ``'\0'`` byte is
- written to the fd. This can be used by a library to wakeup a poll or select
- call, allowing the signal to be fully processed.
+ Set the wakeup file descriptor to *fd*. When a signal is received, the
+ signal number is written as a single byte into the fd. This can be used by
+ a library to wakeup a poll or select call, allowing the signal to be fully
+ processed.
The old wakeup fd is returned. *fd* must be non-blocking. It is up to the
library to remove any bytes before calling poll or select again.
+ Use for example ``struct.unpack('%uB' % len(data), data)`` to decode the
+ signal numbers list.
+
When threads are enabled, this function can only be called from the main thread;
attempting to call it from other threads will cause a :exc:`ValueError`
exception to be raised.
@@ -235,6 +316,74 @@ The :mod:`signal` module defines the following functions:
:const:`SIGTERM`. A :exc:`ValueError` will be raised in any other case.
+.. function:: sigpending()
+
+ Examine the set of signals that are pending for delivery to the calling
+ thread (i.e., the signals which have been raised while blocked). Return the
+ set of the pending signals.
+
+ Availability: Unix (see the man page :manpage:`sigpending(2)` for further
+ information).
+
+ See also :func:`pause`, :func:`pthread_sigmask` and :func:`sigwait`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: sigwait(sigset)
+
+ Suspend execution of the calling thread until the delivery of one of the
+ signals specified in the signal set *sigset*. The function accepts the signal
+ (removes it from the pending list of signals), and returns the signal number.
+
+ Availability: Unix (see the man page :manpage:`sigwait(3)` for further
+ information).
+
+ See also :func:`pause`, :func:`pthread_sigmask`, :func:`sigpending`,
+ :func:`sigwaitinfo` and :func:`sigtimedwait`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: sigwaitinfo(sigset)
+
+ Suspend execution of the calling thread until the delivery of one of the
+ signals specified in the signal set *sigset*. The function accepts the
+ signal and removes it from the pending list of signals. If one of the
+ signals in *sigset* is already pending for the calling thread, the function
+ will return immediately with information about that signal. The signal
+ handler is not called for the delivered signal. The function raises an
+ :exc:`InterruptedError` if it is interrupted by a signal that is not in
+ *sigset*.
+
+ The return value is an object representing the data contained in the
+ :c:type:`siginfo_t` structure, namely: :attr:`si_signo`, :attr:`si_code`,
+ :attr:`si_errno`, :attr:`si_pid`, :attr:`si_uid`, :attr:`si_status`,
+ :attr:`si_band`.
+
+ Availability: Unix (see the man page :manpage:`sigwaitinfo(2)` for further
+ information).
+
+ See also :func:`pause`, :func:`sigwait` and :func:`sigtimedwait`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: sigtimedwait(sigset, (timeout_sec, timeout_nsec))
+
+ Like :func:`sigtimedwait`, but takes a tuple of ``(seconds, nanoseconds)``
+ as an additional argument specifying a timeout. If both *timeout_sec* and
+ *timeout_nsec* are specified as :const:`0`, a poll is performed. Returns
+ :const:`None` if a timeout occurs.
+
+ Availability: Unix (see the man page :manpage:`sigtimedwait(2)` for further
+ information).
+
+ See also :func:`pause`, :func:`sigwait` and :func:`sigwaitinfo`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. _signal-example:
Example
@@ -251,7 +400,7 @@ be sent, and the handler raises an exception. ::
def handler(signum, frame):
print('Signal handler called with signal', signum)
- raise IOError("Couldn't open device!")
+ raise OSError("Couldn't open device!")
# Set the signal handler and a 5-second alarm
signal.signal(signal.SIGALRM, handler)
diff --git a/Doc/library/site.rst b/Doc/library/site.rst
index db96add..b987897 100644
--- a/Doc/library/site.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/site.rst
@@ -16,7 +16,14 @@ import can be suppressed using the interpreter's :option:`-S` option.
.. index:: triple: module; search; path
Importing this module will append site-specific paths to the module search path
-and add a few builtins.
+and add a few builtins, unless :option:`-S` was used. In that case, this module
+can be safely imported with no automatic modifications to the module search path
+or additions to the builtins. To explicitly trigger the usual site-specific
+additions, call the :func:`site.main` function.
+
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Importing the module used to trigger paths manipulation even when using
+ :option:`-S`.
.. index::
pair: site-python; directory
@@ -127,10 +134,21 @@ empty, and the path manipulations are skipped; however the import of
:func:`getuserbase` hasn't been called yet. Default value is
:file:`~/.local` for UNIX and Mac OS X non-framework builds,
:file:`~/Library/Python/{X.Y}` for Mac framework builds, and
- :file:`{%APPDATA%}\\Python` for Windows. This value is used by Distutils to
+ :file:`{%APPDATA%}\\Python` for Windows. This value is used by Packaging to
compute the installation directories for scripts, data files, Python modules,
- etc. for the :ref:`user installation scheme <inst-alt-install-user>`. See
- also :envvar:`PYTHONUSERBASE`.
+ etc. for the :ref:`user installation scheme <packaging-alt-install-user>`.
+ See also :envvar:`PYTHONUSERBASE`.
+
+
+.. function:: main()
+
+ Adds all the standard site-specific directories to the module search
+ path. This function is called automatically when this module is imported,
+ unless the :program:`python` interpreter was started with the :option:`-S`
+ flag.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to be called unconditionnally.
.. function:: addsitedir(sitedir, known_paths=None)
diff --git a/Doc/library/smtplib.rst b/Doc/library/smtplib.rst
index 3101ab7..45c5d6d 100644
--- a/Doc/library/smtplib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/smtplib.rst
@@ -20,7 +20,7 @@ details of SMTP and ESMTP operation, consult :rfc:`821` (Simple Mail Transfer
Protocol) and :rfc:`1869` (SMTP Service Extensions).
-.. class:: SMTP(host='', port=0, local_hostname=None[, timeout])
+.. class:: SMTP(host='', port=0, local_hostname=None[, timeout], source_address=None)
A :class:`SMTP` instance encapsulates an SMTP connection. It has methods
that support a full repertoire of SMTP and ESMTP operations. If the optional
@@ -29,13 +29,34 @@ Protocol) and :rfc:`1869` (SMTP Service Extensions).
raised if the specified host doesn't respond correctly. The optional
*timeout* parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for blocking operations
like the connection attempt (if not specified, the global default timeout
- setting will be used).
+ setting will be used). The optional source_address parameter allows to bind to some
+ specific source address in a machine with multiple network interfaces,
+ and/or to some specific source TCP port. It takes a 2-tuple (host, port),
+ for the socket to bind to as its source address before connecting. If
+ omitted (or if host or port are ``''`` and/or 0 respectively) the OS default
+ behavior will be used.
For normal use, you should only require the initialization/connect,
:meth:`sendmail`, and :meth:`quit` methods. An example is included below.
+ The :class:`SMTP` class supports the :keyword:`with` statement. When used
+ like this, the SMTP ``QUIT`` command is issued automatically when the
+ :keyword:`with` statement exits. E.g.::
-.. class:: SMTP_SSL(host='', port=0, local_hostname=None, keyfile=None, certfile=None[, timeout])
+ >>> from smtplib import SMTP
+ >>> with SMTP("domain.org") as smtp:
+ ... smtp.noop()
+ ...
+ (250, b'Ok')
+ >>>
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Support for the :keyword:`with` statement was added.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ source_address argument was added.
+
+.. class:: SMTP_SSL(host='', port=0, local_hostname=None, keyfile=None, certfile=None[, timeout], context=None, source_address=None)
A :class:`SMTP_SSL` instance behaves exactly the same as instances of
:class:`SMTP`. :class:`SMTP_SSL` should be used for situations where SSL is
@@ -43,18 +64,33 @@ Protocol) and :rfc:`1869` (SMTP Service Extensions).
not appropriate. If *host* is not specified, the local host is used. If
*port* is zero, the standard SMTP-over-SSL port (465) is used. *keyfile*
and *certfile* are also optional, and can contain a PEM formatted private key
- and certificate chain file for the SSL connection. The optional *timeout*
+ and certificate chain file for the SSL connection. *context* also optional, can contain
+ a SSLContext, and is an alternative to keyfile and certfile; If it is specified both
+ keyfile and certfile must be None. The optional *timeout*
parameter specifies a timeout in seconds for blocking operations like the
connection attempt (if not specified, the global default timeout setting
- will be used).
+ will be used). The optional source_address parameter allows to bind to some
+ specific source address in a machine with multiple network interfaces,
+ and/or to some specific source tcp port. It takes a 2-tuple (host, port),
+ for the socket to bind to as its source address before connecting. If
+ omitted (or if host or port are ``''`` and/or 0 respectively) the OS default
+ behavior will be used.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *context* was added.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ source_address argument was added.
-.. class:: LMTP(host='', port=LMTP_PORT, local_hostname=None)
+
+.. class:: LMTP(host='', port=LMTP_PORT, local_hostname=None, source_address=None)
The LMTP protocol, which is very similar to ESMTP, is heavily based on the
- standard SMTP client. It's common to use Unix sockets for LMTP, so our :meth:`connect`
- method must support that as well as a regular host:port server. To specify a
- Unix socket, you must use an absolute path for *host*, starting with a '/'.
+ standard SMTP client. It's common to use Unix sockets for LMTP, so our
+ :meth:`connect` method must support that as well as a regular host:port
+ server. The optional arguments local_hostname and source_address have the
+ same meaning as that of SMTP client. To specify a Unix socket, you must use
+ an absolute path for *host*, starting with a '/'.
Authentication is supported, using the regular SMTP mechanism. When using a Unix
socket, LMTP generally don't support or require any authentication, but your
@@ -242,7 +278,7 @@ An :class:`SMTP` instance has the following methods:
No suitable authentication method was found.
-.. method:: SMTP.starttls(keyfile=None, certfile=None)
+.. method:: SMTP.starttls(keyfile=None, certfile=None, context=None)
Put the SMTP connection in TLS (Transport Layer Security) mode. All SMTP
commands that follow will be encrypted. You should then call :meth:`ehlo`
@@ -251,6 +287,9 @@ An :class:`SMTP` instance has the following methods:
If *keyfile* and *certfile* are provided, these are passed to the :mod:`socket`
module's :func:`ssl` function.
+ Optional *context* parameter is a :class:`ssl.SSLContext` object; This is an alternative to
+ using a keyfile and a certfile and if specified both *keyfile* and *certfile* should be None.
+
If there has been no previous ``EHLO`` or ``HELO`` command this session,
this method tries ESMTP ``EHLO`` first.
@@ -263,6 +302,9 @@ An :class:`SMTP` instance has the following methods:
:exc:`RuntimeError`
SSL/TLS support is not available to your Python interpreter.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *context* was added.
+
.. method:: SMTP.sendmail(from_addr, to_addrs, msg, mail_options=[], rcpt_options=[])
diff --git a/Doc/library/socket.rst b/Doc/library/socket.rst
index f236d30..8cc5a7e 100644
--- a/Doc/library/socket.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/socket.rst
@@ -40,9 +40,23 @@ Socket families
Depending on the system and the build options, various socket families
are supported by this module.
-Socket addresses are represented as follows:
-
-- A single string is used for the :const:`AF_UNIX` address family.
+The address format required by a particular socket object is automatically
+selected based on the address family specified when the socket object was
+created. Socket addresses are represented as follows:
+
+- The address of an :const:`AF_UNIX` socket bound to a file system node
+ is represented as a string, using the file system encoding and the
+ ``'surrogateescape'`` error handler (see :pep:`383`). An address in
+ Linux's abstract namespace is returned as a :class:`bytes` object with
+ an initial null byte; note that sockets in this namespace can
+ communicate with normal file system sockets, so programs intended to
+ run on Linux may need to deal with both types of address. A string or
+ :class:`bytes` object can be used for either type of address when
+ passing it as an argument.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Previously, :const:`AF_UNIX` socket paths were assumed to use UTF-8
+ encoding.
- A pair ``(host, port)`` is used for the :const:`AF_INET` address family,
where *host* is a string representing either a hostname in Internet domain
@@ -80,6 +94,19 @@ Socket addresses are represented as follows:
If *addr_type* is :const:`TIPC_ADDR_ID`, then *v1* is the node, *v2* is the
reference, and *v3* should be set to 0.
+- A tuple ``(interface, )`` is used for the :const:`AF_CAN` address family,
+ where *interface* is a string representing a network interface name like
+ ``'can0'``. The network interface name ``''`` can be used to receive packets
+ from all network interfaces of this family.
+
+- A string or a tuple ``(id, unit)`` is used for the :const:`SYSPROTO_CONTROL`
+ protocol of the :const:`PF_SYSTEM` family. The string is the name of a
+ kernel control using a dynamically-assigned ID. The tuple can be used if ID
+ and unit number of the kernel control are known or if a registered ID is
+ used.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
- Certain other address families (:const:`AF_BLUETOOTH`, :const:`AF_PACKET`)
support specific representations.
@@ -99,8 +126,9 @@ resolution and/or the host configuration. For deterministic behavior use a
numeric address in *host* portion.
All errors raise exceptions. The normal exceptions for invalid argument types
-and out-of-memory conditions can be raised; errors related to socket or address
-semantics raise :exc:`socket.error` or one of its subclasses.
+and out-of-memory conditions can be raised; starting from Python 3.3, errors
+related to socket or address semantics raise :exc:`OSError` or one of its
+subclasses (they used to raise :exc:`socket.error`).
Non-blocking mode is supported through :meth:`~socket.setblocking`. A
generalization of this based on timeouts is supported through
@@ -115,20 +143,15 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
.. exception:: error
- .. index:: module: errno
-
- A subclass of :exc:`IOError`, this exception is raised for socket-related
- errors. It is recommended that you inspect its ``errno`` attribute to
- discriminate between different kinds of errors.
+ A deprecated alias of :exc:`OSError`.
- .. seealso::
- The :mod:`errno` module contains symbolic names for the error codes
- defined by the underlying operating system.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Following :pep:`3151`, this class was made an alias of :exc:`OSError`.
.. exception:: herror
- A subclass of :exc:`socket.error`, this exception is raised for
+ A subclass of :exc:`OSError`, this exception is raised for
address-related errors, i.e. for functions that use *h_errno* in the POSIX
C API, including :func:`gethostbyname_ex` and :func:`gethostbyaddr`.
The accompanying value is a pair ``(h_errno, string)`` representing an
@@ -136,10 +159,12 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
*string* represents the description of *h_errno*, as returned by the
:c:func:`hstrerror` C function.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This class was made a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
.. exception:: gaierror
- A subclass of :exc:`socket.error`, this exception is raised for
+ A subclass of :exc:`OSError`, this exception is raised for
address-related errors by :func:`getaddrinfo` and :func:`getnameinfo`.
The accompanying value is a pair ``(error, string)`` representing an error
returned by a library call. *string* represents the description of
@@ -147,15 +172,19 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
numeric *error* value will match one of the :const:`EAI_\*` constants
defined in this module.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This class was made a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
.. exception:: timeout
- A subclass of :exc:`socket.error`, this exception is raised when a timeout
+ A subclass of :exc:`OSError`, this exception is raised when a timeout
occurs on a socket which has had timeouts enabled via a prior call to
:meth:`~socket.settimeout` (or implicitly through
:func:`~socket.setdefaulttimeout`). The accompanying value is a string
whose value is currently always "timed out".
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This class was made a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
.. data:: AF_UNIX
AF_INET
@@ -198,6 +227,7 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
SOMAXCONN
MSG_*
SOL_*
+ SCM_*
IPPROTO_*
IPPORT_*
INADDR_*
@@ -215,6 +245,32 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
in the Unix header files are defined; for a few symbols, default values are
provided.
+.. data:: AF_CAN
+ PF_CAN
+ SOL_CAN_*
+ CAN_*
+
+ Many constants of these forms, documented in the Linux documentation, are
+ also defined in the socket module.
+
+ Availability: Linux >= 2.6.25.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. data:: AF_RDS
+ PF_RDS
+ SOL_RDS
+ RDS_*
+
+ Many constants of these forms, documented in the Linux documentation, are
+ also defined in the socket module.
+
+ Availability: Linux >= 2.6.30.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. data:: SIO_*
RCVALL_*
@@ -393,10 +449,15 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
Create a new socket using the given address family, socket type and protocol
number. The address family should be :const:`AF_INET` (the default),
- :const:`AF_INET6` or :const:`AF_UNIX`. The socket type should be
- :const:`SOCK_STREAM` (the default), :const:`SOCK_DGRAM` or perhaps one of the
- other ``SOCK_`` constants. The protocol number is usually zero and may be
- omitted in that case.
+ :const:`AF_INET6`, :const:`AF_UNIX`, :const:`AF_CAN` or :const:`AF_RDS`. The
+ socket type should be :const:`SOCK_STREAM` (the default),
+ :const:`SOCK_DGRAM`, :const:`SOCK_RAW` or perhaps one of the other ``SOCK_``
+ constants. The protocol number is usually zero and may be omitted in that
+ case or :const:`CAN_RAW` in case the address family is :const:`AF_CAN`.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The AF_CAN family was added.
+ The AF_RDS family was added.
.. function:: socketpair([family[, type[, proto]]])
@@ -464,7 +525,7 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
Unix manual page :manpage:`inet(3)` for details.
If the IPv4 address string passed to this function is invalid,
- :exc:`socket.error` will be raised. Note that exactly what is valid depends on
+ :exc:`OSError` will be raised. Note that exactly what is valid depends on
the underlying C implementation of :c:func:`inet_aton`.
:func:`inet_aton` does not support IPv6, and :func:`inet_pton` should be used
@@ -481,7 +542,7 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
argument.
If the byte sequence passed to this function is not exactly 4 bytes in
- length, :exc:`socket.error` will be raised. :func:`inet_ntoa` does not
+ length, :exc:`OSError` will be raised. :func:`inet_ntoa` does not
support IPv6, and :func:`inet_ntop` should be used instead for IPv4/v6 dual
stack support.
@@ -495,7 +556,7 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
Supported values for *address_family* are currently :const:`AF_INET` and
:const:`AF_INET6`. If the IP address string *ip_string* is invalid,
- :exc:`socket.error` will be raised. Note that exactly what is valid depends on
+ :exc:`OSError` will be raised. Note that exactly what is valid depends on
both the value of *address_family* and the underlying implementation of
:c:func:`inet_pton`.
@@ -513,11 +574,54 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
Supported values for *address_family* are currently :const:`AF_INET` and
:const:`AF_INET6`. If the string *packed_ip* is not the correct length for the
specified address family, :exc:`ValueError` will be raised. A
- :exc:`socket.error` is raised for errors from the call to :func:`inet_ntop`.
+ :exc:`OSError` is raised for errors from the call to :func:`inet_ntop`.
Availability: Unix (maybe not all platforms).
+..
+ XXX: Are sendmsg(), recvmsg() and CMSG_*() available on any
+ non-Unix platforms? The old (obsolete?) 4.2BSD form of the
+ interface, in which struct msghdr has no msg_control or
+ msg_controllen members, is not currently supported.
+
+.. function:: CMSG_LEN(length)
+
+ Return the total length, without trailing padding, of an ancillary
+ data item with associated data of the given *length*. This value
+ can often be used as the buffer size for :meth:`~socket.recvmsg` to
+ receive a single item of ancillary data, but :rfc:`3542` requires
+ portable applications to use :func:`CMSG_SPACE` and thus include
+ space for padding, even when the item will be the last in the
+ buffer. Raises :exc:`OverflowError` if *length* is outside the
+ permissible range of values.
+
+ Availability: most Unix platforms, possibly others.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: CMSG_SPACE(length)
+
+ Return the buffer size needed for :meth:`~socket.recvmsg` to
+ receive an ancillary data item with associated data of the given
+ *length*, along with any trailing padding. The buffer space needed
+ to receive multiple items is the sum of the :func:`CMSG_SPACE`
+ values for their associated data lengths. Raises
+ :exc:`OverflowError` if *length* is outside the permissible range
+ of values.
+
+ Note that some systems might support ancillary data without
+ providing this function. Also note that setting the buffer size
+ using the results of this function may not precisely limit the
+ amount of ancillary data that can be received, since additional
+ data may be able to fit into the padding area.
+
+ Availability: most Unix platforms, possibly others.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: getdefaulttimeout()
Return the default timeout in seconds (float) for new socket objects. A value
@@ -533,6 +637,49 @@ The module :mod:`socket` exports the following constants and functions:
meanings.
+.. function:: sethostname(name)
+
+ Set the machine's hostname to *name*. This will raise a
+ :exc:`OSError` if you don't have enough rights.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: if_nameindex()
+
+ Return a list of network interface information
+ (index int, name string) tuples.
+ :exc:`OSError` if the system call fails.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: if_nametoindex(if_name)
+
+ Return a network interface index number corresponding to an
+ interface name.
+ :exc:`OSError` if no interface with the given name exists.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. function:: if_indextoname(if_index)
+
+ Return a network interface name corresponding to a
+ interface index number.
+ :exc:`OSError` if no interface with the given index exists.
+
+ Availability: Unix.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. data:: SocketType
This is a Python type object that represents the socket object type. It is the
@@ -706,6 +853,109 @@ correspond to Unix system calls applicable to sockets.
to zero. (The format of *address* depends on the address family --- see above.)
+.. method:: socket.recvmsg(bufsize[, ancbufsize[, flags]])
+
+ Receive normal data (up to *bufsize* bytes) and ancillary data from
+ the socket. The *ancbufsize* argument sets the size in bytes of
+ the internal buffer used to receive the ancillary data; it defaults
+ to 0, meaning that no ancillary data will be received. Appropriate
+ buffer sizes for ancillary data can be calculated using
+ :func:`CMSG_SPACE` or :func:`CMSG_LEN`, and items which do not fit
+ into the buffer might be truncated or discarded. The *flags*
+ argument defaults to 0 and has the same meaning as for
+ :meth:`recv`.
+
+ The return value is a 4-tuple: ``(data, ancdata, msg_flags,
+ address)``. The *data* item is a :class:`bytes` object holding the
+ non-ancillary data received. The *ancdata* item is a list of zero
+ or more tuples ``(cmsg_level, cmsg_type, cmsg_data)`` representing
+ the ancillary data (control messages) received: *cmsg_level* and
+ *cmsg_type* are integers specifying the protocol level and
+ protocol-specific type respectively, and *cmsg_data* is a
+ :class:`bytes` object holding the associated data. The *msg_flags*
+ item is the bitwise OR of various flags indicating conditions on
+ the received message; see your system documentation for details.
+ If the receiving socket is unconnected, *address* is the address of
+ the sending socket, if available; otherwise, its value is
+ unspecified.
+
+ On some systems, :meth:`sendmsg` and :meth:`recvmsg` can be used to
+ pass file descriptors between processes over an :const:`AF_UNIX`
+ socket. When this facility is used (it is often restricted to
+ :const:`SOCK_STREAM` sockets), :meth:`recvmsg` will return, in its
+ ancillary data, items of the form ``(socket.SOL_SOCKET,
+ socket.SCM_RIGHTS, fds)``, where *fds* is a :class:`bytes` object
+ representing the new file descriptors as a binary array of the
+ native C :c:type:`int` type. If :meth:`recvmsg` raises an
+ exception after the system call returns, it will first attempt to
+ close any file descriptors received via this mechanism.
+
+ Some systems do not indicate the truncated length of ancillary data
+ items which have been only partially received. If an item appears
+ to extend beyond the end of the buffer, :meth:`recvmsg` will issue
+ a :exc:`RuntimeWarning`, and will return the part of it which is
+ inside the buffer provided it has not been truncated before the
+ start of its associated data.
+
+ On systems which support the :const:`SCM_RIGHTS` mechanism, the
+ following function will receive up to *maxfds* file descriptors,
+ returning the message data and a list containing the descriptors
+ (while ignoring unexpected conditions such as unrelated control
+ messages being received). See also :meth:`sendmsg`. ::
+
+ import socket, array
+
+ def recv_fds(sock, msglen, maxfds):
+ fds = array.array("i") # Array of ints
+ msg, ancdata, flags, addr = sock.recvmsg(msglen, socket.CMSG_LEN(maxfds * fds.itemsize))
+ for cmsg_level, cmsg_type, cmsg_data in ancdata:
+ if (cmsg_level == socket.SOL_SOCKET and cmsg_type == socket.SCM_RIGHTS):
+ # Append data, ignoring any truncated integers at the end.
+ fds.fromstring(cmsg_data[:len(cmsg_data) - (len(cmsg_data) % fds.itemsize)])
+ return msg, list(fds)
+
+ Availability: most Unix platforms, possibly others.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
+.. method:: socket.recvmsg_into(buffers[, ancbufsize[, flags]])
+
+ Receive normal data and ancillary data from the socket, behaving as
+ :meth:`recvmsg` would, but scatter the non-ancillary data into a
+ series of buffers instead of returning a new bytes object. The
+ *buffers* argument must be an iterable of objects that export
+ writable buffers (e.g. :class:`bytearray` objects); these will be
+ filled with successive chunks of the non-ancillary data until it
+ has all been written or there are no more buffers. The operating
+ system may set a limit (:func:`~os.sysconf` value ``SC_IOV_MAX``)
+ on the number of buffers that can be used. The *ancbufsize* and
+ *flags* arguments have the same meaning as for :meth:`recvmsg`.
+
+ The return value is a 4-tuple: ``(nbytes, ancdata, msg_flags,
+ address)``, where *nbytes* is the total number of bytes of
+ non-ancillary data written into the buffers, and *ancdata*,
+ *msg_flags* and *address* are the same as for :meth:`recvmsg`.
+
+ Example::
+
+ >>> import socket
+ >>> s1, s2 = socket.socketpair()
+ >>> b1 = bytearray(b'----')
+ >>> b2 = bytearray(b'0123456789')
+ >>> b3 = bytearray(b'--------------')
+ >>> s1.send(b'Mary had a little lamb')
+ 22
+ >>> s2.recvmsg_into([b1, memoryview(b2)[2:9], b3])
+ (22, [], 0, None)
+ >>> [b1, b2, b3]
+ [bytearray(b'Mary'), bytearray(b'01 had a 9'), bytearray(b'little lamb---')]
+
+ Availability: most Unix platforms, possibly others.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: socket.recvfrom_into(buffer[, nbytes[, flags]])
Receive data from the socket, writing it into *buffer* instead of creating a
@@ -754,6 +1004,41 @@ correspond to Unix system calls applicable to sockets.
above.)
+.. method:: socket.sendmsg(buffers[, ancdata[, flags[, address]]])
+
+ Send normal and ancillary data to the socket, gathering the
+ non-ancillary data from a series of buffers and concatenating it
+ into a single message. The *buffers* argument specifies the
+ non-ancillary data as an iterable of buffer-compatible objects
+ (e.g. :class:`bytes` objects); the operating system may set a limit
+ (:func:`~os.sysconf` value ``SC_IOV_MAX``) on the number of buffers
+ that can be used. The *ancdata* argument specifies the ancillary
+ data (control messages) as an iterable of zero or more tuples
+ ``(cmsg_level, cmsg_type, cmsg_data)``, where *cmsg_level* and
+ *cmsg_type* are integers specifying the protocol level and
+ protocol-specific type respectively, and *cmsg_data* is a
+ buffer-compatible object holding the associated data. Note that
+ some systems (in particular, systems without :func:`CMSG_SPACE`)
+ might support sending only one control message per call. The
+ *flags* argument defaults to 0 and has the same meaning as for
+ :meth:`send`. If *address* is supplied and not ``None``, it sets a
+ destination address for the message. The return value is the
+ number of bytes of non-ancillary data sent.
+
+ The following function sends the list of file descriptors *fds*
+ over an :const:`AF_UNIX` socket, on systems which support the
+ :const:`SCM_RIGHTS` mechanism. See also :meth:`recvmsg`. ::
+
+ import socket, array
+
+ def send_fds(sock, msg, fds):
+ return sock.sendmsg([msg], [(socket.SOL_SOCKET, socket.SCM_RIGHTS, array.array("i", fds))])
+
+ Availability: most Unix platforms, possibly others.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: socket.setblocking(flag)
Set blocking or non-blocking mode of the socket: if *flag* is false, the
@@ -795,9 +1080,7 @@ correspond to Unix system calls applicable to sockets.
Shut down one or both halves of the connection. If *how* is :const:`SHUT_RD`,
further receives are disallowed. If *how* is :const:`SHUT_WR`, further sends
are disallowed. If *how* is :const:`SHUT_RDWR`, further sends and receives are
- disallowed. Depending on the platform, shutting down one half of the connection
- can also close the opposite half (e.g. on Mac OS X, ``shutdown(SHUT_WR)`` does
- not allow further reads on the other end of the connection).
+ disallowed.
Note that there are no methods :meth:`read` or :meth:`write`; use
:meth:`~socket.recv` and :meth:`~socket.send` without *flags* argument instead.
@@ -942,13 +1225,13 @@ sends traffic to the first one connected successfully. ::
af, socktype, proto, canonname, sa = res
try:
s = socket.socket(af, socktype, proto)
- except socket.error as msg:
+ except OSError as msg:
s = None
continue
try:
s.bind(sa)
s.listen(1)
- except socket.error as msg:
+ except OSError as msg:
s.close()
s = None
continue
@@ -977,12 +1260,12 @@ sends traffic to the first one connected successfully. ::
af, socktype, proto, canonname, sa = res
try:
s = socket.socket(af, socktype, proto)
- except socket.error as msg:
+ except OSError as msg:
s = None
continue
try:
s.connect(sa)
- except socket.error as msg:
+ except OSError as msg:
s.close()
s = None
continue
@@ -996,7 +1279,7 @@ sends traffic to the first one connected successfully. ::
print('Received', repr(data))
-The last example shows how to write a very simple network sniffer with raw
+The next example shows how to write a very simple network sniffer with raw
sockets on Windows. The example requires administrator privileges to modify
the interface::
@@ -1021,11 +1304,51 @@ the interface::
# disabled promiscuous mode
s.ioctl(socket.SIO_RCVALL, socket.RCVALL_OFF)
+The last example shows how to use the socket interface to communicate to a CAN
+network. This example might require special priviledge::
+
+ import socket
+ import struct
+
+
+ # CAN frame packing/unpacking (see `struct can_frame` in <linux/can.h>)
+
+ can_frame_fmt = "=IB3x8s"
+ can_frame_size = struct.calcsize(can_frame_fmt)
+
+ def build_can_frame(can_id, data):
+ can_dlc = len(data)
+ data = data.ljust(8, b'\x00')
+ return struct.pack(can_frame_fmt, can_id, can_dlc, data)
+
+ def dissect_can_frame(frame):
+ can_id, can_dlc, data = struct.unpack(can_frame_fmt, frame)
+ return (can_id, can_dlc, data[:can_dlc])
+
+
+ # create a raw socket and bind it to the `vcan0` interface
+ s = socket.socket(socket.AF_CAN, socket.SOCK_RAW, socket.CAN_RAW)
+ s.bind(('vcan0',))
+
+ while True:
+ cf, addr = s.recvfrom(can_frame_size)
+
+ print('Received: can_id=%x, can_dlc=%x, data=%s' % dissect_can_frame(cf))
+
+ try:
+ s.send(cf)
+ except OSError:
+ print('Error sending CAN frame')
+
+ try:
+ s.send(build_can_frame(0x01, b'\x01\x02\x03'))
+ except OSError:
+ print('Error sending CAN frame')
Running an example several times with too small delay between executions, could
lead to this error::
- socket.error: [Errno 98] Address already in use
+ OSError: [Errno 98] Address already in use
This is because the previous execution has left the socket in a ``TIME_WAIT``
state, and can't be immediately reused.
diff --git a/Doc/library/socketserver.rst b/Doc/library/socketserver.rst
index 5287f17..7dc0cc7 100644
--- a/Doc/library/socketserver.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/socketserver.rst
@@ -154,9 +154,21 @@ Server Objects
.. method:: BaseServer.serve_forever(poll_interval=0.5)
Handle requests until an explicit :meth:`shutdown` request.
- Poll for shutdown every *poll_interval* seconds. Ignores :attr:`self.timeout`.
- If you need to do periodic tasks, do them in another thread.
+ Poll for shutdown every *poll_interval* seconds. Ignores :attr:`self.timeout`. It also calls
+ :meth:`service_actions` which may be used by a subclass or Mixin to provide
+ various cleanup actions. For e.g. ForkingMixin class uses
+ :meth:`service_actions` to cleanup the zombie child processes.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added service_actions call to the serve_forever method.
+
+
+.. method:: BaseServer.service_actions()
+
+ This is called by the serve_forever loop. This method is can be overridden
+ by Mixin's to add cleanup or service specific actions.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. method:: BaseServer.shutdown()
diff --git a/Doc/library/sqlite3.rst b/Doc/library/sqlite3.rst
index 786bb04..f3acdc5 100644
--- a/Doc/library/sqlite3.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/sqlite3.rst
@@ -369,6 +369,22 @@ Connection Objects
method with :const:`None` for *handler*.
+.. method:: Connection.set_trace_callback(trace_callback)
+
+ Registers *trace_callback* to be called for each SQL statement that is
+ actually executed by the SQLite backend.
+
+ The only argument passed to the callback is the statement (as string) that
+ is being executed. The return value of the callback is ignored. Note that
+ the backend does not only run statements passed to the :meth:`Cursor.execute`
+ methods. Other sources include the transaction management of the Python
+ module and the execution of triggers defined in the current database.
+
+ Passing :const:`None` as *trace_callback* will disable the trace callback.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: Connection.enable_load_extension(enabled)
This routine allows/disallows the SQLite engine to load SQLite extensions
diff --git a/Doc/library/ssl.rst b/Doc/library/ssl.rst
index 8cd07d7..7691996 100644
--- a/Doc/library/ssl.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/ssl.rst
@@ -53,9 +53,53 @@ Functions, Constants, and Exceptions
(currently provided by the OpenSSL library). This signifies some
problem in the higher-level encryption and authentication layer that's
superimposed on the underlying network connection. This error
- is a subtype of :exc:`socket.error`, which in turn is a subtype of
- :exc:`IOError`. The error code and message of :exc:`SSLError` instances
- are provided by the OpenSSL library.
+ is a subtype of :exc:`OSError`. The error code and message of
+ :exc:`SSLError` instances are provided by the OpenSSL library.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`SSLError` used to be a subtype of :exc:`socket.error`.
+
+.. exception:: SSLZeroReturnError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`SSLError` raised when trying to read or write and
+ the SSL connection has been closed cleanly. Note that this doesn't
+ mean that the underlying transport (read TCP) has been closed.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. exception:: SSLWantReadError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`SSLError` raised by a :ref:`non-blocking SSL socket
+ <ssl-nonblocking>` when trying to read or write data, but more data needs
+ to be received on the underlying TCP transport before the request can be
+ fulfilled.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. exception:: SSLWantWriteError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`SSLError` raised by a :ref:`non-blocking SSL socket
+ <ssl-nonblocking>` when trying to read or write data, but more data needs
+ to be sent on the underlying TCP transport before the request can be
+ fulfilled.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. exception:: SSLSyscallError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`SSLError` raised when a system error was encountered
+ while trying to fulfill an operation on a SSL socket. Unfortunately,
+ there is no easy way to inspect the original errno number.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. exception:: SSLEOFError
+
+ A subclass of :exc:`SSLError` raised when the SSL connection has been
+ terminated abruptly. Generally, you shouldn't try to reuse the underlying
+ transport when this error is encountered.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. exception:: CertificateError
@@ -161,6 +205,35 @@ instead.
Random generation
^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^
+.. function:: RAND_bytes(num)
+
+ Returns *num* cryptographically strong pseudo-random bytes. Raises an
+ :class:`SSLError` if the PRNG has not been seeded with enough data or if the
+ operation is not supported by the current RAND method. :func:`RAND_status`
+ can be used to check the status of the PRNG and :func:`RAND_add` can be used
+ to seed the PRNG.
+
+ Read the Wikipedia article, `Cryptographically secure pseudorandom number
+ generator (CSPRNG)
+ <http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Cryptographically_secure_pseudorandom_number_generator>`_,
+ to get the requirements of a cryptographically generator.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. function:: RAND_pseudo_bytes(num)
+
+ Returns (bytes, is_cryptographic): bytes are *num* pseudo-random bytes,
+ is_cryptographic is True if the bytes generated are cryptographically
+ strong. Raises an :class:`SSLError` if the operation is not supported by the
+ current RAND method.
+
+ Generated pseudo-random byte sequences will be unique if they are of
+ sufficient length, but are not necessarily unpredictable. They can be used
+ for non-cryptographic purposes and for certain purposes in cryptographic
+ protocols, but usually not for key generation etc.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: RAND_status()
Returns True if the SSL pseudo-random number generator has been seeded with
@@ -170,7 +243,7 @@ Random generation
.. function:: RAND_egd(path)
- If you are running an entropy-gathering daemon (EGD) somewhere, and ``path``
+ If you are running an entropy-gathering daemon (EGD) somewhere, and *path*
is the pathname of a socket connection open to it, this will read 256 bytes
of randomness from the socket, and add it to the SSL pseudo-random number
generator to increase the security of generated secret keys. This is
@@ -181,8 +254,8 @@ Random generation
.. function:: RAND_add(bytes, entropy)
- Mixes the given ``bytes`` into the SSL pseudo-random number generator. The
- parameter ``entropy`` (a float) is a lower bound on the entropy contained in
+ Mixes the given *bytes* into the SSL pseudo-random number generator. The
+ parameter *entropy* (a float) is a lower bound on the entropy contained in
string (so you can always use :const:`0.0`). See :rfc:`1750` for more
information on sources of entropy.
@@ -238,6 +311,9 @@ Certificate handling
will attempt to validate the server certificate against that set of root
certificates, and will fail if the validation attempt fails.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function is now IPv6-compatible.
+
.. function:: DER_cert_to_PEM_cert(DER_cert_bytes)
Given a certificate as a DER-encoded blob of bytes, returns a PEM-encoded
@@ -345,6 +421,46 @@ Constants
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+.. data:: OP_CIPHER_SERVER_PREFERENCE
+
+ Use the server's cipher ordering preference, rather than the client's.
+ This option has no effect on client sockets and SSLv2 server sockets.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: OP_SINGLE_DH_USE
+
+ Prevents re-use of the same DH key for distinct SSL sessions. This
+ improves forward secrecy but requires more computational resources.
+ This option only applies to server sockets.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: OP_SINGLE_ECDH_USE
+
+ Prevents re-use of the same ECDH key for distinct SSL sessions. This
+ improves forward secrecy but requires more computational resources.
+ This option only applies to server sockets.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: OP_NO_COMPRESSION
+
+ Disable compression on the SSL channel. This is useful if the application
+ protocol supports its own compression scheme.
+
+ This option is only available with OpenSSL 1.0.0 and later.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: HAS_ECDH
+
+ Whether the OpenSSL library has built-in support for Elliptic Curve-based
+ Diffie-Hellman key exchange. This should be true unless the feature was
+ explicitly disabled by the distributor.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. data:: HAS_SNI
Whether the OpenSSL library has built-in support for the *Server Name
@@ -354,6 +470,13 @@ Constants
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+.. data:: CHANNEL_BINDING_TYPES
+
+ List of supported TLS channel binding types. Strings in this list
+ can be used as arguments to :meth:`SSLSocket.get_channel_binding`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. data:: OPENSSL_VERSION
The version string of the OpenSSL library loaded by the interpreter::
@@ -463,6 +586,28 @@ SSL sockets also have the following additional methods and attributes:
version of the SSL protocol that defines its use, and the number of secret
bits being used. If no connection has been established, returns ``None``.
+.. method:: SSLSocket.compression()
+
+ Return the compression algorithm being used as a string, or ``None``
+ if the connection isn't compressed.
+
+ If the higher-level protocol supports its own compression mechanism,
+ you can use :data:`OP_NO_COMPRESSION` to disable SSL-level compression.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. method:: SSLSocket.get_channel_binding(cb_type="tls-unique")
+
+ Get channel binding data for current connection, as a bytes object. Returns
+ ``None`` if not connected or the handshake has not been completed.
+
+ The *cb_type* parameter allow selection of the desired channel binding
+ type. Valid channel binding types are listed in the
+ :data:`CHANNEL_BINDING_TYPES` list. Currently only the 'tls-unique' channel
+ binding, defined by :rfc:`5929`, is supported. :exc:`ValueError` will be
+ raised if an unsupported channel binding type is requested.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. method:: SSLSocket.unwrap()
@@ -502,7 +647,7 @@ to speed up repeated connections from the same clients.
:class:`SSLContext` objects have the following methods and attributes:
-.. method:: SSLContext.load_cert_chain(certfile, keyfile=None)
+.. method:: SSLContext.load_cert_chain(certfile, keyfile=None, password=None)
Load a private key and the corresponding certificate. The *certfile*
string must be the path to a single file in PEM format containing the
@@ -513,9 +658,25 @@ to speed up repeated connections from the same clients.
:ref:`ssl-certificates` for more information on how the certificate
is stored in the *certfile*.
+ The *password* argument may be a function to call to get the password for
+ decrypting the private key. It will only be called if the private key is
+ encrypted and a password is necessary. It will be called with no arguments,
+ and it should return a string, bytes, or bytearray. If the return value is
+ a string it will be encoded as UTF-8 before using it to decrypt the key.
+ Alternatively a string, bytes, or bytearray value may be supplied directly
+ as the *password* argument. It will be ignored if the private key is not
+ encrypted and no password is needed.
+
+ If the *password* argument is not specified and a password is required,
+ OpenSSL's built-in password prompting mechanism will be used to
+ interactively prompt the user for a password.
+
An :class:`SSLError` is raised if the private key doesn't
match with the certificate.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ New optional argument *password*.
+
.. method:: SSLContext.load_verify_locations(cafile=None, capath=None)
Load a set of "certification authority" (CA) certificates used to validate
@@ -554,6 +715,38 @@ to speed up repeated connections from the same clients.
when connected, the :meth:`SSLSocket.cipher` method of SSL sockets will
give the currently selected cipher.
+.. method:: SSLContext.load_dh_params(dhfile)
+
+ Load the key generation parameters for Diffie-Helman (DH) key exchange.
+ Using DH key exchange improves forward secrecy at the expense of
+ computational resources (both on the server and on the client).
+ The *dhfile* parameter should be the path to a file containing DH
+ parameters in PEM format.
+
+ This setting doesn't apply to client sockets. You can also use the
+ :data:`OP_SINGLE_DH_USE` option to further improve security.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. method:: SSLContext.set_ecdh_curve(curve_name)
+
+ Set the curve name for Elliptic Curve-based Diffie-Hellman (ECDH) key
+ exchange. ECDH is significantly faster than regular DH while arguably
+ as secure. The *curve_name* parameter should be a string describing
+ a well-known elliptic curve, for example ``prime256v1`` for a widely
+ supported curve.
+
+ This setting doesn't apply to client sockets. You can also use the
+ :data:`OP_SINGLE_ECDH_USE` option to further improve security.
+
+ This method is not available if :data:`HAS_ECDH` is False.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+ .. seealso::
+ `SSL/TLS & Perfect Forward Secrecy <http://vincent.bernat.im/en/blog/2011-ssl-perfect-forward-secrecy.html>`_
+ Vincent Bernat.
+
.. method:: SSLContext.wrap_socket(sock, server_side=False, \
do_handshake_on_connect=True, suppress_ragged_eofs=True, \
server_hostname=None)
@@ -968,13 +1161,10 @@ to be aware of:
try:
sock.do_handshake()
break
- except ssl.SSLError as err:
- if err.args[0] == ssl.SSL_ERROR_WANT_READ:
- select.select([sock], [], [])
- elif err.args[0] == ssl.SSL_ERROR_WANT_WRITE:
- select.select([], [sock], [])
- else:
- raise
+ except ssl.SSLWantReadError:
+ select.select([sock], [], [])
+ except ssl.SSLWantWriteError:
+ select.select([], [sock], [])
.. _ssl-security:
diff --git a/Doc/library/stdtypes.rst b/Doc/library/stdtypes.rst
index 2714633..a2ee932 100644
--- a/Doc/library/stdtypes.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/stdtypes.rst
@@ -15,6 +15,10 @@ interpreter.
The principal built-in types are numerics, sequences, mappings, classes,
instances and exceptions.
+Some collection classes are mutable. The methods that add, subtract, or
+rearrange their members in place, and don't return a specific item, never return
+the collection instance itself but ``None``.
+
Some operations are supported by several object types; in particular,
practically all objects can be compared, tested for truth value, and converted
to a string (with the :func:`repr` function or the slightly different
@@ -998,6 +1002,23 @@ functions based on regular expressions.
rest lowercased.
+.. method:: str.casefold()
+
+ Return a casefolded copy of the string. Casefolded strings may be used for
+ caseless matching.
+
+ Casefolding is similar to lowercasing but more aggressive because it is
+ intended to remove all case distinctions in a string. For example, the German
+ lowercase letter ``'ß'`` is equivalent to ``"ss"``. Since it is already
+ lowercase, :meth:`lower` would do nothing to ``'ß'``; :meth:`casefold`
+ converts it to ``"ss"``.
+
+ The casefolding algorithm is described in section 3.13 of the Unicode
+ Standard.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: str.center(width[, fillchar])
Return centered in a string of length *width*. Padding is done using the
@@ -1205,6 +1226,9 @@ functions based on regular expressions.
Return a copy of the string with all the cased characters [4]_ converted to
lowercase.
+ The lowercasing algorithm used is described in section 3.13 of the Unicode
+ Standard.
+
.. method:: str.lstrip([chars])
@@ -1356,7 +1380,8 @@ functions based on regular expressions.
.. method:: str.swapcase()
Return a copy of the string with uppercase characters converted to lowercase and
- vice versa.
+ vice versa. Note that it is not necessarily true that
+ ``s.swapcase().swapcase() == s``.
.. method:: str.title()
@@ -1407,7 +1432,11 @@ functions based on regular expressions.
Return a copy of the string with all the cased characters [4]_ converted to
uppercase. Note that ``str.upper().isupper()`` might be ``False`` if ``s``
contains uncased characters or if the Unicode category of the resulting
- character(s) is not "Lu" (Letter, uppercase), but e.g. "Lt" (Letter, titlecase).
+ character(s) is not "Lu" (Letter, uppercase), but e.g. "Lt" (Letter,
+ titlecase).
+
+ The uppercasing algorithm used is described in section 3.13 of the Unicode
+ Standard.
.. method:: str.zfill(width)
@@ -1667,6 +1696,8 @@ Note that while lists allow their items to be of any type, bytearray object
single: append() (sequence method)
single: extend() (sequence method)
single: count() (sequence method)
+ single: clear() (sequence method)
+ single: copy() (sequence method)
single: index() (sequence method)
single: insert() (sequence method)
single: pop() (sequence method)
@@ -1698,6 +1729,12 @@ Note that while lists allow their items to be of any type, bytearray object
| ``s.extend(x)`` | same as ``s[len(s):len(s)] = | \(2) |
| | x`` | |
+------------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------+
+| ``s.clear()`` | remove all items from ``s`` | |
+| | | |
++------------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------+
+| ``s.copy()`` | return a shallow copy of ``s`` | |
+| | | |
++------------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------+
| ``s.count(x)`` | return number of *i*'s for | |
| | which ``s[i] == x`` | |
+------------------------------+--------------------------------+---------------------+
@@ -1776,6 +1813,9 @@ Notes:
(8)
:meth:`sort` is not supported by :class:`bytearray` objects.
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ :meth:`clear` and :meth:`!copy` methods.
+
.. _bytes-methods:
@@ -1793,6 +1833,12 @@ the objects to strings, they have a :func:`decode` method.
Wherever one of these methods needs to interpret the bytes as characters
(e.g. the :func:`is...` methods), the ASCII character set is assumed.
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+ The functions :func:`count`, :func:`find`, :func:`index`,
+ :func:`rfind` and :func:`rindex` have additional semantics compared to
+ the corresponding string functions: They also accept an integer in
+ range 0 to 255 (a byte) as their first argument.
+
.. note::
The methods on bytes and bytearray objects don't accept strings as their
@@ -2383,6 +2429,19 @@ copying. Memory is generally interpreted as simple bytes.
Notice how the size of the memoryview object cannot be changed.
+ Memoryviews of hashable (read-only) types are also hashable and their
+ hash value matches the corresponding bytes object::
+
+ >>> v = memoryview(b'abcefg')
+ >>> hash(v) == hash(b'abcefg')
+ True
+ >>> hash(v[2:4]) == hash(b'ce')
+ True
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Memoryview objects are now hashable.
+
+
:class:`memoryview` has several methods:
.. method:: tobytes()
@@ -2698,7 +2757,7 @@ The Null Object
This object is returned by functions that don't explicitly return a value. It
supports no special operations. There is exactly one null object, named
-``None`` (a built-in name).
+``None`` (a built-in name). ``type(None)()`` produces the same singleton.
It is written as ``None``.
@@ -2710,7 +2769,8 @@ The Ellipsis Object
This object is commonly used by slicing (see :ref:`slicings`). It supports no
special operations. There is exactly one ellipsis object, named
-:const:`Ellipsis` (a built-in name).
+:const:`Ellipsis` (a built-in name). ``type(Ellipsis)()`` produces the
+:const:`Ellipsis` singleton.
It is written as ``Ellipsis`` or ``...``.
@@ -2722,7 +2782,8 @@ The NotImplemented Object
This object is returned from comparisons and binary operations when they are
asked to operate on types they don't support. See :ref:`comparisons` for more
-information.
+information. There is exactly one ``NotImplemented`` object.
+``type(NotImplemented)()`` produces the singleton instance.
It is written as ``NotImplemented``.
@@ -2788,6 +2849,13 @@ types, where they are relevant. Some of these are not reported by the
The name of the class or type.
+.. attribute:: class.__qualname__
+
+ The :term:`qualified name` of the class or type.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. attribute:: class.__mro__
This attribute is a tuple of classes that are considered when looking for
diff --git a/Doc/library/struct.rst b/Doc/library/struct.rst
index 12820e0..994506c 100644
--- a/Doc/library/struct.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/struct.rst
@@ -187,17 +187,24 @@ platform-dependent.
| ``Q`` | :c:type:`unsigned long | integer | 8 | \(2), \(3) |
| | long` | | | |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
-| ``f`` | :c:type:`float` | float | 4 | \(4) |
+| ``n`` | :c:type:`ssize_t` | integer | | \(4) |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
-| ``d`` | :c:type:`double` | float | 8 | \(4) |
+| ``N`` | :c:type:`size_t` | integer | | \(4) |
++--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
+| ``f`` | :c:type:`float` | float | 4 | \(5) |
++--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
+| ``d`` | :c:type:`double` | float | 8 | \(5) |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
| ``s`` | :c:type:`char[]` | bytes | | |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
| ``p`` | :c:type:`char[]` | bytes | | |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
-| ``P`` | :c:type:`void \*` | integer | | \(5) |
+| ``P`` | :c:type:`void \*` | integer | | \(6) |
+--------+--------------------------+--------------------+----------------+------------+
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added support for the ``'n'`` and ``'N'`` formats.
+
Notes:
(1)
@@ -219,11 +226,17 @@ Notes:
Use of the :meth:`__index__` method for non-integers is new in 3.2.
(4)
+ The ``'n'`` and ``'N'`` conversion codes are only available for the native
+ size (selected as the default or with the ``'@'`` byte order character).
+ For the standard size, you can use whichever of the other integer formats
+ fits your application.
+
+(5)
For the ``'f'`` and ``'d'`` conversion codes, the packed representation uses
the IEEE 754 binary32 (for ``'f'``) or binary64 (for ``'d'``) format,
regardless of the floating-point format used by the platform.
-(5)
+(6)
The ``'P'`` format character is only available for the native byte ordering
(selected as the default or with the ``'@'`` byte order character). The byte
order character ``'='`` chooses to use little- or big-endian ordering based
diff --git a/Doc/library/subprocess.rst b/Doc/library/subprocess.rst
index 97c0e03..427e4a0 100644
--- a/Doc/library/subprocess.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/subprocess.rst
@@ -30,16 +30,21 @@ convenience functions for all use cases they can handle. For more advanced
use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
-.. function:: call(args, *, stdin=None, stdout=None, stderr=None, shell=False)
+.. function:: call(args, *, stdin=None, stdout=None, stderr=None, shell=False, timeout=None)
Run the command described by *args*. Wait for command to complete, then
return the :attr:`returncode` attribute.
The arguments shown above are merely the most common ones, described below
- in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the slightly odd notation in
- the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is the same as
- that of the :class:`Popen` constructor - this functions passes all
- supplied arguments directly through to that interface.
+ in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the use of keyword-only notation
+ in the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is largely the
+ same as that of the :class:`Popen` constructor - this function passes all
+ supplied arguments other than *timeout* directly through to that interface.
+
+ The *timeout* argument is passed to :meth:`Popen.wait`. If the timeout
+ expires, the child process will be killed and then waited for again. The
+ :exc:`TimeoutExpired` exception will be re-raised after the child process
+ has terminated.
Examples::
@@ -62,8 +67,11 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
process may block if it generates enough output to a pipe to fill up
the OS pipe buffer.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timeout* was added.
+
-.. function:: check_call(args, *, stdin=None, stdout=None, stderr=None, shell=False)
+.. function:: check_call(args, *, stdin=None, stdout=None, stderr=None, shell=False, timeout=None)
Run command with arguments. Wait for command to complete. If the return
code was zero then return, otherwise raise :exc:`CalledProcessError`. The
@@ -71,10 +79,15 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
:attr:`returncode` attribute.
The arguments shown above are merely the most common ones, described below
- in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the slightly odd notation in
- the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is the same as
- that of the :class:`Popen` constructor - this functions passes all
- supplied arguments directly through to that interface.
+ in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the use of keyword-only notation
+ in the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is largely the
+ same as that of the :class:`Popen` constructor - this function passes all
+ supplied arguments other than *timeout* directly through to that interface.
+
+ The *timeout* argument is passed to :meth:`Popen.wait`. If the timeout
+ expires, the child process will be killed and then waited for again. The
+ :exc:`TimeoutExpired` exception will be re-raised after the child process
+ has terminated.
Examples::
@@ -86,8 +99,6 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
...
subprocess.CalledProcessError: Command 'exit 1' returned non-zero exit status 1
- .. versionadded:: 2.5
-
.. warning::
Invoking the system shell with ``shell=True`` can be a security hazard
@@ -101,8 +112,11 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
process may block if it generates enough output to a pipe to fill up
the OS pipe buffer.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timeout* was added.
+
-.. function:: check_output(args, *, stdin=None, stderr=None, shell=False, universal_newlines=False)
+.. function:: check_output(args, *, stdin=None, stderr=None, shell=False, universal_newlines=False, timeout=None)
Run command with arguments and return its output as a byte string.
@@ -112,11 +126,17 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
attribute.
The arguments shown above are merely the most common ones, described below
- in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the slightly odd notation in
- the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is largely the
- same as that of the :class:`Popen` constructor, except that *stdout* is
- not permitted as it is used internally. All other supplied arguments are
- passed directly through to the :class:`Popen` constructor.
+ in :ref:`frequently-used-arguments` (hence the use of keyword-only notation
+ in the abbreviated signature). The full function signature is largely the
+ same as that of the :class:`Popen` constructor - this functions passes all
+ supplied arguments other than *timeout* directly through to that interface.
+ In addition, *stdout* is not permitted as an argument, as it is used
+ internally to collect the output from the subprocess.
+
+ The *timeout* argument is passed to :meth:`Popen.wait`. If the timeout
+ expires, the child process will be killed and then waited for again. The
+ :exc:`TimeoutExpired` exception will be re-raised after the child process
+ has terminated.
Examples::
@@ -147,7 +167,7 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
... shell=True)
'ls: non_existent_file: No such file or directory\n'
- .. versionadded:: 2.7
+ .. versionadded:: 3.1
.. warning::
@@ -161,6 +181,18 @@ use cases, the underlying :class:`Popen` interface can be used directly.
read in the current process, the child process may block if it
generates enough output to the pipe to fill up the OS pipe buffer.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timeout* was added.
+
+
+.. data:: DEVNULL
+
+ Special value that can be used as the *stdin*, *stdout* or *stderr* argument
+ to :class:`Popen` and indicates that the special file :data:`os.devnull`
+ will be used.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. data:: PIPE
@@ -196,13 +228,14 @@ default values. The arguments that are most commonly needed are:
*stdin*, *stdout* and *stderr* specify the executed program's standard input,
standard output and standard error file handles, respectively. Valid values
- are :data:`PIPE`, an existing file descriptor (a positive integer), an
- existing file object, and ``None``. :data:`PIPE` indicates that a new pipe
- to the child should be created. With the default settings of ``None``, no
- redirection will occur; the child's file handles will be inherited from the
- parent. Additionally, *stderr* can be :data:`STDOUT`, which indicates that
- the stderr data from the child process should be captured into the same file
- handle as for stdout.
+ are :data:`PIPE`, :data:`DEVNULL`, an existing file descriptor (a positive
+ integer), an existing file object, and ``None``. :data:`PIPE` indicates
+ that a new pipe to the child should be created. :data:`DEVNULL` indicates
+ that the special file :data:`os.devnull` will be used. With the default
+ settings of ``None``, no redirection will occur; the child's file handles
+ will be inherited from the parent. Additionally, *stderr* can be
+ :data:`STDOUT`, which indicates that the stderr data from the child
+ process should be captured into the same file handle as for *stdout*.
When *stdout* or *stderr* are pipes and *universal_newlines* is
:const:`True` then the output data is assumed to be encoded as UTF-8 and
@@ -331,13 +364,14 @@ functions.
*stdin*, *stdout* and *stderr* specify the executed program's standard input,
standard output and standard error file handles, respectively. Valid values
- are :data:`PIPE`, an existing file descriptor (a positive integer), an
- existing :term:`file object`, and ``None``. :data:`PIPE` indicates that a
- new pipe to the child should be created. With the default settings of
- ``None``, no redirection will occur; the child's file handles will be
- inherited from the parent. Additionally, *stderr* can be :data:`STDOUT`,
- which indicates that the stderr data from the applications should be
- captured into the same file handle as for stdout.
+ are :data:`PIPE`, :data:`DEVNULL`, an existing file descriptor (a positive
+ integer), an existing :term:`file object`, and ``None``. :data:`PIPE`
+ indicates that a new pipe to the child should be created. :data:`DEVNULL`
+ indicates that the special file :data:`os.devnull` will be used. With the
+ default settings of ``None``, no redirection will occur; the child's file
+ handles will be inherited from the parent. Additionally, *stderr* can be
+ :data:`STDOUT`, which indicates that the stderr data from the applications
+ should be captured into the same file handle as for stdout.
If *preexec_fn* is set to a callable object, this object will be called in the
child process just before the child is executed.
@@ -456,6 +490,15 @@ arguments.
:exc:`CalledProcessError` if the called process returns a non-zero return
code.
+All of the functions and methods that accept a *timeout* parameter, such as
+:func:`call` and :meth:`Popen.communicate` will raise :exc:`TimeoutExpired` if
+the timeout expires before the process exits.
+
+Exceptions defined in this module all inherit from :exc:`SubprocessError`.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+ The :exc:`SubprocessError` base class was added.
+
Security
^^^^^^^^
@@ -479,11 +522,15 @@ Instances of the :class:`Popen` class have the following methods:
attribute.
-.. method:: Popen.wait()
+.. method:: Popen.wait(timeout=None)
Wait for child process to terminate. Set and return :attr:`returncode`
attribute.
+ If the process does not terminate after *timeout* seconds, raise a
+ :exc:`TimeoutExpired` exception. It is safe to catch this exception and
+ retry the wait.
+
.. warning::
This will deadlock when using ``stdout=PIPE`` and/or
@@ -491,13 +538,17 @@ Instances of the :class:`Popen` class have the following methods:
a pipe such that it blocks waiting for the OS pipe buffer to
accept more data. Use :meth:`communicate` to avoid that.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timeout* was added.
-.. method:: Popen.communicate(input=None)
+
+.. method:: Popen.communicate(input=None, timeout=None)
Interact with process: Send data to stdin. Read data from stdout and stderr,
- until end-of-file is reached. Wait for process to terminate. The optional
- *input* argument should be a byte string to be sent to the child process, or
- ``None``, if no data should be sent to the child.
+ until end-of-file is reached. Wait for process to terminate. The optional
+ *input* argument should be data to be sent to the child process, or
+ ``None``, if no data should be sent to the child. The type of *input*
+ must be bytes or, if *universal_newlines* was ``True``, a string.
:meth:`communicate` returns a tuple ``(stdoutdata, stderrdata)``.
@@ -506,11 +557,29 @@ Instances of the :class:`Popen` class have the following methods:
``None`` in the result tuple, you need to give ``stdout=PIPE`` and/or
``stderr=PIPE`` too.
+ If the process does not terminate after *timeout* seconds, a
+ :exc:`TimeoutExpired` exception will be raised. Catching this exception and
+ retrying communication will not lose any output.
+
+ The child process is not killed if the timeout expires, so in order to
+ cleanup properly a well-behaved application should kill the child process and
+ finish communication::
+
+ proc = subprocess.Popen(...)
+ try:
+ outs, errs = proc.communicate(timeout=15)
+ except TimeoutExpired:
+ proc.kill()
+ outs, errs = proc.communicate()
+
.. note::
The data read is buffered in memory, so do not use this method if the data
size is large or unlimited.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ *timeout* was added.
+
.. method:: Popen.send_signal(signal)
@@ -952,3 +1021,9 @@ runtime):
backslash. If the number of backslashes is odd, the last
backslash escapes the next double quotation mark as
described in rule 3.
+
+
+.. seealso::
+
+ :mod:`shlex`
+ Module which provides function to parse and escape command lines.
diff --git a/Doc/library/sys.rst b/Doc/library/sys.rst
index d611acf..c2b7423 100644
--- a/Doc/library/sys.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/sys.rst
@@ -235,14 +235,13 @@ always available.
.. data:: flags
- The struct sequence *flags* exposes the status of command line flags. The
- attributes are read only.
+ The :term:`struct sequence` *flags* exposes the status of command line
+ flags. The attributes are read only.
============================= =============================
attribute flag
============================= =============================
:const:`debug` :option:`-d`
- :const:`division_warning` :option:`-Q`
:const:`inspect` :option:`-i`
:const:`interactive` :option:`-i`
:const:`optimize` :option:`-O` or :option:`-OO`
@@ -258,15 +257,18 @@ always available.
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Added ``quiet`` attribute for the new :option:`-q` flag.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Removed obsolete ``division_warning`` attribute.
+
.. data:: float_info
- A structseq holding information about the float type. It contains low level
- information about the precision and internal representation. The values
- correspond to the various floating-point constants defined in the standard
- header file :file:`float.h` for the 'C' programming language; see section
- 5.2.4.2.2 of the 1999 ISO/IEC C standard [C99]_, 'Characteristics of
- floating types', for details.
+ A :term:`struct sequence` holding information about the float type. It
+ contains low level information about the precision and internal
+ representation. The values correspond to the various floating-point
+ constants defined in the standard header file :file:`float.h` for the 'C'
+ programming language; see section 5.2.4.2.2 of the 1999 ISO/IEC C standard
+ [C99]_, 'Characteristics of floating types', for details.
+---------------------+----------------+--------------------------------------------------+
| attribute | float.h macro | explanation |
@@ -516,8 +518,9 @@ always available.
.. data:: hash_info
- A structseq giving parameters of the numeric hash implementation. For
- more details about hashing of numeric types, see :ref:`numeric-hash`.
+ A :term:`struct sequence` giving parameters of the numeric hash
+ implementation. For more details about hashing of numeric types, see
+ :ref:`numeric-hash`.
+---------------------+--------------------------------------------------+
| attribute | explanation |
@@ -552,8 +555,8 @@ always available.
This is called ``hexversion`` since it only really looks meaningful when viewed
as the result of passing it to the built-in :func:`hex` function. The
- struct sequence :data:`sys.version_info` may be used for a more human-friendly
- encoding of the same information.
+ :term:`struct sequence` :data:`sys.version_info` may be used for a more
+ human-friendly encoding of the same information.
The ``hexversion`` is a 32-bit number with the following layout:
@@ -581,8 +584,8 @@ always available.
.. data:: int_info
- A struct sequence that holds information about Python's
- internal representation of integers. The attributes are read only.
+ A :term:`struct sequence` that holds information about Python's internal
+ representation of integers. The attributes are read only.
+-------------------------+----------------------------------------------+
| Attribute | Explanation |
@@ -637,9 +640,13 @@ always available.
.. data:: maxunicode
- An integer giving the largest supported code point for a Unicode character. The
- value of this depends on the configuration option that specifies whether Unicode
- characters are stored as UCS-2 or UCS-4.
+ An integer giving the value of the largest Unicode code point,
+ i.e. ``1114111`` (``0x10FFFF`` in hexadecimal).
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Before :pep:`393`, ``sys.maxunicode`` used to be either ``0xFFFF``
+ or ``0x10FFFF``, depending on the configuration option that specified
+ whether Unicode characters were stored as UCS-2 or UCS-4.
.. data:: meta_path
@@ -714,36 +721,35 @@ always available.
This string contains a platform identifier that can be used to append
platform-specific components to :data:`sys.path`, for instance.
- For most Unix systems, this is the lowercased OS name as returned by ``uname
- -s`` with the first part of the version as returned by ``uname -r`` appended,
- e.g. ``'sunos5'``, *at the time when Python was built*. Unless you want to
- test for a specific system version, it is therefore recommended to use the
- following idiom::
+ For Unix systems, except on Linux, this is the lowercased OS name as
+ returned by ``uname -s`` with the first part of the version as returned by
+ ``uname -r`` appended, e.g. ``'sunos5'`` or ``'freebsd8'``, *at the time
+ when Python was built*. Unless you want to test for a specific system
+ version, it is therefore recommended to use the following idiom::
if sys.platform.startswith('freebsd'):
# FreeBSD-specific code here...
elif sys.platform.startswith('linux'):
# Linux-specific code here...
- .. versionchanged:: 3.2.2
- Since lots of code check for ``sys.platform == 'linux2'``, and there is
- no essential change between Linux 2.x and 3.x, ``sys.platform`` is always
- set to ``'linux2'``, even on Linux 3.x. In Python 3.3 and later, the
- value will always be set to ``'linux'``, so it is recommended to always
- use the ``startswith`` idiom presented above.
-
For other systems, the values are:
- ====================== ===========================
- System :data:`platform` value
- ====================== ===========================
- Linux (2.x *and* 3.x) ``'linux2'``
- Windows ``'win32'``
- Windows/Cygwin ``'cygwin'``
- Mac OS X ``'darwin'``
- OS/2 ``'os2'``
- OS/2 EMX ``'os2emx'``
- ====================== ===========================
+ ================ ===========================
+ System :data:`platform` value
+ ================ ===========================
+ Linux ``'linux'``
+ Windows ``'win32'``
+ Windows/Cygwin ``'cygwin'``
+ Mac OS X ``'darwin'``
+ OS/2 ``'os2'``
+ OS/2 EMX ``'os2emx'``
+ ================ ===========================
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ On Linux, :attr:`sys.platform` doesn't contain the major version anymore.
+ It is always ``'linux'``, instead of ``'linux2'`` or ``'linux3'``. Since
+ older Python versions include the version number, it is recommended to
+ always use the ``startswith`` idiom presented above.
.. seealso::
:attr:`os.name` has a coarser granularity. :func:`os.uname` gives
@@ -752,6 +758,7 @@ always available.
The :mod:`platform` module provides detailed checks for the
system's identity.
+
.. data:: prefix
A string giving the site-specific directory prefix where the platform
@@ -800,11 +807,11 @@ always available.
the interpreter loads extension modules. Among other things, this will enable a
lazy resolving of symbols when importing a module, if called as
``sys.setdlopenflags(0)``. To share symbols across extension modules, call as
- ``sys.setdlopenflags(ctypes.RTLD_GLOBAL)``. Symbolic names for the
- flag modules can be either found in the :mod:`ctypes` module, or in the :mod:`DLFCN`
- module. If :mod:`DLFCN` is not available, it can be generated from
- :file:`/usr/include/dlfcn.h` using the :program:`h2py` script. Availability:
- Unix.
+ ``sys.setdlopenflags(os.RTLD_GLOBAL)``. Symbolic names for the flag modules
+ can be found in the :mod:`os` module (``RTLD_xxx`` constants, e.g.
+ :data:`os.RTLD_LAZY`).
+
+ Availability: Unix.
.. function:: setprofile(profilefunc)
@@ -997,22 +1004,33 @@ always available.
to a console and Python apps started with :program:`pythonw`.
-.. data:: subversion
+.. data:: thread_info
- A triple (repo, branch, version) representing the Subversion information of the
- Python interpreter. *repo* is the name of the repository, ``'CPython'``.
- *branch* is a string of one of the forms ``'trunk'``, ``'branches/name'`` or
- ``'tags/name'``. *version* is the output of ``svnversion``, if the interpreter
- was built from a Subversion checkout; it contains the revision number (range)
- and possibly a trailing 'M' if there were local modifications. If the tree was
- exported (or svnversion was not available), it is the revision of
- ``Include/patchlevel.h`` if the branch is a tag. Otherwise, it is ``None``.
+ A :term:`struct sequence` holding information about the thread
+ implementation.
- .. deprecated:: 3.2.1
- Python is now `developed <http://docs.python.org/devguide/>`_ using
- Mercurial. In recent Python 3.2 bugfix releases, :data:`subversion`
- therefore contains placeholder information. It is removed in Python
- 3.3.
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------------------+
+ | Attribute | Explanation |
+ +==================+=========================================================+
+ | :const:`name` | Name of the thread implementation: |
+ | | |
+ | | * ``'nt'``: Windows threads |
+ | | * ``'os2'``: OS/2 threads |
+ | | * ``'pthread'``: POSIX threads |
+ | | * ``'solaris'``: Solaris threads |
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------------------+
+ | :const:`lock` | Name of the lock implementation: |
+ | | |
+ | | * ``'semaphore'``: a lock uses a semaphore |
+ | | * ``'mutex+cond'``: a lock uses a mutex |
+ | | and a condition variable |
+ | | * ``None`` if this information is unknown |
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------------------+
+ | :const:`version` | Name and version of the thread library. It is a string, |
+ | | or ``None`` if these informations are unknown. |
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------------------+
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
.. data:: tracebacklimit
diff --git a/Doc/library/tarfile.rst b/Doc/library/tarfile.rst
index 46e4900..92e9df7 100644
--- a/Doc/library/tarfile.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/tarfile.rst
@@ -13,13 +13,13 @@
--------------
The :mod:`tarfile` module makes it possible to read and write tar
-archives, including those using gzip or bz2 compression.
+archives, including those using gzip, bz2 and lzma compression.
Use the :mod:`zipfile` module to read or write :file:`.zip` files, or the
higher-level functions in :ref:`shutil <archiving-operations>`.
Some facts and figures:
-* reads and writes :mod:`gzip` and :mod:`bz2` compressed archives.
+* reads and writes :mod:`gzip`, :mod:`bz2` and :mod:`lzma` compressed archives.
* read/write support for the POSIX.1-1988 (ustar) format.
@@ -33,6 +33,9 @@ Some facts and figures:
character devices and block devices and is able to acquire and restore file
information like timestamp, access permissions and owner.
+.. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added support for :mod:`lzma` compression.
+
.. function:: open(name=None, mode='r', fileobj=None, bufsize=10240, \*\*kwargs)
@@ -56,6 +59,8 @@ Some facts and figures:
+------------------+---------------------------------------------+
| ``'r:bz2'`` | Open for reading with bzip2 compression. |
+------------------+---------------------------------------------+
+ | ``'r:xz'`` | Open for reading with lzma compression. |
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------+
| ``'a' or 'a:'`` | Open for appending with no compression. The |
| | file is created if it does not exist. |
+------------------+---------------------------------------------+
@@ -65,11 +70,13 @@ Some facts and figures:
+------------------+---------------------------------------------+
| ``'w:bz2'`` | Open for bzip2 compressed writing. |
+------------------+---------------------------------------------+
+ | ``'w:xz'`` | Open for lzma compressed writing. |
+ +------------------+---------------------------------------------+
- Note that ``'a:gz'`` or ``'a:bz2'`` is not possible. If *mode* is not suitable
- to open a certain (compressed) file for reading, :exc:`ReadError` is raised. Use
- *mode* ``'r'`` to avoid this. If a compression method is not supported,
- :exc:`CompressionError` is raised.
+ Note that ``'a:gz'``, ``'a:bz2'`` or ``'a:xz'`` is not possible. If *mode*
+ is not suitable to open a certain (compressed) file for reading,
+ :exc:`ReadError` is raised. Use *mode* ``'r'`` to avoid this. If a
+ compression method is not supported, :exc:`CompressionError` is raised.
If *fileobj* is specified, it is used as an alternative to a :term:`file object`
opened in binary mode for *name*. It is supposed to be at position 0.
@@ -100,6 +107,9 @@ Some facts and figures:
| ``'r|bz2'`` | Open a bzip2 compressed *stream* for |
| | reading. |
+-------------+--------------------------------------------+
+ | ``'r|xz'`` | Open a lzma compressed *stream* for |
+ | | reading. |
+ +-------------+--------------------------------------------+
| ``'w|'`` | Open an uncompressed *stream* for writing. |
+-------------+--------------------------------------------+
| ``'w|gz'`` | Open a gzip compressed *stream* for |
@@ -108,6 +118,9 @@ Some facts and figures:
| ``'w|bz2'`` | Open a bzip2 compressed *stream* for |
| | writing. |
+-------------+--------------------------------------------+
+ | ``'w|xz'`` | Open an lzma compressed *stream* for |
+ | | writing. |
+ +-------------+--------------------------------------------+
.. class:: TarFile
@@ -263,9 +276,9 @@ be finalized; only the internally used file object will be closed. See the
If *errorlevel* is ``0``, all errors are ignored when using :meth:`TarFile.extract`.
Nevertheless, they appear as error messages in the debug output, when debugging
- is enabled. If ``1``, all *fatal* errors are raised as :exc:`OSError` or
- :exc:`IOError` exceptions. If ``2``, all *non-fatal* errors are raised as
- :exc:`TarError` exceptions as well.
+ is enabled. If ``1``, all *fatal* errors are raised as :exc:`OSError`
+ exceptions. If ``2``, all *non-fatal* errors are raised as :exc:`TarError`
+ exceptions as well.
The *encoding* and *errors* arguments define the character encoding to be
used for reading or writing the archive and how conversion errors are going
diff --git a/Doc/library/telnetlib.rst b/Doc/library/telnetlib.rst
index 646634d..9bc79c5 100644
--- a/Doc/library/telnetlib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/telnetlib.rst
@@ -162,9 +162,13 @@ Telnet Objects
.. method:: Telnet.write(buffer)
Write a byte string to the socket, doubling any IAC characters. This can
- block if the connection is blocked. May raise :exc:`socket.error` if the
+ block if the connection is blocked. May raise :exc:`OSError` if the
connection is closed.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This method used to raise :exc:`socket.error`, which is now an alias
+ of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. method:: Telnet.interact()
diff --git a/Doc/library/tempfile.rst b/Doc/library/tempfile.rst
index fff6c4e..dfeb250 100644
--- a/Doc/library/tempfile.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/tempfile.rst
@@ -25,7 +25,7 @@ instead a string of six random characters is used.
Also, all the user-callable functions now take additional arguments which
allow direct control over the location and name of temporary files. It is
-no longer necessary to use the global *tempdir* and *template* variables.
+no longer necessary to use the global *tempdir* variable.
To maintain backward compatibility, the argument order is somewhat odd; it
is recommended to use keyword arguments for clarity.
diff --git a/Doc/library/test.rst b/Doc/library/test.rst
index c27ee08..5e4a1cb 100644
--- a/Doc/library/test.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/test.rst
@@ -223,14 +223,14 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following constants:
.. data:: verbose
- :const:`True` when verbose output is enabled. Should be checked when more
+ ``True`` when verbose output is enabled. Should be checked when more
detailed information is desired about a running test. *verbose* is set by
:mod:`test.regrtest`.
.. data:: is_jython
- :const:`True` if the running interpreter is Jython.
+ ``True`` if the running interpreter is Jython.
.. data:: TESTFN
@@ -249,7 +249,7 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
.. function:: is_resource_enabled(resource)
- Return :const:`True` if *resource* is enabled and available. The list of
+ Return ``True`` if *resource* is enabled and available. The list of
available resources is only set when :mod:`test.regrtest` is executing the
tests.
@@ -258,7 +258,7 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
Raise :exc:`ResourceDenied` if *resource* is not available. *msg* is the
argument to :exc:`ResourceDenied` if it is raised. Always returns
- :const:`True` if called by a function whose ``__name__`` is ``'__main__'``.
+ ``True`` if called by a function whose ``__name__`` is ``'__main__'``.
Used when tests are executed by :mod:`test.regrtest`.
@@ -286,6 +286,15 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
This will run all tests defined in the named module.
+.. function:: run_doctest(module, verbosity=None)
+
+ Run :func:`doctest.testmod` on the given *module*. Return
+ ``(failure_count, test_count)``.
+
+ If *verbosity* is ``None``, :func:`doctest.testmod` is run with verbosity
+ set to :data:`verbose`. Otherwise, it is run with verbosity set to
+ ``None``.
+
.. function:: check_warnings(\*filters, quiet=True)
A convenience wrapper for :func:`warnings.catch_warnings()` that makes it
@@ -296,12 +305,12 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
``check_warnings`` accepts 2-tuples of the form ``("message regexp",
WarningCategory)`` as positional arguments. If one or more *filters* are
- provided, or if the optional keyword argument *quiet* is :const:`False`,
+ provided, or if the optional keyword argument *quiet* is ``False``,
it checks to make sure the warnings are as expected: each specified filter
must match at least one of the warnings raised by the enclosed code or the
test fails, and if any warnings are raised that do not match any of the
specified filters the test fails. To disable the first of these checks,
- set *quiet* to :const:`True`.
+ set *quiet* to ``True``.
If no arguments are specified, it defaults to::
@@ -316,7 +325,7 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
representing the most recent warning can also be accessed directly through
the recorder object (see example below). If no warning has been raised,
then any of the attributes that would otherwise be expected on an object
- representing a warning will return :const:`None`.
+ representing a warning will return ``None``.
The recorder object also has a :meth:`reset` method, which clears the
warnings list.
@@ -354,7 +363,7 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
.. function:: captured_stdout()
- This is a context manager that runs the :keyword:`with` statement body using
+ A context manager that runs the :keyword:`with` statement body using
a :class:`StringIO.StringIO` object as sys.stdout. That object can be
retrieved using the ``as`` clause of the :keyword:`with` statement.
@@ -365,6 +374,57 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
assert s.getvalue() == "hello"
+.. function:: temp_cwd(name='tempcwd', quiet=False, path=None)
+
+ A context manager that temporarily changes the current working
+ directory (CWD).
+
+ An existing path may be provided as *path*, in which case this function
+ makes no changes to the file system.
+
+ Otherwise, the new CWD is created in the current directory and it's named
+ *name*. If *quiet* is ``False`` and it's not possible to create or
+ change the CWD, an error is raised. If it's ``True``, only a warning
+ is raised and the original CWD is used.
+
+
+.. function:: temp_umask(umask)
+
+ A context manager that temporarily sets the process umask.
+
+
+.. function:: can_symlink()
+
+ Return ``True`` if the OS supports symbolic links, ``False``
+ otherwise.
+
+
+.. decorator:: skip_unless_symlink()
+
+ A decorator for running tests that require support for symbolic links.
+
+
+.. decorator:: anticipate_failure(condition)
+
+ A decorator to conditionally mark tests with
+ :func:`unittest.expectedFailure`. Any use of this decorator should
+ have an associated comment identifying the relevant tracker issue.
+
+
+.. decorator:: run_with_locale(catstr, *locales)
+
+ A decorator for running a function in a different locale, correctly
+ resetting it after it has finished. *catstr* is the locale category as
+ a string (for example ``"LC_ALL"``). The *locales* passed will be tried
+ sequentially, and the first valid locale will be used.
+
+
+.. function:: make_bad_fd()
+
+ Create an invalid file descriptor by opening and closing a temporary file,
+ and returning its descripor.
+
+
.. function:: import_module(name, deprecated=False)
This function imports and returns the named module. Unlike a normal
@@ -372,7 +432,7 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
cannot be imported.
Module and package deprecation messages are suppressed during this import
- if *deprecated* is :const:`True`.
+ if *deprecated* is ``True``.
.. versionadded:: 3.1
@@ -396,9 +456,9 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
``sys.modules`` when the fresh import is complete.
Module and package deprecation messages are suppressed during this import
- if *deprecated* is :const:`True`.
+ if *deprecated* is ``True``.
- This function will raise :exc:`unittest.SkipTest` is the named module
+ This function will raise :exc:`unittest.SkipTest` if the named module
cannot be imported.
Example use::
@@ -413,6 +473,48 @@ The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following functions:
.. versionadded:: 3.1
+.. function:: bind_port(sock, host=HOST)
+
+ Bind the socket to a free port and return the port number. Relies on
+ ephemeral ports in order to ensure we are using an unbound port. This is
+ important as many tests may be running simultaneously, especially in a
+ buildbot environment. This method raises an exception if the
+ ``sock.family`` is :const:`~socket.AF_INET` and ``sock.type`` is
+ :const:`~socket.SOCK_STREAM`, and the socket has
+ :const:`~socket.SO_REUSEADDR` or :const:`~socket.SO_REUSEPORT` set on it.
+ Tests should never set these socket options for TCP/IP sockets.
+ The only case for setting these options is testing multicasting via
+ multiple UDP sockets.
+
+ Additionally, if the :const:`~socket.SO_EXCLUSIVEADDRUSE` socket option is
+ available (i.e. on Windows), it will be set on the socket. This will
+ prevent anyone else from binding to our host/port for the duration of the
+ test.
+
+
+.. function:: find_unused_port(family=socket.AF_INET, socktype=socket.SOCK_STREAM)
+
+ Returns an unused port that should be suitable for binding. This is
+ achieved by creating a temporary socket with the same family and type as
+ the ``sock`` parameter (default is :const:`~socket.AF_INET`,
+ :const:`~socket.SOCK_STREAM`),
+ and binding it to the specified host address (defaults to ``0.0.0.0``)
+ with the port set to 0, eliciting an unused ephemeral port from the OS.
+ The temporary socket is then closed and deleted, and the ephemeral port is
+ returned.
+
+ Either this method or :func:`bind_port` should be used for any tests
+ where a server socket needs to be bound to a particular port for the
+ duration of the test.
+ Which one to use depends on whether the calling code is creating a python
+ socket, or if an unused port needs to be provided in a constructor
+ or passed to an external program (i.e. the ``-accept`` argument to
+ openssl's s_server mode). Always prefer :func:`bind_port` over
+ :func:`find_unused_port` where possible. Using a hard coded port is
+ discouraged since it can makes multiple instances of the test impossible to
+ run simultaneously, which is a problem for buildbots.
+
+
The :mod:`test.support` module defines the following classes:
.. class:: TransientResource(exc, **kwargs)
diff --git a/Doc/library/threading.rst b/Doc/library/threading.rst
index 9b3affd..2b43ee5 100644
--- a/Doc/library/threading.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/threading.rst
@@ -20,17 +20,6 @@ The :mod:`dummy_threading` module is provided for situations where
methods and functions in this module in the Python 2.x series are still
supported by this module.
-.. impl-detail::
-
- Due to the :term:`Global Interpreter Lock`, in CPython only one thread
- can execute Python code at once (even though certain performance-oriented
- libraries might overcome this limitation).
- If you want your application to make better of use of the computational
- resources of multi-core machines, you are advised to use
- :mod:`multiprocessing` or :class:`concurrent.futures.ProcessPoolExecutor`.
- However, threading is still an appropriate model if you want to run
- multiple I/O-bound tasks simultaneously.
-
This module defines the following functions and objects:
@@ -59,6 +48,17 @@ This module defines the following functions and objects:
returned.
+.. function:: get_ident()
+
+ Return the 'thread identifier' of the current thread. This is a nonzero
+ integer. Its value has no direct meaning; it is intended as a magic cookie
+ to be used e.g. to index a dictionary of thread-specific data. Thread
+ identifiers may be recycled when a thread exits and another thread is
+ created.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: enumerate()
Return a list of all :class:`Thread` objects currently alive. The list
@@ -241,7 +241,7 @@ changed through the :attr:`name` attribute.
A thread can be flagged as a "daemon thread". The significance of this flag is
that the entire Python program exits when only daemon threads are left. The
initial value is inherited from the creating thread. The flag can be set
-through the :attr:`daemon` property.
+through the :attr:`daemon` property or the *daemon* constructor argument.
There is a "main thread" object; this corresponds to the initial thread of
control in the Python program. It is not a daemon thread.
@@ -254,7 +254,8 @@ daemonic, and cannot be :meth:`join`\ ed. They are never deleted, since it is
impossible to detect the termination of alien threads.
-.. class:: Thread(group=None, target=None, name=None, args=(), kwargs={})
+.. class:: Thread(group=None, target=None, name=None, args=(), kwargs={},
+ verbose=None, *, daemon=None)
This constructor should always be called with keyword arguments. Arguments
are:
@@ -273,10 +274,19 @@ impossible to detect the termination of alien threads.
*kwargs* is a dictionary of keyword arguments for the target invocation.
Defaults to ``{}``.
+ *verbose* is a flag used for debugging messages.
+
+ If not ``None``, *daemon* explicitly sets whether the thread is daemonic.
+ If ``None`` (the default), the daemonic property is inherited from the
+ current thread.
+
If the subclass overrides the constructor, it must make sure to invoke the
base class constructor (``Thread.__init__()``) before doing anything else to
the thread.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *daemon* argument.
+
.. method:: start()
Start the thread's activity.
@@ -333,10 +343,10 @@ impossible to detect the termination of alien threads.
.. attribute:: ident
The 'thread identifier' of this thread or ``None`` if the thread has not
- been started. This is a nonzero integer. See the
- :func:`thread.get_ident()` function. Thread identifiers may be recycled
- when a thread exits and another thread is created. The identifier is
- available even after the thread has exited.
+ been started. This is a nonzero integer. See the :func:`get_ident()`
+ function. Thread identifiers may be recycled when a thread exits and
+ another thread is created. The identifier is available even after the
+ thread has exited.
.. method:: is_alive()
@@ -364,6 +374,18 @@ impossible to detect the termination of alien threads.
property instead.
+.. impl-detail::
+
+ Due to the :term:`Global Interpreter Lock`, in CPython only one thread
+ can execute Python code at once (even though certain performance-oriented
+ libraries might overcome this limitation).
+ If you want your application to make better of use of the computational
+ resources of multi-core machines, you are advised to use
+ :mod:`multiprocessing` or :class:`concurrent.futures.ProcessPoolExecutor`.
+ However, threading is still an appropriate model if you want to run
+ multiple I/O-bound tasks simultaneously.
+
+
.. _lock-objects:
Lock Objects
diff --git a/Doc/library/time.rst b/Doc/library/time.rst
index 7c464ac..7865b5a 100644
--- a/Doc/library/time.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/time.rst
@@ -41,25 +41,6 @@ An explanation of some terminology and conventions is in order.
parsed, they are converted according to the POSIX and ISO C standards: values
69--99 are mapped to 1969--1999, and values 0--68 are mapped to 2000--2068.
- For backward compatibility, years with less than 4 digits are treated
- specially by :func:`asctime`, :func:`mktime`, and :func:`strftime` functions
- that operate on a 9-tuple or :class:`struct_time` values. If year (the first
- value in the 9-tuple) is specified with less than 4 digits, its interpretation
- depends on the value of ``accept2dyear`` variable.
-
- If ``accept2dyear`` is true (default), a backward compatibility behavior is
- invoked as follows:
-
- - for 2-digit year, century is guessed according to POSIX rules for
- ``%y`` strptime format. A deprecation warning is issued when century
- information is guessed in this way.
-
- - for 3-digit or negative year, a :exc:`ValueError` exception is raised.
-
- If ``accept2dyear`` is false (set by the program or as a result of a
- non-empty value assigned to ``PYTHONY2K`` environment variable) all year
- values are interpreted as given.
-
.. index::
single: UTC
single: Coordinated Universal Time
@@ -117,24 +98,6 @@ An explanation of some terminology and conventions is in order.
The module defines the following functions and data items:
-
-.. data:: accept2dyear
-
- Boolean value indicating whether two-digit year values will be
- mapped to 1969--2068 range by :func:`asctime`, :func:`mktime`, and
- :func:`strftime` functions. This is true by default, but will be
- set to false if the environment variable :envvar:`PYTHONY2K` has
- been set to a non-empty string. It may also be modified at run
- time.
-
- .. deprecated:: 3.2
- Mapping of 2-digit year values by :func:`asctime`,
- :func:`mktime`, and :func:`strftime` functions to 1969--2068
- range is deprecated. Programs that need to process 2-digit
- years should use ``%y`` code available in :func:`strptime`
- function or convert 2-digit year values to 4-digit themselves.
-
-
.. data:: altzone
The offset of the local DST timezone, in seconds west of UTC, if one is defined.
@@ -152,7 +115,8 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
.. note::
- Unlike the C function of the same name, there is no trailing newline.
+ Unlike the C function of the same name, :func:`asctime` does not add a
+ trailing newline.
.. function:: clock()
@@ -173,6 +137,53 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
microsecond.
+.. function:: clock_getres(clk_id)
+
+ Return the resolution (precision) of the specified clock *clk_id*.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. function:: clock_gettime(clk_id)
+
+ Return the time of the specified clock *clk_id*.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: CLOCK_REALTIME
+
+ System-wide real-time clock. Setting this clock requires appropriate
+ privileges.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: CLOCK_MONOTONIC
+
+ Clock that cannot be set and represents monotonic time since some
+ unspecified starting point.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: CLOCK_MONOTONIC_RAW
+
+ Similar to :data:`CLOCK_MONOTONIC`, but provides access to a raw
+ hardware-based time that is not subject to NTP adjustments.
+
+ Availability: Linux 2.6.28 or later.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: CLOCK_PROCESS_CPUTIME_ID
+
+ High-resolution per-process timer from the CPU.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+.. data:: CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID
+
+ Thread-specific CPU-time clock.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. function:: ctime([secs])
Convert a time expressed in seconds since the epoch to a string representing
@@ -215,6 +226,14 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
The earliest date for which it can generate a time is platform-dependent.
+.. function:: monotonic()
+
+ Monotonic clock. The reference point of the returned value is undefined so
+ only the difference of consecutive calls is valid.
+
+ .. versionadded: 3.3
+
+
.. function:: sleep(secs)
Suspend execution for the given number of seconds. The argument may be a
@@ -308,7 +327,7 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
| ``%y`` | Year without century as a decimal number | |
| | [00,99]. | |
+-----------+------------------------------------------------+-------+
- | ``%Y`` | Year with century as a decimal number. | \(4) |
+ | ``%Y`` | Year with century as a decimal number. | |
| | | |
+-----------+------------------------------------------------+-------+
| ``%Z`` | Time zone name (no characters if no time zone | |
@@ -332,12 +351,6 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
When used with the :func:`strptime` function, ``%U`` and ``%W`` are only used in
calculations when the day of the week and the year are specified.
- (4)
- Produces different results depending on the value of
- ``time.accept2dyear`` variable. See :ref:`Year 2000 (Y2K)
- issues <time-y2kissues>` for details.
-
-
Here is an example, a format for dates compatible with that specified in the
:rfc:`2822` Internet email standard. [#]_ ::
@@ -418,8 +431,7 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
+-------+-------------------+---------------------------------+
Note that unlike the C structure, the month value is a range of [1, 12], not
- [0, 11]. A year value will be handled as described under :ref:`Year 2000
- (Y2K) issues <time-y2kissues>` above. A ``-1`` argument as the daylight
+ [0, 11]. A ``-1`` argument as the daylight
savings flag, passed to :func:`mktime` will usually result in the correct
daylight savings state to be filled in.
@@ -534,6 +546,20 @@ The module defines the following functions and data items:
('EET', 'EEST')
+.. function:: wallclock()
+
+ .. index::
+ single: Wallclock
+ single: benchmarking
+
+ Return the current time in fractions of a second to the system's best ability.
+ Use this when the most accurate representation of wall-clock is required, i.e.
+ when "processor time" is inappropriate. The reference point of the returned
+ value is undefined so only the difference of consecutive calls is valid.
+
+ .. versionadded: 3.3
+
+
.. seealso::
Module :mod:`datetime`
diff --git a/Doc/library/tokenize.rst b/Doc/library/tokenize.rst
index 70919ca..37d9f41 100644
--- a/Doc/library/tokenize.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/tokenize.rst
@@ -17,9 +17,11 @@ colorizers for on-screen displays.
To simplify token stream handling, all :ref:`operators` and :ref:`delimiters`
tokens are returned using the generic :data:`token.OP` token type. The exact
-type can be determined by checking the token ``string`` field on the
-:term:`named tuple` returned from :func:`tokenize.tokenize` for the character
-sequence that identifies a specific operator token.
+type can be determined by checking the ``exact_type`` property on the
+:term:`named tuple` returned from :func:`tokenize.tokenize`.
+
+Tokenizing Input
+----------------
The primary entry point is a :term:`generator`:
@@ -39,9 +41,17 @@ The primary entry point is a :term:`generator`:
returned as a :term:`named tuple` with the field names:
``type string start end line``.
+ The returned :term:`named tuple` has a additional property named
+ ``exact_type`` that contains the exact operator type for
+ :data:`token.OP` tokens. For all other token types ``exact_type``
+ equals the named tuple ``type`` field.
+
.. versionchanged:: 3.1
Added support for named tuples.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added support for ``exact_type``.
+
:func:`tokenize` determines the source encoding of the file by looking for a
UTF-8 BOM or encoding cookie, according to :pep:`263`.
@@ -122,6 +132,38 @@ function it uses to do this is available:
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+.. _tokenize-cli:
+
+Command-Line Usage
+------------------
+
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+The :mod:`tokenize` module can be executed as a script from the command line.
+It is as simple as:
+
+.. code-block:: sh
+
+ python -m tokenize [-e] [filename.py]
+
+The following options are accepted:
+
+.. program:: tokenize
+
+.. cmdoption:: -h, --help
+
+ show this help message and exit
+
+.. cmdoption:: -e, --exact
+
+ display token names using the exact type
+
+If :file:`filename.py` is specified its contents are tokenized to stdout.
+Otherwise, tokenization is performed on stdin.
+
+Examples
+------------------
+
Example of a script rewriter that transforms float literals into Decimal
objects::
@@ -164,3 +206,63 @@ objects::
result.append((toknum, tokval))
return untokenize(result).decode('utf-8')
+Example of tokenizing from the command line. The script::
+
+ def say_hello():
+ print("Hello, World!")
+
+ say_hello()
+
+will be tokenized to the following output where the first column is the range
+of the line/column coordinates where the token is found, the second column is
+the name of the token, and the final column is the value of the token (if any)
+
+.. code-block:: sh
+
+ $ python -m tokenize hello.py
+ 0,0-0,0: ENCODING 'utf-8'
+ 1,0-1,3: NAME 'def'
+ 1,4-1,13: NAME 'say_hello'
+ 1,13-1,14: OP '('
+ 1,14-1,15: OP ')'
+ 1,15-1,16: OP ':'
+ 1,16-1,17: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 2,0-2,4: INDENT ' '
+ 2,4-2,9: NAME 'print'
+ 2,9-2,10: OP '('
+ 2,10-2,25: STRING '"Hello, World!"'
+ 2,25-2,26: OP ')'
+ 2,26-2,27: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 3,0-3,1: NL '\n'
+ 4,0-4,0: DEDENT ''
+ 4,0-4,9: NAME 'say_hello'
+ 4,9-4,10: OP '('
+ 4,10-4,11: OP ')'
+ 4,11-4,12: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 5,0-5,0: ENDMARKER ''
+
+The exact token type names can be displayed using the ``-e`` option:
+
+.. code-block:: sh
+
+ $ python -m tokenize -e hello.py
+ 0,0-0,0: ENCODING 'utf-8'
+ 1,0-1,3: NAME 'def'
+ 1,4-1,13: NAME 'say_hello'
+ 1,13-1,14: LPAR '('
+ 1,14-1,15: RPAR ')'
+ 1,15-1,16: COLON ':'
+ 1,16-1,17: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 2,0-2,4: INDENT ' '
+ 2,4-2,9: NAME 'print'
+ 2,9-2,10: LPAR '('
+ 2,10-2,25: STRING '"Hello, World!"'
+ 2,25-2,26: RPAR ')'
+ 2,26-2,27: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 3,0-3,1: NL '\n'
+ 4,0-4,0: DEDENT ''
+ 4,0-4,9: NAME 'say_hello'
+ 4,9-4,10: LPAR '('
+ 4,10-4,11: RPAR ')'
+ 4,11-4,12: NEWLINE '\n'
+ 5,0-5,0: ENDMARKER ''
diff --git a/Doc/library/unicodedata.rst b/Doc/library/unicodedata.rst
index 42400df..f912fe8 100644
--- a/Doc/library/unicodedata.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/unicodedata.rst
@@ -29,6 +29,9 @@ following functions:
Look up character by name. If a character with the given name is found, return
the corresponding character. If not found, :exc:`KeyError` is raised.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Support for name aliases [#]_ and named sequences [#]_ has been added.
+
.. function:: name(chr[, default])
@@ -160,3 +163,9 @@ Examples:
>>> unicodedata.bidirectional('\u0660') # 'A'rabic, 'N'umber
'AN'
+
+.. rubric:: Footnotes
+
+.. [#] http://www.unicode.org/Public/6.0.0/ucd/NameAliases.txt
+
+.. [#] http://www.unicode.org/Public/6.0.0/ucd/NamedSequences.txt
diff --git a/Doc/library/unittest.rst b/Doc/library/unittest.rst
index bdf07a4..8938312 100644
--- a/Doc/library/unittest.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/unittest.rst
@@ -792,11 +792,14 @@ Test cases
Run the test, collecting the result into the test result object passed as
*result*. If *result* is omitted or ``None``, a temporary result
object is created (by calling the :meth:`defaultTestResult` method) and
- used. The result object is not returned to :meth:`run`'s caller.
+ used. The result object is returned to :meth:`run`'s caller.
The same effect may be had by simply calling the :class:`TestCase`
instance.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Previous versions of ``run`` did not return the result. Neither did
+ calling an instance.
.. method:: skipTest(reason)
@@ -857,10 +860,11 @@ Test cases
| <TestCase.assertNotIsInstance>` | | |
+-----------------------------------------+-----------------------------+---------------+
- All the assert methods (except :meth:`assertRaises`,
- :meth:`assertRaisesRegex`, :meth:`assertWarns`, :meth:`assertWarnsRegex`)
- accept a *msg* argument that, if specified, is used as the error message on
- failure (see also :data:`longMessage`).
+ All the assert methods accept a *msg* argument that, if specified, is used
+ as the error message on failure (see also :data:`longMessage`).
+ Note that the *msg* keyword argument can be passed to :meth:`assertRaises`,
+ :meth:`assertRaisesRegex`, :meth:`assertWarns`, :meth:`assertWarnsRegex`
+ only when they are used as a context manager.
.. method:: assertEqual(first, second, msg=None)
@@ -955,7 +959,7 @@ Test cases
+---------------------------------------------------------+--------------------------------------+------------+
.. method:: assertRaises(exception, callable, *args, **kwds)
- assertRaises(exception)
+ assertRaises(exception, msg=None)
Test that an exception is raised when *callable* is called with any
positional or keyword arguments that are also passed to
@@ -964,12 +968,16 @@ Test cases
To catch any of a group of exceptions, a tuple containing the exception
classes may be passed as *exception*.
- If only the *exception* argument is given, returns a context manager so
- that the code under test can be written inline rather than as a function::
+ If only the *exception* and possibly the *msg* arguments are given,
+ return a context manager so that the code under test can be written
+ inline rather than as a function::
with self.assertRaises(SomeException):
do_something()
+ When used as a context manager, :meth:`assertRaises` accepts the
+ additional keyword argument *msg*.
+
The context manager will store the caught exception object in its
:attr:`exception` attribute. This can be useful if the intention
is to perform additional checks on the exception raised::
@@ -986,9 +994,12 @@ Test cases
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Added the :attr:`exception` attribute.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *msg* keyword argument when used as a context manager.
+
.. method:: assertRaisesRegex(exception, regex, callable, *args, **kwds)
- assertRaisesRegex(exception, regex)
+ assertRaisesRegex(exception, regex, msg=None)
Like :meth:`assertRaises` but also tests that *regex* matches
on the string representation of the raised exception. *regex* may be
@@ -1005,12 +1016,16 @@ Test cases
.. versionadded:: 3.1
under the name ``assertRaisesRegexp``.
+
.. versionchanged:: 3.2
Renamed to :meth:`assertRaisesRegex`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *msg* keyword argument when used as a context manager.
+
.. method:: assertWarns(warning, callable, *args, **kwds)
- assertWarns(warning)
+ assertWarns(warning, msg=None)
Test that a warning is triggered when *callable* is called with any
positional or keyword arguments that are also passed to
@@ -1019,12 +1034,16 @@ Test cases
To catch any of a group of warnings, a tuple containing the warning
classes may be passed as *warnings*.
- If only the *warning* argument is given, returns a context manager so
- that the code under test can be written inline rather than as a function::
+ If only the *warning* and possibly the *msg* arguments are given,
+ returns a context manager so that the code under test can be written
+ inline rather than as a function::
with self.assertWarns(SomeWarning):
do_something()
+ When used as a context manager, :meth:`assertRaises` accepts the
+ additional keyword argument *msg*.
+
The context manager will store the caught warning object in its
:attr:`warning` attribute, and the source line which triggered the
warnings in the :attr:`filename` and :attr:`lineno` attributes.
@@ -1042,9 +1061,12 @@ Test cases
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *msg* keyword argument when used as a context manager.
+
.. method:: assertWarnsRegex(warning, regex, callable, *args, **kwds)
- assertWarnsRegex(warning, regex)
+ assertWarnsRegex(warning, regex, msg=None)
Like :meth:`assertWarns` but also tests that *regex* matches on the
message of the triggered warning. *regex* may be a regular expression
@@ -1062,6 +1084,8 @@ Test cases
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Added the *msg* keyword argument when used as a context manager.
There are also other methods used to perform more specific checks, such as:
diff --git a/Doc/library/urllib.error.rst b/Doc/library/urllib.error.rst
index 282329f..e20db27 100644
--- a/Doc/library/urllib.error.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/urllib.error.rst
@@ -8,21 +8,23 @@
The :mod:`urllib.error` module defines the exception classes for exceptions
-raised by :mod:`urllib.request`. The base exception class is :exc:`URLError`,
-which inherits from :exc:`IOError`.
+raised by :mod:`urllib.request`. The base exception class is :exc:`URLError`.
The following exceptions are raised by :mod:`urllib.error` as appropriate:
.. exception:: URLError
The handlers raise this exception (or derived exceptions) when they run into
- a problem. It is a subclass of :exc:`IOError`.
+ a problem. It is a subclass of :exc:`OSError`.
.. attribute:: reason
The reason for this error. It can be a message string or another
- exception instance (:exc:`socket.error` for remote URLs, :exc:`OSError`
- for local URLs).
+ exception instance.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`URLError` has been made a subclass of :exc:`OSError` instead
+ of :exc:`IOError`.
.. exception:: HTTPError
diff --git a/Doc/library/urllib.request.rst b/Doc/library/urllib.request.rst
index cc759a4..29a8413 100644
--- a/Doc/library/urllib.request.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/urllib.request.rst
@@ -132,7 +132,7 @@ The :mod:`urllib.request` module defines the following functions:
The following classes are provided:
-.. class:: Request(url, data=None, headers={}, origin_req_host=None, unverifiable=False)
+.. class:: Request(url, data=None, headers={}, origin_req_host=None, unverifiable=False, method=None)
This class is an abstraction of a URL request.
@@ -140,8 +140,8 @@ The following classes are provided:
*data* may be a string specifying additional data to send to the
server, or ``None`` if no such data is needed. Currently HTTP
- requests are the only ones that use *data*; the HTTP request will
- be a POST instead of a GET when the *data* parameter is provided.
+ requests are the only ones that use *data*, in order to choose between
+ ``'GET'`` and ``'POST'`` when *method* is not specified.
*data* should be a buffer in the standard
:mimetype:`application/x-www-form-urlencoded` format. The
:func:`urllib.parse.urlencode` function takes a mapping or sequence
@@ -157,8 +157,8 @@ The following classes are provided:
:mod:`urllib`'s default user agent string is
``"Python-urllib/2.6"`` (on Python 2.6).
- The final two arguments are only of interest for correct handling
- of third-party HTTP cookies:
+ The following two arguments, *origin_req_host* and *unverifiable*,
+ are only of interest for correct handling of third-party HTTP cookies:
*origin_req_host* should be the request-host of the origin
transaction, as defined by :rfc:`2965`. It defaults to
@@ -175,6 +175,13 @@ The following classes are provided:
document, and the user had no option to approve the automatic
fetching of the image, this should be true.
+ *method* should be a string that indicates the HTTP request method that
+ will be used (e.g. ``'HEAD'``). Its value is stored in the
+ :attr:`~Request.method` attribute and is used by :meth:`get_method()`.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :attr:`Request.method` argument is added to the Request class.
+
.. class:: OpenerDirector()
@@ -240,10 +247,11 @@ The following classes are provided:
.. class:: HTTPBasicAuthHandler(password_mgr=None)
- Handle authentication with the remote host. *password_mgr*, if given, should be
- something that is compatible with :class:`HTTPPasswordMgr`; refer to section
- :ref:`http-password-mgr` for information on the interface that must be
- supported.
+ Handle authentication with the remote host. *password_mgr*, if given, should
+ be something that is compatible with :class:`HTTPPasswordMgr`; refer to
+ section :ref:`http-password-mgr` for information on the interface that must
+ be supported. HTTPBasicAuthHandler will raise a :exc:`ValueError` when
+ presented with a wrong Authentication scheme.
.. class:: ProxyBasicAuthHandler(password_mgr=None)
@@ -265,10 +273,19 @@ The following classes are provided:
.. class:: HTTPDigestAuthHandler(password_mgr=None)
- Handle authentication with the remote host. *password_mgr*, if given, should be
- something that is compatible with :class:`HTTPPasswordMgr`; refer to section
- :ref:`http-password-mgr` for information on the interface that must be
- supported.
+ Handle authentication with the remote host. *password_mgr*, if given, should
+ be something that is compatible with :class:`HTTPPasswordMgr`; refer to
+ section :ref:`http-password-mgr` for information on the interface that must
+ be supported. When both Digest Authentication Handler and Basic
+ Authentication Handler are both added, Digest Authentication is always tried
+ first. If the Digest Authentication returns a 40x response again, it is sent
+ to Basic Authentication handler to Handle. This Handler method will raise a
+ :exc:`ValueError` when presented with an authentication scheme other than
+ Digest or Basic.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ Raise :exc:`ValueError` on unsupported Authentication Scheme.
+
.. class:: ProxyDigestAuthHandler(password_mgr=None)
@@ -359,6 +376,15 @@ request.
boolean, indicates whether the request is unverifiable as defined
by RFC 2965.
+.. attribute:: Request.method
+
+ The HTTP request method to use. This value is used by
+ :meth:`~Request.get_method` to override the computed HTTP request
+ method that would otherwise be returned. This attribute is initialized with
+ the value of the *method* argument passed to the constructor.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
.. method:: Request.add_data(data)
Set the :class:`Request` data to *data*. This is ignored by all handlers except
@@ -368,8 +394,13 @@ request.
.. method:: Request.get_method()
- Return a string indicating the HTTP request method. This is only meaningful for
- HTTP requests, and currently always returns ``'GET'`` or ``'POST'``.
+ Return a string indicating the HTTP request method. If
+ :attr:`Request.method` is not ``None``, return its value, otherwise return
+ ``'GET'`` if :attr:`Request.data` is ``None``, or ``'POST'`` if it's not.
+ This is only meaningful for HTTP requests.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ get_method now looks at the value of :attr:`Request.method`.
.. method:: Request.has_data()
@@ -1162,7 +1193,7 @@ some point in the future.
*key_file* and *cert_file* are supported to provide an SSL key and certificate;
both are needed to support client authentication.
- :class:`URLopener` objects will raise an :exc:`IOError` exception if the server
+ :class:`URLopener` objects will raise an :exc:`OSError` exception if the server
returns an error code.
.. method:: open(fullurl, data=None)
diff --git a/Doc/library/warnings.rst b/Doc/library/warnings.rst
index 8af19a2..8387f5a 100644
--- a/Doc/library/warnings.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/warnings.rst
@@ -339,8 +339,7 @@ Available Functions
Write a warning to a file. The default implementation calls
``formatwarning(message, category, filename, lineno, line)`` and writes the
resulting string to *file*, which defaults to ``sys.stderr``. You may replace
- this function with an alternative implementation by assigning to
- ``warnings.showwarning``.
+ this function with any callable by assigning to ``warnings.showwarning``.
*line* is a line of source code to be included in the warning
message; if *line* is not supplied, :func:`showwarning` will
try to read the line specified by *filename* and *lineno*.
diff --git a/Doc/library/webbrowser.rst b/Doc/library/webbrowser.rst
index 23ba6c5..9cf8c50 100644
--- a/Doc/library/webbrowser.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/webbrowser.rst
@@ -96,47 +96,55 @@ A number of browser types are predefined. This table gives the type names that
may be passed to the :func:`get` function and the corresponding instantiations
for the controller classes, all defined in this module.
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| Type Name | Class Name | Notes |
-+=======================+=========================================+=======+
-| ``'mozilla'`` | :class:`Mozilla('mozilla')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'firefox'`` | :class:`Mozilla('mozilla')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'netscape'`` | :class:`Mozilla('netscape')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'galeon'`` | :class:`Galeon('galeon')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'epiphany'`` | :class:`Galeon('epiphany')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'skipstone'`` | :class:`BackgroundBrowser('skipstone')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'kfmclient'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'konqueror'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'kfm'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'mosaic'`` | :class:`BackgroundBrowser('mosaic')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'opera'`` | :class:`Opera()` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'grail'`` | :class:`Grail()` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'links'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('links')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'elinks'`` | :class:`Elinks('elinks')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'lynx'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('lynx')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'w3m'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('w3m')` | |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'windows-default'`` | :class:`WindowsDefault` | \(2) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'internet-config'`` | :class:`InternetConfig` | \(3) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
-| ``'macosx'`` | :class:`MacOSX('default')` | \(4) |
-+-----------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| Type Name | Class Name | Notes |
++========================+=========================================+=======+
+| ``'mozilla'`` | :class:`Mozilla('mozilla')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'firefox'`` | :class:`Mozilla('mozilla')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'netscape'`` | :class:`Mozilla('netscape')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'galeon'`` | :class:`Galeon('galeon')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'epiphany'`` | :class:`Galeon('epiphany')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'skipstone'`` | :class:`BackgroundBrowser('skipstone')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'kfmclient'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'konqueror'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'kfm'`` | :class:`Konqueror()` | \(1) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'mosaic'`` | :class:`BackgroundBrowser('mosaic')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'opera'`` | :class:`Opera()` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'grail'`` | :class:`Grail()` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'links'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('links')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'elinks'`` | :class:`Elinks('elinks')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'lynx'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('lynx')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'w3m'`` | :class:`GenericBrowser('w3m')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'windows-default'`` | :class:`WindowsDefault` | \(2) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'internet-config'`` | :class:`InternetConfig` | \(3) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'macosx'`` | :class:`MacOSX('default')` | \(4) |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'google-chrome'`` | :class:`Chrome('google-chrome')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'chrome'`` | :class:`Chrome('chrome')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'chromium'`` | :class:`Chromium('chromium')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
+| ``'chromium-browser'`` | :class:`Chromium('chromium-browser')` | |
++------------------------+-----------------------------------------+-------+
Notes:
@@ -156,12 +164,15 @@ Notes:
(4)
Only on Mac OS X platform.
+.. versionadded:: 3.3
+ Support for Chrome/Chromium has been added.
+
Here are some simple examples::
- url = 'http://www.python.org/'
+ url = 'http://docs.python.org/'
# Open URL in a new tab, if a browser window is already open.
- webbrowser.open_new_tab(url + 'doc/')
+ webbrowser.open_new_tab(url)
# Open URL in new window, raising the window if possible.
webbrowser.open_new(url)
diff --git a/Doc/library/winreg.rst b/Doc/library/winreg.rst
index 5cf30ee..376752e 100644
--- a/Doc/library/winreg.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/winreg.rst
@@ -38,7 +38,11 @@ This module offers the following functions:
*key* is the predefined handle to connect to.
The return value is the handle of the opened key. If the function fails, a
- :exc:`WindowsError` exception is raised.
+ :exc:`OSError` exception is raised.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
.. function:: CreateKey(key, sub_key)
@@ -57,7 +61,11 @@ This module offers the following functions:
If the key already exists, this function opens the existing key.
The return value is the handle of the opened key. If the function fails, a
- :exc:`WindowsError` exception is raised.
+ :exc:`OSError` exception is raised.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
.. function:: CreateKeyEx(key, sub_key, reserved=0, access=KEY_ALL_ACCESS)
@@ -82,10 +90,14 @@ This module offers the following functions:
If the key already exists, this function opens the existing key.
The return value is the handle of the opened key. If the function fails, a
- :exc:`WindowsError` exception is raised.
+ :exc:`OSError` exception is raised.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: DeleteKey(key, sub_key)
@@ -100,7 +112,11 @@ This module offers the following functions:
*This method can not delete keys with subkeys.*
If the method succeeds, the entire key, including all of its values, is removed.
- If the method fails, a :exc:`WindowsError` exception is raised.
+ If the method fails, a :exc:`OSError` exception is raised.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
.. function:: DeleteKeyEx(key, sub_key, access=KEY_ALL_ACCESS, reserved=0)
@@ -129,12 +145,16 @@ This module offers the following functions:
*This method can not delete keys with subkeys.*
If the method succeeds, the entire key, including all of its values, is
- removed. If the method fails, a :exc:`WindowsError` exception is raised.
+ removed. If the method fails, a :exc:`OSError` exception is raised.
On unsupported Windows versions, :exc:`NotImplementedError` is raised.
.. versionadded:: 3.2
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: DeleteValue(key, value)
@@ -156,9 +176,13 @@ This module offers the following functions:
*index* is an integer that identifies the index of the key to retrieve.
The function retrieves the name of one subkey each time it is called. It is
- typically called repeatedly until a :exc:`WindowsError` exception is
+ typically called repeatedly until a :exc:`OSError` exception is
raised, indicating, no more values are available.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: EnumValue(key, index)
@@ -170,7 +194,7 @@ This module offers the following functions:
*index* is an integer that identifies the index of the value to retrieve.
The function retrieves the name of one subkey each time it is called. It is
- typically called repeatedly, until a :exc:`WindowsError` exception is
+ typically called repeatedly, until a :exc:`OSError` exception is
raised, indicating no more values.
The result is a tuple of 3 items:
@@ -189,6 +213,10 @@ This module offers the following functions:
| | :meth:`SetValueEx`) |
+-------+--------------------------------------------+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: ExpandEnvironmentStrings(str)
@@ -260,10 +288,14 @@ This module offers the following functions:
The result is a new handle to the specified key.
- If the function fails, :exc:`WindowsError` is raised.
+ If the function fails, :exc:`OSError` is raised.
.. versionchanged:: 3.2 Allow the use of named arguments.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ This function used to raise a :exc:`WindowsError`, which is now an
+ alias of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. function:: OpenKeyEx()
diff --git a/Doc/library/xmlrpc.client.rst b/Doc/library/xmlrpc.client.rst
index e72770a..1871c99 100644
--- a/Doc/library/xmlrpc.client.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/xmlrpc.client.rst
@@ -8,7 +8,7 @@
.. XXX Not everything is documented yet. It might be good to describe
- Marshaller, Unmarshaller, getparser, dumps, loads, and Transport.
+ Marshaller, Unmarshaller, getparser and Transport.
**Source code:** :source:`Lib/xmlrpc/client.py`
@@ -21,7 +21,12 @@ supports writing XML-RPC client code; it handles all the details of translating
between conformable Python objects and XML on the wire.
-.. class:: ServerProxy(uri, transport=None, encoding=None, verbose=False, allow_none=False, use_datetime=False)
+.. class:: ServerProxy(uri, transport=None, encoding=None, verbose=False, \
+ allow_none=False, use_datetime=False, \
+ use_builtin_types=False)
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag was added.
A :class:`ServerProxy` instance is an object that manages communication with a
remote XML-RPC server. The required first argument is a URI (Uniform Resource
@@ -34,9 +39,13 @@ between conformable Python objects and XML on the wire.
XML; the default behaviour is for ``None`` to raise a :exc:`TypeError`. This is
a commonly-used extension to the XML-RPC specification, but isn't supported by
all clients and servers; see http://ontosys.com/xml-rpc/extensions.php for a
- description. The *use_datetime* flag can be used to cause date/time values to
- be presented as :class:`datetime.datetime` objects; this is false by default.
- :class:`datetime.datetime` objects may be passed to calls.
+ description. The *use_builtin_types* flag can be used to cause date/time values
+ to be presented as :class:`datetime.datetime` objects and binary data to be
+ presented as :class:`bytes` objects; this flag is false by default.
+ :class:`datetime.datetime` and :class:`bytes` objects may be passed to calls.
+
+ The obsolete *use_datetime* flag is similar to *use_builtin_types* but it
+ applies only to date/time values.
Both the HTTP and HTTPS transports support the URL syntax extension for HTTP
Basic Authentication: ``http://user:pass@host:port/path``. The ``user:pass``
@@ -78,12 +87,12 @@ between conformable Python objects and XML on the wire.
| | only their *__dict__* attribute is |
| | transmitted. |
+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------+
- | :const:`dates` | in seconds since the epoch (pass in an |
- | | instance of the :class:`DateTime` class) or |
+ | :const:`dates` | In seconds since the epoch. Pass in an |
+ | | instance of the :class:`DateTime` class or |
| | a :class:`datetime.datetime` instance. |
+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------+
- | :const:`binary data` | pass in an instance of the :class:`Binary` |
- | | wrapper class |
+ | :const:`binary data` | Pass in an instance of the :class:`Binary` |
+ | | wrapper class or a :class:`bytes` instance. |
+---------------------------------+---------------------------------------------+
This is the full set of data types supported by XML-RPC. Method calls may also
@@ -98,8 +107,9 @@ between conformable Python objects and XML on the wire.
ensure that the string is free of characters that aren't allowed in XML, such as
the control characters with ASCII values between 0 and 31 (except, of course,
tab, newline and carriage return); failing to do this will result in an XML-RPC
- request that isn't well-formed XML. If you have to pass arbitrary strings via
- XML-RPC, use the :class:`Binary` wrapper class described below.
+ request that isn't well-formed XML. If you have to pass arbitrary bytes
+ via XML-RPC, use the :class:`bytes` class or the class:`Binary` wrapper class
+ described below.
:class:`Server` is retained as an alias for :class:`ServerProxy` for backwards
compatibility. New code should use :class:`ServerProxy`.
@@ -249,7 +259,7 @@ The client code for the preceding server::
Binary Objects
--------------
-This class may be initialized from string data (which may include NULs). The
+This class may be initialized from bytes data (which may include NULs). The
primary access to the content of a :class:`Binary` object is provided by an
attribute:
@@ -257,15 +267,15 @@ attribute:
.. attribute:: Binary.data
The binary data encapsulated by the :class:`Binary` instance. The data is
- provided as an 8-bit string.
+ provided as a :class:`bytes` object.
:class:`Binary` objects have the following methods, supported mainly for
internal use by the marshalling/unmarshalling code:
-.. method:: Binary.decode(string)
+.. method:: Binary.decode(bytes)
- Accept a base64 string and decode it as the instance's new data.
+ Accept a base64 :class:`bytes` object and decode it as the instance's new data.
.. method:: Binary.encode(out)
@@ -471,14 +481,21 @@ Convenience Functions
it via an extension, provide a true value for *allow_none*.
-.. function:: loads(data, use_datetime=False)
+.. function:: loads(data, use_datetime=False, use_builtin_types=False)
Convert an XML-RPC request or response into Python objects, a ``(params,
methodname)``. *params* is a tuple of argument; *methodname* is a string, or
``None`` if no method name is present in the packet. If the XML-RPC packet
represents a fault condition, this function will raise a :exc:`Fault` exception.
- The *use_datetime* flag can be used to cause date/time values to be presented as
- :class:`datetime.datetime` objects; this is false by default.
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag can be used to cause date/time values to be
+ presented as :class:`datetime.datetime` objects and binary data to be
+ presented as :class:`bytes` objects; this flag is false by default.
+
+ The obsolete *use_datetime* flag is similar to *use_builtin_types* but it
+ applies only to date/time values.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag was added.
.. _xmlrpc-client-example:
diff --git a/Doc/library/xmlrpc.server.rst b/Doc/library/xmlrpc.server.rst
index 67feba6..6493fd4 100644
--- a/Doc/library/xmlrpc.server.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/xmlrpc.server.rst
@@ -16,7 +16,9 @@ servers written in Python. Servers can either be free standing, using
:class:`CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler`.
-.. class:: SimpleXMLRPCServer(addr, requestHandler=SimpleXMLRPCRequestHandler, logRequests=True, allow_none=False, encoding=None, bind_and_activate=True)
+.. class:: SimpleXMLRPCServer(addr, requestHandler=SimpleXMLRPCRequestHandler,\
+ logRequests=True, allow_none=False, encoding=None,\
+ bind_and_activate=True, use_builtin_types=False)
Create a new server instance. This class provides methods for registration of
functions that can be called by the XML-RPC protocol. The *requestHandler*
@@ -25,18 +27,31 @@ servers written in Python. Servers can either be free standing, using
are passed to the :class:`socketserver.TCPServer` constructor. If *logRequests*
is true (the default), requests will be logged; setting this parameter to false
will turn off logging. The *allow_none* and *encoding* parameters are passed
- on to :mod:`xmlrpc.client` and control the XML-RPC responses that will be returned
+ on to :mod:`xmlrpc.client` and control the XML-RPC responses that will be returned
from the server. The *bind_and_activate* parameter controls whether
:meth:`server_bind` and :meth:`server_activate` are called immediately by the
constructor; it defaults to true. Setting it to false allows code to manipulate
the *allow_reuse_address* class variable before the address is bound.
+ The *use_builtin_types* parameter is passed to the
+ :func:`~xmlrpc.client.loads` function and controls which types are processed
+ when date/times values or binary data are received; it defaults to false.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag was added.
-.. class:: CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler(allow_none=False, encoding=None)
+
+.. class:: CGIXMLRPCRequestHandler(allow_none=False, encoding=None,\
+ use_builtin_types=False)
Create a new instance to handle XML-RPC requests in a CGI environment. The
*allow_none* and *encoding* parameters are passed on to :mod:`xmlrpc.client`
and control the XML-RPC responses that will be returned from the server.
+ The *use_builtin_types* parameter is passed to the
+ :func:`~xmlrpc.client.loads` function and controls which types are processed
+ when date/times values or binary data are received; it defaults to false.
+
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag was added.
.. class:: SimpleXMLRPCRequestHandler()
@@ -233,12 +248,17 @@ to HTTP GET requests. Servers can either be free standing, using
:class:`DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler`.
-.. class:: DocXMLRPCServer(addr, requestHandler=DocXMLRPCRequestHandler, logRequests=True, allow_none=False, encoding=None, bind_and_activate=True)
+.. class:: DocXMLRPCServer(addr, requestHandler=DocXMLRPCRequestHandler,\
+ logRequests=True, allow_none=False, encoding=None,\
+ bind_and_activate=True, use_builtin_types=True)
Create a new server instance. All parameters have the same meaning as for
:class:`SimpleXMLRPCServer`; *requestHandler* defaults to
:class:`DocXMLRPCRequestHandler`.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ The *use_builtin_types* flag was added.
+
.. class:: DocCGIXMLRPCRequestHandler()
diff --git a/Doc/library/zipimport.rst b/Doc/library/zipimport.rst
index 4f17092..b47c35b 100644
--- a/Doc/library/zipimport.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/zipimport.rst
@@ -85,9 +85,12 @@ zipimporter Objects
.. method:: get_data(pathname)
- Return the data associated with *pathname*. Raise :exc:`IOError` if the
+ Return the data associated with *pathname*. Raise :exc:`OSError` if the
file wasn't found.
+ .. versionchanged:: 3.3
+ :exc:`IOError` used to be raised instead of :exc:`OSError`.
+
.. method:: get_filename(fullname)
diff --git a/Doc/library/zlib.rst b/Doc/library/zlib.rst
index 897d919..1e9a2bc 100644
--- a/Doc/library/zlib.rst
+++ b/Doc/library/zlib.rst
@@ -120,6 +120,7 @@ The available exception and functions in this module are:
won't fit into memory at once. The *wbits* parameter controls the size of the
window buffer.
+
Compression objects support the following methods:
@@ -150,7 +151,7 @@ Compression objects support the following methods:
compress a set of data that share a common initial prefix.
-Decompression objects support the following methods, and two attributes:
+Decompression objects support the following methods and attributes:
.. attribute:: Decompress.unused_data
@@ -160,13 +161,6 @@ Decompression objects support the following methods, and two attributes:
available. If the whole bytestring turned out to contain compressed data, this is
``b""``, an empty bytes object.
- The only way to determine where a bytestring of compressed data ends is by actually
- decompressing it. This means that when compressed data is contained part of a
- larger file, you can only find the end of it by reading data and feeding it
- followed by some non-empty bytestring into a decompression object's
- :meth:`decompress` method until the :attr:`unused_data` attribute is no longer
- empty.
-
.. attribute:: Decompress.unconsumed_tail
@@ -177,6 +171,17 @@ Decompression objects support the following methods, and two attributes:
:meth:`decompress` method call in order to get correct output.
+.. attribute:: Decompress.eof
+
+ A boolean indicating whether the end of the compressed data stream has been
+ reached.
+
+ This makes it possible to distinguish between a properly-formed compressed
+ stream, and an incomplete or truncated one.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. method:: Decompress.decompress(data[, max_length])
Decompress *data*, returning a bytes object containing the uncompressed data
@@ -211,6 +216,24 @@ Decompression objects support the following methods, and two attributes:
seeks into the stream at a future point.
+Information about the version of the zlib library in use is available through
+the following constants:
+
+
+.. data:: ZLIB_VERSION
+
+ The version string of the zlib library that was used for building the module.
+ This may be different from the zlib library actually used at runtime, which
+ is available as :const:`ZLIB_RUNTIME_VERSION`.
+
+
+.. data:: ZLIB_RUNTIME_VERSION
+
+ The version string of the zlib library actually loaded by the interpreter.
+
+ .. versionadded:: 3.3
+
+
.. seealso::
Module :mod:`gzip`